九年级英语上册教案
发布时间:2024-03-12 九年级英语上册教案 九年级英语上册九年级英语上册教案十五篇。
每个老师在上课前需要规划好教案课件,又到了老师开始写教案课件的时候了。教案是教学模式和教育思想的体现,如何根据课件写教案呢?幼儿教师教育网的编辑特别为您精选的“九年级英语上册教案”一定能够让您满意,为了避免遗失建议您将本页网址收藏好!
九年级英语上册教案(篇1)
小学英语《Unit 4 What can you do》教案
一、教学重点
本课时的教学重点是掌握四会句型,并能在情景中自然的加以运用。
二、教学难点
本课时的教学难点是正确拼写主要句型。
三、课前准备
1.教师准备教学过程中所需要的图片、英文卡片、声音、课件。
2.教师准备录音机及录音带。
四、教学过程
1.Warm-up(热身)
(l)Listen and do
① 教师或学生上台发指令:set the table, sweep the floor……,其余学生做动作。
② 还可以分组比赛的方式,每组各选一人,一方发指令,一方做动作,然后轮换。
此活动旨在带领学生复习本单元所有主要词组,教师特别注意要照顾到学困生,使他们也能顺利完成教学任务。
(2)Let’s play 斗牛士
① 将全班分成两组,每组请一位同学上前,两人各从教师准备的图片中抽取一张藏在背后。
② 两人同时向前走三步,然后回头,谁能最先用英语说出对方的图片,即可为本组加一分。(还可以请同学在规定的地点、时间,跳跃闪躲,先说出对方图片的同学为获胜者)
此游戏学生兴趣较大,但教师要控制好课堂纪律。两种方式可根据本班学生情况来选择,目的在于锻炼学生的英语表达及快速反应的能力。
2. Presentation(新课呈现)
(l)Read and write
① 教师可先请请学生来做介绍。教师提问,你想对机器人说什么?请3-4人说一说。
② 播放课文:画面上出现机器人和同学们的对话,点击每句话,都会听到该句声音。
③ 请学生听声音,不理解的地方,教师作必要的解释。
④ 听并且跟读,提醒学生注意语音语调。
⑤ 分组表演对话,请学生来为画面配音。
⑥ 请学生笔头完成练习题,再请同学口头回答。
画面上出示表格,学生说出正确答案后,教师点击一栏表格就会出现相应的英文和图画,重复以上步骤可完成其他内容。
⑦ 指导学生进行四会句子的书写。
利用课件循序渐进,看―听―读―演―写,使学生掌握四会句型,并能在情景中自然运用。
(2)Let’s check
① 画面上出现六条小鱼set, you, can, ?, table, the,及其他几句话。
② 教师请学生仔细观察一分钟,然后将他们按顺序排列,最后可大声读出本句。老师点击画面,出示答案。
③ 如果有时间,教师还可以准备一些句子的单词卡片,以组为单位,每组会有一个不同的句子,看哪组速度最快,即为优胜组。
连词组句是学生在测试中经常会遇到的题目,用动画和游戏的方式出现,趣味性更强,便于学生理解、操练。
3.Let’s play (趣味操练)
(1)Let’s play 猜猜我是谁
① 教师在课前准备一些小卡片,上面写有不同动物的特征。如:I can fly. I can sing. Who am I?(bird)分别发到几个组。
② 看哪个组的速度最快,能猜出卡片上的动物。
如果学生完成的很快,教师还可以提前布置一些同学把自己的特长写在纸上,让大家来猜一猜。
(2)Group work
① 教师提出要求,四人一组,模仿书上的内容轮换提问,并做好记录。推选一人为监督员,对话中不能使用中文。
② 请4-5组汇报自己组内的情况。
在分组练习之前,教师可以请两组来做示范,一定要让学生明白之后才开始操练,避免在对话中出现中文。
4.Consolidation and extension(巩固与扩展)
(l)练一练
① 让学生做本单元B Read and write部分的活动手册配套练习。P40 3/4
② 将今天的.故事讲给你的家长听。
5. 板书
Can you make the bed?No, I can’t.
Can you use a computer? Yes, I can.
I can play chess。
教案点评:
本课时主要是在前两课时的基础上,使学生能听说读写主要句型,并在合适的情景中自然的使用。Read and write 部分为学生创设了趣味性极强的情景,在活动中可以很好的完成教学目标。而Group work则为学生提供了学以致用的机会,教师应承担好主讲和指挥等多重角色,观察、监控课堂活动的进展。
我为教材来补充
――请学生为本课教材添加新词的探究活动
探究内容: 组织学生自己扩充与劳动相关的词组。
探究目的: 开阔学生思维,养成举一反三的学习习惯。
探究形式: 分组。
活动特点: 自己寻找方法巧学妙记,进一步扩充词汇量。
活动过程:
7. 教师举例clean the room, clean the windows……。
8. 以组为单位,在组长带领下,你们还能再补充多少与劳动有关的词组。
9. 教师带领总结,并评选出优胜组。
九年级英语上册教案(篇2)
一、教学背景分析
(一)教学内容分析
本单元的中心话题是Food,主要语言功能项目是Talk about likes and dislikes,语法结构为Present tense to like, Yes / No questions and short answers, Affirmative and negative statements。本单元Section A所呈现的是与谈论喜好与厌恶相关的基本语言知识及其初步运用。这部分内容从呈现食物词汇开始,通过视、听等方式输入信息,并引出本单元主要句型:Do you like…? 及其回答Yes,I do / No, I don’t.接着设计了一个听力练习,要求圈出所听到的食物以及补全对话,强化记忆所学词汇和初学句型。然后教材设计了一个结对活动,以此操练主语是第三人称单数时句型的变化以及回答。并借此突出本单元的语法重点。最后教材设计的Food Survey起到了引导学生初步综合运用所学语言的作用,以调查的形式使学生在富有挑战性的活动中主动运用所学语言,落实新知。Section B是在Section A基础上的知识的扩展和延伸。本单元中,Section B首先以听、说、写的形式展开了食物与名称配对以及对食物进行分类。接着设计了听力填写Sandra和Tom喜欢与不喜欢的食物;自然引到了谈论一日三餐的话题的结对活动,实现了新旧知识的综合运用;一日三餐合理健康膳食引出同步阅读;之后的写一段话谈谈Tom 的一日三餐到写一段关于自己一日三餐喜欢吃的食物,直到最后的小组活动列出购物清单,使学生从完成半真实的任务转向了完成真实的任务,从而达到了创造性活用所学语言的目的。Self check部分的主要内容是对本单元主要词汇及语言运用能力的自我评价。
综上所述,本单元以食物为主线,围绕着谈论喜欢与不喜欢以及一日三餐等语言功能项目展开了一系列任务活动。教材内容从基本语言知识到语言综合运用层层递进,听说读写依次展开,以一种循序渐进的生活化的学习程序,引导学生在做事中有目的地学习语言。
(二)教学重点和难点
教学重点:1、掌握关于食物的词汇。
2、熟练运用所学功能项目谈论喜好和厌恶。
3、能准确地用英语描述一日三餐的食谱。
教学难点:1、交际用语Do you like bananas? Yes, I do. /No, I don’t.
2、描述一日三餐的方法。
3、一般现在时,主语是三单时,助动词与动词的变化。
4、可数名词和不可数名词的区别。
(三)教学目标
《新课程标准》之基础教育阶段英语课程的总体目标是培养学生综合语言运用能力,而这种综合语言运用能力的形成是建立在语言知识、语言技能、情感态度、学习策略和文化意识的整体发展基础上的,根据本课教学内容和学生知识结构及认知特点,本单元的教学目标确定为:
1、语言知识目标:立足语言实践活动,在完成任务的过程中掌握谈论喜好和厌恶以及表述一日三餐的词汇和语言结构。
2、语言技能目标:
(1) 开展多种任务型的听力活动,获得理解、识别和处理与谈论喜好、厌恶相关的信息。
(2) 展开各种任务活动,使学生具备较熟练地运用所学语言谈论喜好与厌恶,描述一日三餐的合理搭配的能力。
(3) 引导同步阅读,使学生理解与主题相关的语言材料,并增强学生运用语言获取更多信息的能力。
(4) 进行写作练习,使学生具备初步的综合运用语言的能力。
3、情感态度目标:
(1)通过情景的设置和活动的开展,引导学生在体验、实践、参与、合作和交流中,积极主动地学习语言,体会在做事中学习英语的喜悦。
(2)讨论美食,享受生活美味,提倡健康合理膳食。
4、学习策略目标:
(1)Disscussion. 通过小组讨论、开展调查等研究,明确在用中学、交流中学习的想法。
(2)Classifying. 通过分类法,可简化学习过程,利于记忆。
(3)Guessing. 通过猜测,并大胆发言,以学习新知。
5、文化意识目标:了解中西方膳食的不同习惯以及表示喜好与厌恶的一些常用表达法。
二、教学方法和学习策略
1、教法
(1)本单元话题源自生活,立足这一点,充分利用学生已有的知识和经验,创设生活化的真实(或半真实情景)引导学生在运用语言中学习语言,然后在学习新的语言知识后创造性地运用语言(为用而学,在用中学,学了用)。
(2)开展多种类型任务活动,提供给学生合作交流的空间和时间,促使学生为完成任务和同学进行合作,为完成任务进行探究学习。
2、学习策略:
(1)通过Disscussing, Classifying and Guessing等形式多样的活动,促使学生运用认知策略进行有效地学习。
(2)在与同学合作完成任务的活动中主动探究和学习语言;并运用知识内在规律帮助记忆、巩固知识。
三、课时结构
为了能较好地 实现既定的教学目标,结合本单元教学内容和学生的学习规律,将本单元授课时定为四课时。
Period 1 Section A 1a /1b /1c /2a /2b.
Period 2 Section A 2c /3 /4 .
Period 3 Section B 1a /1b /2a /2b /2c /3a /3b /3c /4a/4b.
Period 4 Summing up SectionsAand Band the grammar.
四、教学过程设计
Period One
一、教学目标
1.知识目标:
1)单词:do, don’t, does, doesn’t, strawberries, like, have, bamburgers, orange, tomatoes, icecream, broccoli, salad, French fries, bananas.
2)句型:Do you like bananas?
Yes, I do. / No, I don’t.
2.能力目标:通过学习本课,学生能够用英语互相讨论喜欢与不喜欢的食品。
3.情感目标:讨论美食,享受生活美味,提倡健康合理膳食。
二、教学重点:掌握关于食物的词汇。
三、教学难点:学会使用交际用语Do you like bananas?
Yes, I do./No, Idon’t.
四、教学设计:
Step1. 通过让学生猜冰箱里有哪些食物的形式,导出新的单词。同时让全体学生拼读每个单词、让个别学生将单词写到黑板上。
本环节课堂节录如下:
T: Today we are going to learn Unit 6. Look, what’s this?
Ss: It’s a fridge.
T: Right! There are many kinds of delicious food in it. Can you guess?
S1: Apple.
T: Yes, there are some apples in it. Are there any oranges in it?
S2: Yes.
T: OK, Maybe you are right. Now let’s open the fridge and check them out. Look, what are they?
Ss: They are bananas.
T: How do you spell it?
Ss: B-A-N-A-N-A, banana.
T: Anything else?
S: French fries.
T: Maybe you are right. Let’s see. Look! What are they?
Ss: They are French fries.
T: Can you spell it, please?
Ss: F-R-E-N-C-H, French, F-R-I-E-S, fries.
T: Yes, very good! Who can write it on the blackboard?
S: Me.
T: You please.
Step2. 布置一项任务:老师手持一个盒子,让同学猜猜老师最喜欢的食物。规则为学生只能问老师问题而老师只用 “Yes” 或 “No” 回答。
本环节课堂节录如下:
T: You see, there are so many things in the fridge. I know each of you has your favourite food. Right? I have my favourite food, too. Now I want you to guess it. You can ask me questions to find it out. Think over, what question can you ask?
S: What’s your favourite food ?
T: Yes, you can ask me in this way, but I want you to guess it. I can only answer “ Yes” or “ No”. How can you ask me?
S: Do you like bananas?
T: Yes, I do. Yes, good question! So all of you can ask me like this, clear?
Ss: Yes!
S: Do you like hamburgers?
T: No, I don’t. I don’t like hamburgers.
S: Do you like oranges?
T: Yes, I do. They’re sweet.
S: Do you like ice cream?
T: Yes, I do. It’s my favourite food in summer. OK, I think one of you has got the right answer. Now my favourite food is in this box!
Ss: Chocolate!
T: No, I don’t like chocolate. let’s open and see! Look! What’s this?
Ss: Orange!
T: Who got the right answer?
S: Me!
T: OK, congratulations! And this orange is for you!
完成Section A, 1a, 1b.
Step 3. 布置拓展性任务:要求同桌学生合作编一个小型对话,主题为询问别人喜欢或不喜欢的食物。要求使用刚学过的食物类单词以及句型,同时也可以适当地加入课外单词(老师请一程度较好的学生先进行示范)。
本环节课堂节录:
T: Now let’s do the pair work. Make a dialogue with your partners. Ask your partners like this to find out their favourite food. I will ask some pairs to act it out. Two minutes.
( Two minutes later )
T: OK, stop here. Who’d like to be the first pair? You two, please!
A: Hello.
B: Hi.
A: Let’s go to eat breakfast. Look, do you like hamburgers?
B: Yes, I do.
A: Oh, I like it, too. Do you like French fries?
B: No, I don’t. They aren’t healthy food.
A: OK, let’s eat hamburgers.
B: Great! Thank you.
Step 4. 完成课文32页Section A听力练习activity 2a, 2b。
Setp5. 当堂听写:听写单词与句型,进一步巩固本课学习内容,并将本课应掌握的单词和句型落实到“写”上,使学生不但会说同时会写。
Homework
1. Copy the new words and try to learn them by heart.
2. Make up a new dialogue about likes and dislikes then write it down in your exercise book.
五、课后反思:本单元的主题为食物,贴近学生生活,因此学生很喜欢该主题,上课气氛比较热烈。课堂布置的任务使学生在完成的过程中不知不觉地掌握了单词与句型,从而达到教学目标。
Period Two
一、教学目标
1. 知识目标:
1)能将所学单词进行归类。
2)熟练地掌握主语为第三人称单数和非第三人称的否定句、一般疑问句及其回答。
如:Do you /they like salad? Yes, I /they do. No, I /they don’t
Does he like French fries? Yes, he does. No, he doesn’t.
I (They) like oranges. I (They) don’t like bananas.
She likes bananas. She doesn’t like ice cream.
2.能力目标:能用英语熟练地交流喜欢与不喜欢的食品,并在班上提问同学展开调查。
3.情感目标:通过谈论美食,进一步引导学生享受美味生活,同时培养学生的合作学习精神。
二、 教学重点:掌握主语为三单和非三单时的陈述句、否定句、一般疑问句及其回答的形式。
三、 教学难点:主语是第三人称单数时的否定句和疑问句中的动词变化形式。
四、 教学设计:
Step 1. 复习前课所学单词与句型:通过看图片说单词的方式复习单词,并通过询问学生“Do you like bananas/ oranges…?”的形式,复习前一课的句型。
本环节课堂节录如下:
T: Yesterday, we learned many words about food, right? Do you still remember? Now please look at the screen.
T: What’s this?
Ss: Apple.
T: Do you like apples?
Ss: Yes, I do.
T: And what’s this?
Ss: Banana.
T: Yes, What about this one?
Ss: Broccoli.
T: Do you like broccoli?
Ss: No, I don’t.
…
T: Yes, good job! You have good memory!
Step 2. 导入新课:分别请一男孩和女孩回答老师的问题,说出他们喜欢与不喜欢的食物,然后就这两位学生的情况向全班提问,以此介绍主语为三单和非三单时的各种句型。
本环节课堂节录如下:
T: Now I’ll ask a boy and a girl to answer my questions. First I’d like to ask a boy.
( To a boy ) Do you like pears?
B: Yes, I do.
T: Do you like French fries?
B: No, I don’t.
T: (To the class) Class, does he like pears?
Ss: Yes, he does.
T: Does he like French fries?
Ss: No, he doesn’t.
(Then ask a girl to answer the teacher’s question.)
T: (To a girl) Do you like pears?
G: Yes, I do.
T: Do you like French fries?
G: No, I don’t.
T: (To the class) Now class, does she like pears?
Ss: Yes, she does.
T: Does she like French fries?
Ss: No, she doesn’t.
T: (Pointing to the boy and the girl) Class, do they like pears?
Ss: Yes, they do.
T: Right. They like pears. Do they like French fries?
Ss: No, they don’t.
T: Yeah, they don’t like French fries. Good job!
(边说边板书重点句型.)
Step 3 布置任务:四人小组活动。其中两位互相询问对方喜欢与不喜欢的食物,另两位转述他们所说的情况。
eg. A: I like chicken. Do you like chicken?
B: Yes, I do. / No, I don’t
C: He /She likes chicken. Does she /he like chicken?
D: Yes, he /she does. /No, He /she doesn’t.
Step 4 完成课本33页Part 3中的Pairwork. Find out what Bob and Bill like and don’t like.Then draw in the chart.
Step 5 简单总结一下语法。然后布置拓展性的任务:假如明天是你的生日,你打算邀请一些同学来你家做客,你事先已了解他们所喜欢的食物。你和妈妈讨论准备去买一些他们喜欢吃的东西。要求和同伴合作编对话,然后上台表演。(教师事先与一学生做示范.)
eg. A: Mum, tomorrow is my birthday. Jim, Kate, Lucy and Lily are coming to my party.
B: Good. Let’s give them something nice to eat. Does Jim like oranges?
A: Yes, he likes them very much.
B: Does Kate like oranges, too?
A: No, she doesn’t. She likes pears.
B: What about Lucy and Lily? Do they like ice cream?
A: Yes, they like it very much.
B: OK. Let’s go and get some oranges, pears, ice cream and some other things.
A: OK. Let’s go.
T: Good job! Next Sunday I want to invite some students to my house, please help me to make a survey in our class and tell me what they like and don’t like.
Step 6 接着完成课本33页 Part 4中的Food survey。要求学生就表格中的食物向同伴提问:Do you like…?找出他们喜欢与不喜欢的食物,填好表格,然后向全班汇报。
eg. Liu Li likes tomatoes, but Zhao Jun doesn’t like tomatoes. He likes potatoes. Liu Mei and Chen Yan like bananas, but Li Lei and Bill don’t like bananas. They like oranges. …
Homework
1. Write a report about your food survey in your class.
2. Finish off the exercises in the exercise book.
Period Three
一、教学目标
1.知识目标:
1) 单词:have, has, eat, eats, like, likes, oh, for, carrot, runner, lots of, dessert, egg, apple, chichen, fruit, vegetable, breakfast, lunch, dinner, eat, run, star, healthy, food, list
2)句型:What do you have for breakfast/ lunch/ dinner?
For breakfast, I have…
What does he/ she have for breakfast/ lunch/ dinner?
For breakfast, he/ she has….
2.能力目标:学完本课,学生能够用英语描述一日三餐的食谱。
3.情感目标:懂得一日三餐应合理搭配饮食,才会健康,快乐。
二、教学重点:掌握本课新单词。
三、教学难点:掌握描述一日三餐的方法。
四、教学设计:
Step1. Memory challenge
Show some words about the food in groups of two, four or six on the screen quickly, let the students say out the words as many as they can to revise the words.
完成Section B, 2a, 2b, 2c.
Step2. 导入新课:在大屏幕上出现三个盘子,分别代表一日三餐,并将刚复习的食物放入盘中,引导学生表述三餐的食谱。
本节课堂实录如下:
T: How many meals do we have every day?
Ss: Three.
T: Yes, and what are they?
T: Right. So I have three plates for you. The first one is for breakfast, the second one is for lunch and the third one is for dinner. Now I put the food into each plate. According to it. What do you have for breakfast?
S: For breakfast, I have hamburgers, tomatoes and salad.
T: Yes, great! Then what about lunch? What do you have for lunch?
S: For lunch, I have eggs, broccoli and carrots.
T: Right! How about dinner? What do you have for dinner?
S: For dinner, I have chicken, salad and ice cream.
T: OK. Well done!
Step3. 布置任务:要求同桌学生合作编对话,主题为询问别人一日三餐喜欢吃的食物。学生上台展示时,可使用电脑将自己选择的食物直观地放入每餐的盘中。
本节课堂实录如下:
T: Do you like the food I chose for you?
Ss: Yes/ No.
T: It’s your turn now! choose food for yourself and make a dialogue with your partners. Ask your partners what they have for three meals. Two minutes, and I will ask some pairs to come here to act it out and you can put the food into the plate by yourself. Two minutes, start!
( Two minutes later )
T: Time is up. Who’d like to be the first one?
Ss: Me/ Let me have a try.
T: OK, you two first. Let’s welcome!
A: Good morning.
B: Goodmorning.
A: What do you like for breakfast?
B: I like hamburgers and bananas.
A: What do you eat for lunch?
B: For lunch, I eat chicken, broccoli and ice cream. What do you have for dinner?
A: For dinner, I have rice, fish, vegetable soup and cucumbers.
B: I think your dinner is very delicious.
A: Thank you. Let’s go to KFC.
B: Really/ OK. Let’s go!
A: Not bad!
与学生讨论哪些是健康食品,哪些是不健康食品。
T: You have eaten healthy food. Let’s look at Sandra. What kind of food does she eat? Now let me tell you. Listen carefully and answer my questions.
Step 4. 完成34页Section B的听力练习activity 2a, 2b以及Pairwork 2c.
Step 5. 巩固描述一日三餐食谱的方法:同步阅读“ Runner eats well!” 然后完成SectionB activity 3b.
Step 6. 完成Section B Activity 3c: Write about what you like for breakfast, lunch and dinner.
Step 7. Groupwork: You are going for a picnic with a group of friends.
1. Make a list of food to buy.
2. Read your list of food to the class.
Homework
1. Eating healthily is very important.It can make you healthy and happy. Please write about what you like for breakfast, lunch and dinner.
五、 课后反思:学生在前一课的基础上进一步学会了如何表达一日三餐的食谱,也明白了合理搭配饮食,才会健康,快乐。
Period Four
一、教学目标:
1.知识目标
1) 将本单元所学内容编成一个对话。
2)巩固单元语言知识点,即可教名词与不可数名词。
2. 能力目标:学会综合运用英语交谈喜欢与不喜欢的事物以及一日三餐的食谱。
3. 情感目标:懂得饮食合理、健康。
二、教学重点:复习单词、句型以及一日三餐表达方法。
三、教学难点:可数名词、不可数名词以及有时可数名词有时不可数名词的分类。
四、教学设计:
Setp1. 复习本单元内容:要求学生编一个关于讨论喜欢的食物以及一日三餐食谱的对话。
本环节课堂实录如下:
T: Look at the screen.Who are they?
Ss: 蜡笔小新和樱桃小丸子.
T: Yes, they meet each other on Sunday. What do they talk about?
Ss: Hamburgers, French fries…
(Show the conversation.)
T: OK. Let’s read it together.
Boys: Good afternoon.
Girls: Good afternoon.
Boys: Let’s go to the KFC together.
Girls: great! I’d like to go.
Boys: What do you have for lunch?
Girls: I have hamburgers and salad. What about you?
Boys: I have rice, fish and broccoli.
Girls: What do you like for dinner in KFC?
Boys: I like hamburgers, chicken and ice cream. And you?
Girls: Me, too.
Boys: OK.Let’s go!
T: Now please make a conversation like this with your partners. Two minutes.
(Two minutes later.)
T: Now, I’d like to ask some pairs to act it out. You please.
A: Nice to meet you.
B: Nice to meet you.
A: Oh, it’s seven o’clock now. Let’s go to school.
B: OK.
A: Do you like apples?
B: Yes, I do.
A: Do you like strawberries?
B: No, I don’t. It’s too sour. Do you like French fries?
A: No, I don’t.It’s isn’t healthy food.
B: What do you have for breakfast?
A: For breakfast, I have hamburgers, eggs and orange juice. What about you?
B: I have hamburgers, French fries and coca cola.
A: Let’s have lunch together, OK?
B: OK. Bye-bye.
A: Bye.(A is a girl,B is a boy.)
Step2. 归纳本单元语言点:可数与不可数名词。(注:由于初一学生对于语法讲解不太熟悉,为便于学生们理解及掌握,本环节以中文讲解为主。)
本环节课堂实录:
T: Next let’s review the grammar together. Please take out your notebooks.
T: 英语名词可以大致分为两类,是哪两类?
Ss: 可数名词和不可数名词。
T: 对,可数名词又可以分为两类:单数和复数名词。
1.可数名词。举例:apple, orange, desk, chair, book等。
2.不可数名词。比如:water, milk, bread, news等。不可数名词一般没有复数形式。表示其数量时要用计量名词。比如a glass of water,一杯水,a piece of news一则新闻。
3.有时既可当可数名词又可当不可数名词。如:ice cream, salad, chicken.
T: 好的,接下来我们来看可数名词的复数形式。
可数名词由单数变为复数有五种情况:
1. 词尾加s,如apples,oranges.
2.以s, x, ch, sh, o结尾的加es, 如bus--buses, box--boxes, watch--watches, brush--brushes, tomato--tomatoes. 但有些例外。如:radios, photos, zoos.
3.以y结尾的,去y加ies. 如story--stories.
4.以f或fe结尾的,去f或fe加ves. 如knife--knives.
5.不规则变化:如child--children, man--men, tooth--teeth.
T: 关于名词的复数形式,清楚了吗? Ss: 清楚。
T: 好,接着我们再看看动词变化。
1. 陈述句中,主语如果是第三人称单数,谓语动词加S
如:He likes hamburgers.
He has chicken for dinner. (have-has)
2. 否定句中,主语如果是第三人称单数,用doesn’t.主语如果是非第三人称单数,用don’t. doesn’t和don’t后面动词变原形。
如:I don’t like hamburgers
He dosen’t like ice cream.
3. 一般疑问句中,主语如果是第三人称单数,用doesn’t开头提问,主语如果是非第三人称单数,用don’t开头提问,后面动词变原形。
如:Does he like pears?
Do they like Salad?
T: OK.These are the main grammar points of unit six.Do you have any questions?
Ss: No.
Finish off Self-Check.
Do a short test about the grammer above.
Homework
1. Make a survey and write a report.(抽样调查现在中学生的早餐状况并提出合理化的建议)
九年级英语上册教案(篇3)
PEP小学五年级上册英语UNIT 4 What can you do? 第一课时教案
Unit 4 What can you do? Lesson 1 一、教学重点 本课时的.教学重点是Let’s learn部分五种家务劳动的表达方法,要求学生做到四会,并能在情景中自然的加以运用。 二、教学难点 本课时的教学难点是如何利用所提供的对话和情景,以旧引新,让学生进入学习状态。 三、课前准备 1.教师准备教学过程中所需要的图片、英文卡片、声音、课件。 2.教师准备录音机及录音带。 四、教学过程 1.Warm-up(热身) T: Are you ready? Ss: Yes! T: OK! Class Begin! Good morning, everyone! Ss: Good morning, Teacher. T: Sit down, please! Ss: Thank you! 2.Presentation(新课呈现) (l) Start T: Let’s learn new lesson. Unit 4 What can you do? Look here. What can you see? Who can answer this question? Please, hands up! Ss: I can see a dog. Ss: I can see a panda. Ss: I can see a mouse. Ss: I can see a boy. T: Great! What can they do? Listen carefully! Let’s chant! 放音 T: Ok! It’s nice sing! Follow me, please! Let’s chant! Dog, dog, what can you do? I can run after you. Panda, panda, what can you do? I can eat so much bamboo. Mouse, mouse, what can you do? I can hide in the shoe. Mike, mike, what can you do? I can draw animals in the zoo! Let’s sing it together. Ss: …… T: Now! Look at these pictures. What can you do? Who can answer? Hands up,please! Ss: I can jump high. I can play football. I can sing. I can row a boat. I can play table tennis. I can play basketball. I can play chess. T: You’re great! Sit down, please! (2) Let’s learn T: Hi, I will introduce a new friend for your. Look! She’s Lucy. “Hello! I’m Lucy. How are you?I’m helpful. I can help my mother to do housework. I can ……” Ok! Look at these pictures. You can see what can she do? Ss: Sweep the floor. Ss: Cook the meals. Ss: Clean the bedroom. Ss: Water the flowers. Ss: Empty the trash. T: Good job! You’re helpful! Ok! Follow me, please! One, two, begin! What can you do? I’m helpful. I can sweep the floor. Ss: …… T: What can you do? I’m helpful. I can cook the meals. Ss: …… T: What can you do? I’m helpful. I can clean the bedroom. Ss: …… T: What can you do? I’m helpful. I can water the flowers. Ss: …… T: What can you do? I’m helpful. I can empty the trash. Ss: …… 3.Let’s play (Guess) 老师做出一系列的动作,让学生猜。如扫地,让同学猜一猜并说出英文sweep the floor。看看学生新课的掌握程度和对以往知识的积累。 4.Consolidation and extension(巩固与扩展) Look and write What can they do?(他们会做什么?看图完成句子。 ) (1). Lucy can sweep the floor, water the flowers and play table tennis. (2). Tom can water the flowers and cook the meals. (3). Mary can clean the bedroom and play table tennis. (4). Ann can sweep the floor and play table tennis. 5.板书 句 型:I’m helpful! I can sweep the floor. cook the meals clean the bedroom water the flowers empty the trash九年级英语上册教案(篇4)
教材分析
主要围绕着“ What would you do if you had a million dollars? ”的
问与答来进行课堂教学和语言实践,要求学生初步学习虚拟条件句的结构用法。
学生分析
初三学生有比较丰富的语言积累和知识储备,他们有较强的求知欲和好奇心,在课堂上他们善于表现自我,乐于积极思考,敢于发表自己的观点,这些都有利于师生在课堂上能够进行交流。
教学目标
1. Language goals
(1)掌握虚拟条件句,注意动词的形式 。
(2)重要短语:buy snacks; buy a big house; put it in a bank; give it to charity;
give it to the zoo; give it to medical research
(3)熟练句型:If I had a million dollars, I’d give it to charity.
(4)掌握对话:
A:What would you do it you had a million dollars?
B:I would give it to medical research.
2.Ability goals
Enable the students to understand and talk about imaginary situations.
3.Emotion & attitude goals
What is the others’ attitude toward money?
How do they deal with worries /problems?
教学重点
Talk about imaginary situations,worries/problems.
教学难点
The structure: I would/I’d do
教学方法
采用听说法,口语法,情景法,交流法,语言翻译法,等多种方法进行教学。
学法指导
充分发挥教师良好的示范作用,注重教师在课堂中对学生无意识的影响,培养学生良好的语言表达习惯。
教学准备: 多媒体
教学过程
Step1.Warming-up
Use a song“If you are happy.”to ask students discuss:“If you are happy, what will you do ?”
Step 2.Lead-in
用一幅“钱”的图片导入,引发学生讨论:“What will you do if you have one hundred dollars?”
T: What will you do if you have one hundred dollars?
S1: I will buy some beautiful clothes.
S2: I will buy a dictionary.
Step 3. Presentation
用比尔盖茨引出新句型 What would you do if you had a million dollars?
A:What would you do it you had a million dollars?
B:I would give it to charity.(让学生讨论)
Exercise : (给出图片,并练习句型。这个环节学生的答案更加丰富多彩。)
If I had a million dollars, I would __________________________________.
Step 4. Consolidation]
1. Conclusion the grammar.
Show 2 sentences. Let them compare and conclude the grammar.
What will you do if you have one yuan ? If I have one yuan, I will…
What would you do if you had a million dollars? If I had a million dollars, I would…
2.Subjunctive Mood (虚拟语气)
(1).通过让学生找出自己造的if条件句与以前所学if条件句的不同引出虚拟语气。(我真的有一百万吗?没有。 所以虚拟语气表示与事实相反。主句用would+动词原形,从句用一般过去时。而以前的if条件句用“主将从现”)
定义:虚拟语气用来表示说话人所说的话不是客观存在的事实,而是一种愿望、可能、猜测、建议、要求或假设等。
(2).出示名人图片,引出 If I were you, I would ______________.
Step 5. Listening practice
Teacher: Now open your books, and turn to page26. number the orders.Ask students to complete 1a 、 1b、 2a、2b.
Step6. Pairwork
2c
Step 7. Summary
(1) Phrases
把钱捐给慈善机构 give it to charity
把钱捐给动物园give it to the zoo
把钱用于医学研究 give it to medical research
把钱存入银行 put it in a bank
给家里买个大房子 buy a big house for my family
(2) Sentence structures : I would…if I had…虚拟语气,表示与现在事实相反。
主句用would+动词原形,从句用一般过去时.
Step 8.Do some exercise
( )1. If I _______ a teacher, I would be strict with my students。
A. amB. was C. wereD. will be
( ) 2. I will go to meet you , if I ______free then .
A. would be B. will beC. am was
( ) 3. I don’t know if he _______ tomorrow . If he ______, I’ll tell you .
A. will come ; comes B. comes ; comes C. comes ; will D. is coming ; is coming
( ) 4. If I _____a lot of money , I ______a big house at once .
A. have ; buy B. had ; would buy C. had ; bought D. have ; am buying
( ) 5. The school is very big , there are two ______teachers there , and it has ______students.
A. hundreds ; thousands B hundred ; thousands of C. hundreds ; thousands of D. hundred;thousand
( )6. I don’t think it _______snow tomorrow .
A. does B. is going C. will D. would
( )7. He asked me if I ______help him.
A. can B. will C. am going to D. could
Step 9:homework.
If you were the headmaster in your school, what would you do? Write four sentences or an article in 80 words .
教学反思
1. 学生对真实条件和非真实条件的区分并没有预想的那样难,比较轻松的进入了虚拟语气的学习。
2. 整节课都能顺利的按计划实施,但在谈论有很多钱要做什么时,大部分学生想做的事都是物质方面的享受,比较少对社会和他人的关注。这表明现在的学生虚荣心强,奉献意识弱,在教学中我特意强调有钱了也不能只顾自己,还要帮助他人和社会。
3. 通过使用语言与他人进行讨论和交流,从而对涉及的语法知识进行归纳和总结,这一教学方法比枯燥的讲语法理论的效果要好,学生学得也比较轻松。
本节课的不足之处在于各个环节教学时间分配不均,教授生词花的时间过多,以至于后面的句型操练时间不足,没能使学生人人开口练习。今后在课堂教学中,一定得注意,避免前松后紧的现象出现。测试评价:单项选择
九年级英语上册教案(篇5)
冀教版英语九年级上册说课稿 Lesson 1: Higher, Faster, Stronger
作为一位杰出的老师,时常要开展说课稿准备工作,说课稿有助于学生理解并掌握系统的知识。那么问题来了,说课稿应该怎么写?以下是小编整理的冀教版英语九年级上册说课稿 Lesson 1: Higher, Faster, Stronger,希望能够帮助到大家。
我说课的内容是冀教版初中英语第五册Unit1 The Olympics Lesson 1: Higher, Faster, Stronger.下面我主要从教材分析、教学方法、学法指导和教学过程等四个方面作具体的说明。
一、教材分析:
本单元的中心话题是The Olympics,而第29界奥运会去年在北京举行,学生对奥运会很感兴趣,这就为学好本课提供了保障。本课是本单元的第一课时,题目是“更高,更快,更强”,既是奥林匹克的口号,也是国际奥委会对所有参与奥林匹克运动的人们的号召,号召他们本着奥林匹克的精神奋力向上。本课课文围绕着“奥运会的起源,发展以及奥运选手”而展开的。学生通过本课学习掌握一些与奥运会有关的单词、短语和句型。使学生更加了解有关奥运会的常识,培养他们为国争光的爱国情感;在学习中发扬“更快、更高、更强”的奥运精神。
根据《英语课程标准》的要求、教材特点以及我校九年级学生的实际情况,我将本课时的教学目标及重难点确定如下:
知识与技能:
1、学习并掌握有关奥运的词汇及短语:modern, gold, record, event, twentieth, win a gold medal. ancient, medal, shooting, athlete, silver, bronze, sprint.
2、能听懂、读懂有关奥运话题的语段。
3、能够谈论奥运会的起源、运动项目及自己喜欢的运动员。
过程与方法:
1、利用北京奥运会主题歌及精彩的奥运图片导入新课,创设情境,激发学生兴趣。
2、通过分组学习,使学生加深对课文的理解程度,培养学生自主学习、合作探究的能力。
3、通过学习中外著名运动员的经历,培养学生的竞争意识。
情感态度与价值观:
在学习中,敢于用英语来表达自己的'看法,培养学习英语的兴趣和学好英语
的勇气,乐意了解异地文化。通过了解著名的奥运人物,增强为国争光和努力、勤奋、拼搏的意识,培养爱国情感,发扬自强不息的精神,为实现自己的理想而奋斗。
教学重点和难点:
1、正确理解课文,对奥运会有更充分的了解,并能用英语表达相关的单词,短语和句子。
2、用英语描述奥运会及奥运风云人物。
二、教学方法:
为了体现《英语课程标准》的理念,更好地突出重点、突破难点。本节课主要采用任务型教学方法(Task-based Language Teaching),以三个任务为核心,引导学生在做和玩的过程中学习英语,体验成功,感受英语学习的乐趣,培养学生的团队意识,提高学生的主动性和参与性,使学生成为课堂的真正主人。同时、采用多媒体辅助教学,更好地激发学生的学习兴趣。通过歌曲、图片等为学生创设生动活泼的语言环境,激发他们学习的欲望。
三、学法指导:
美国著名心理学家布鲁纳说过:“对学生的最好刺激乃是对所学教材的兴趣。”在设计本节课时我适当整合了部分内容,以任务为核心、以学生为主体,倡导自主学习、合作学习,在课堂教学中引导学生进行小组讨论、猜测游戏、竞赛等与他人合作,鼓励学生通过感知、体验、实践、参与与实践等方式,积极思考,实现任务的目标,感受成功的喜悦。
四、教学过程:
本节课以任务型语言教学为原则,设计了三个主要任务:一个是The history of the Olympics.第二个是Olympic sports.第三个是Your favourite Olympic ath- lete.
Task One:The history of the Olympics.
在这个任务中,首先播放由刘欢、莎拉·布莱曼演唱的北京奥运主题歌《我和你》,学生在老师的带领下随着歌声的旋律,能自然地联想到奥运场景,通过三个问题,引出本节课的课题——Higher, Faster, Stronger、歌曲引入营造了热烈的课堂气氛,让学生在不经意中积极发言、探讨问题,为后续活动打下基础。紧
接着分组讨论Think about it中的问题,然后引导学生欣赏一组奥运会的图片并学习本课的生词和短语,再听录音,回答关于奥运会起源的问题,将孤立的单词和图片相结合,便于学生接受,并创设问题情境,引发学生认知需要。最后各小组作出汇报。整个任务由易到难,层层深入,充分调动学生的眼、耳、口、手、脑等各个器官,学生在愉快的氛围中锻炼了听和说的能力。
Task two: Olympic sports.
首先带领学生欣赏奥运比赛的精彩图片,把Task One和Task two连接起来。然后分组讨论奥运项目,再进行竞赛,说出项目最多的小组获胜,学生对于体育项目有着浓厚的兴趣,表现欲很强,在讨论和竞赛时,不但能踊跃地说出图片中的运动项目,而且还能说出图片中没有的项目。最后做猜测游戏,教师先做一个项目的示范,学生猜测名称,再由学生轮流做动作,其余学生猜。给学生提供展示才能的舞台,把整个课堂推向高潮,学生感受到学习英语的乐趣,从而有效地培养他们的语言运用能力。
Task three: Your favourite Olympic athlete.
为了避免对课文内容的单纯讲解,充分培养学生自主学习的能力,检查学生个体的阅读能力,在这个任务开始时,让学生带着问题自己默读课文并回答,然后引导他们分小组谈论自己最喜欢的奥运明星,最后通过调查找出哪些同学喜欢的奥运明星相同。同学间加强了了解,增进了友谊。,
在课堂小节时,先播放全文录音,让学生从整体上回顾本课。之后学生自己说出奥运会的起源、项目以及奥运明星,教师点评补充,布置作业,加深学生对课文内容的理解,达到巩固提高的目的。
九年级英语上册教案(篇6)
hear from sb.=receive/ get a letter from sb.
work well in doing sth.做某事方面很有功效
be short of 缺乏……
one of the greatest problems 最大问题之一
1.We got lost and couldn’t find each other. 我们走失了,互相找不到对方。
2.It seems that their living conditions were not very good. 似乎他们的生活条件不是很好。
3.It is possible that Kangkang’s father was the only child in his family.
康康的父亲有可能是他家中的独生子。
4.One answer is known as the one-child policy. 其中一项众所周知的措施是独生子女政策.
5.And even though we have made a lot of progress, we have big pollution problems in the
city. 虽然我们已经取得了很大的进步,但是仍存在严重的城市污染问题。
already “已经”(多用于肯定陈述句)。
如:He has already gone home. 他已经回家了。
yet “已经; 还”(用于否定句或疑问句)。
如:Have you found him yet? 你已经找到他了吗?
I haven’t finished my homework yet. 我还没完成作业。
※ already 也可用于疑问句,表“出乎意料或惊奇”
Have you finished your homework already? 难道你已经完成作业了?
ever “曾经”(多用于疑问句,问初次经历)。
如:I have ever been abroad. 我曾出过国。
never“从未;从来不”(多用于否定陈述句),常回答ever的句型。
如:I have never seen him before.
----Has he ever been abroad? 他曾出过国吗?
----No, never. 不,从来不。
just “刚刚”(多用于肯定句,位于谓语动词之前)。
如: I have just tried to call you. 我刚刚打电话给你。
before “之前”(一般位于句末;常与never呼应)。
如:He says he has never seen such beautiful scenery before.
1.---- I really hate to go shopping. 我真讨厌去购物。
---- So do I . 我也是。
So do I .为倒装句,表示前面提到的肯定情况也同样适合另外一个主体,表“某某也一样”,结构为“so + be /情态动词/ 助动词 + 主语”。
如:Jim is a student, so is Tom. 吉姆是一名学生,汤姆也是。
Jim can swim, so can Tom. 吉姆会游泳,汤姆也会。
Jim likes sports, so does Tom. 吉姆喜欢运动,汤姆也喜欢。
如表前面不怎样,后面“也不”怎样时,其结构为“ neither/ nor + be /情态动词/ 助动词 + 主语”。
如:Jim wasn’t Chinese, neither/ nor were they. 吉姆不中国人,他们也不是。
Jim can’t speak Japanese, neither can I . 吉姆不会说日语,我也不会。
Jim didn’t go there, neither did I . 吉姆没去那儿,我也没去。
如前后两句表达的是同一个主体,则不能倒装,表“的确如此”。
如:Jim is a good student. So he is. 吉姆是一名好学生,的确如此。
Jim swims well. So he does. 吉姆游泳很好,的确如此。
2.At that time, China was the country with the largest population in the world.
那时,中国是世界上人口最多的国家。
population为不可数名词,表示人口的多少只能用 “large”或 “small”修饰,提问人口用“what”.
如:The population of Shanghai is larger than that of Beijing. 上海的人口比北京多。
What’s the population of China?= How many people are there in China?
中国的人口有多少?
3. Great changes have taken place in China. 中国发生了巨大变化。
take place 指必然性的“发生”或有计划、安排之内的“举行”。
如:The meeting will take place next Friday. 会议将在下周五举行。
happen 指偶然的、没有预料的“发生“,其结果往往给人带来不幸或麻烦。
如:The accident happened yesterday. 事故发生在昨天。
※两者都不用于被动语态。
如:The population has increased a lot. 人口增长发很多。
4.increase 可作及物动词也可作不及物动词。其含义是“增长,增加,加强”等。
increase by… 指“增加了……”; increase to…指 “增加到……”
5. and about one fifth of the people in the world live in China.
而且世界上大约五分之一的人口生活在中国。
one fifth 是分数表达法。英文分数表达法:分子为基数词,分母为序数词,先读分子后读分母。当分子大于1时,分母的序数词则变为复数,直接在词尾加“s”。
如:one fourth四分之一three fourths 四分之三one second二分之一two thirds三分之二
6.It has worked well in controlling China’s population.
它在控制人口数量方面取得了显著的功效。
work well in doing sth. 表“在……方面很有功效”, 如:
如:Doing eye exercises works well in protecting our eyesight.
做眼保健操在保护视力方面很有功效。
7. Because of our large population, we are short of energy and water.
be short of… 表 “缺乏……”
如:She is always short of money at the end of every month. 每个月底她总是缺钱。
be short for… 表“是……的缩写”.
如:TV is short for television. TV是television的缩写形式.
8. Can all Chinese families offer their children a good education?
所有的中国家庭都能给他们的的孩子提供良好的教育吗?
offer 表“(主动)给予, 提供”
offer sb. sth. “提供某人某物”.
如:I offered him a glass of wine. 我敬了他一杯酒。
offer to do sth. “(主动)提出做某事”
如:She offered to cook for her mother. 她提出帮她妈妈煮饭。
I can’t go shopping in big stores unless I travel for a couple of hours.
我得花几个小时,才能到大的商场购物。
9. unless = if not 表“除非…; 如果不”,引导条件状语从句。
如:I won’t go unless I hear from you. = I won’t go if I don’t hear from you.
如果你不通知我,我就不去。
Unless Bill studies hard, he’ll fail in the exam. 如果比尔不努力, 他不会通过考试的.
10. a couple of… 表 “几个人或几件事”.
如:a couple of years ago 几年前; a couple of students 几个学生
如: a couple of watches 两只手表; five couples of cats 五对猫
11.pair 指两件不可分开使用的东西,它们可指两件互不相连的东西(鞋子、袜子等),也可指
两部分构成的一件东西(裤子、剪刀等)。
如:a pair of shoes 一双鞋子a pair of pants 一条裤子
( )1.-They have been to Australia.
-So _____ I.
A. do B. have been C. did D. have
分析:D 此句为so引导的完全倒装句。其含义为“A如此,B也如此。”其结构是so+be/助动词/情态动词+主语。本句为完成时态,其助动词是have。故选D。
( )2.The population of Shanghai is larger than _____ of Shenyang.
分析:A 此句要用相同成分即上海的人口和沈阳的人口做比较。因为population是不可数名词,所以用that代替。如果是复数名词则要用those来代替。
( )3.-_____ the population of the U.S.A. in ?
-It _____ about 296 million.
C. How many is; was D. How many was; is
分析:B 问人口的多少用what而不用how many。本题问的是的人口, 故为过去时态。
( )4._____ of the teachers are women in our school.
A. Two third B. Two threes C. Two thirds D. Second three
分析:C分数的表达法是基数词在前表示分子,序数词在后表示分母;当分子大于1时,表示分母的序数词要加s。
( )5.He’s read this book before, _____?
A. hasn’t he B. doesn’t he C .isn’t he D. wasn’t he
分析:A 本题考查反义疑问句反问部分的时态与人称的单复数要与陈述部分一致的用法。
( )6.The _____ population may be the greatest challenge of the world today.
A. increase B. increased C. increasing D. increases
分析:C 本题考查increase的现在分词作定语的情况,表示“正在增长的”。increased是它的过去分词也可作定语,但表示的是“已增长过的”。
( )7.The little girl has _____ finished reading the book you lent her.
A .already B. yet C. still D. once
分析:A already“已经”,常用覨t now.
分析:C 上句为否定情况,应用neither/nor+助动词+主语,表示“我也未参观过造纸厂”。
1. ---No one likes “Little Emperors.” ---N___________ do my parents.
2. The cars in the cities are i____________ rapidly these days, so traffic jam comes into being.
3. People couldn’t live long because of poor medical t________________.
4. In China, some people in less developed areas p__________ boys to girls.DA被动语态。根据题中changes是复数,答句用完成时态。故选B。
( )9.Students today have a lot of pressure(压力) _____ they have to learn too much knowledge at school.
A. in order to B .unless C. because D .because of
分析:C in order to和because of后面不能接从句,unless不符合题意。故选C,用because。
( )10.-I have never visited a paper factory.
A. So have I. B. So I have. C. Neither have I. D.I haven’t now.
分析:C 上句为否定情况,应用neither/nor+助动词+主语,表示“我也未参观过造纸厂”。
1. ---No one likes “Little Emperors.” ---N___________ do my parents.
2. The cars in the cities are i____________ rapidly these days, so traffic jam comes into being.
3. People couldn’t live long because of poor medical t________________.
4. In China, some people in less developed areas p__________ boys to girls.
5. His mother told him that the sun r__________ in the east and sets in the west.
1.We must ___________ ___________ (采取措施) to control the population.
2. Doing eye exercises ____________ __________ (起明显作用) in protecting our eyesight.
3. In 1960s, we were ________ _________ (缺乏) food and money .
4. He wouldn’t leave the TV set, __________ ___________ (既使) he was going to have an important exam the next day.
5.Her daughter __________ __________ (迷路) in the shopping center yesterday.
1.中国人口有多少? 中国有大约13亿人口。
_______ the _________ _______ China ? China ______ a population of ______1.3 billion.
2. 为什么中国要实施独生子女政策? 虽然跟以前比,中国人口增长放慢了,但人口问题依然严峻。
---Why does China _________ __________ with its __________ policy ?
---___________ its population is __________ _________ slowly than before, its population problem _________ ___________ quite ___________.
3. 这所学校里老师的数量是300人,其中四分之一是女教师。
_________ ___________ of the teachers in the school __________ 300, _________ ___________ of them ___________ women teachers.
4. 上周石油的价格增长了百分之二。 的确如些。
The price of oil ___________ ___________ 2% last week.
__________ _________ _____________.
5. 你生活在哪种家庭,是大家庭,还是小家庭?
_________ _________ of family are you ________, ________ family or _______ family ?
( ) 1. Two thirds of the surface of the earth ____ covered with water.
( ) 2. The number of workers in this factory _____ increasing.
( ) 3. ---It seems to me that you are very hard-working, Maria.
---I have to. I have a lot of _____ from my family and society.
A. time B. efforts C. pressure
( ) 4. ---______ have you done with the waste ?
---I have thrown it away.
( ) 5. ---Which country has a ____ population, England or Germany ?
( ) 6. About one fifth of the people in the world _____ in China.
A. live B. is living C. has lived
( ) 7. ---Excuse me, is Joan in ?
---Sorry, she isn’t here. She ___ to the airport to see her parents off half an hour ago.
A. went B. has gone C. has been
( ) 8. ---Who will go to the airport to meet Jenny ?
---I will. I _____ her several times. I can find her easily.
A. met B. have met C. will meet
( ) 9. We are tired. We have studies for ____ hours.
A. a couple B. couple C. a couple of
( ) 10. The more excellent our public transportation is, _____ our life will be.
A. the happier B. the more happy C. the more happily
( ) 11. ---What did Jeff say about the lost girl ?
---He said that he had seen her _______.
A. three days agoB. three days before C. for three days
( ) 12. ---Dad, my teacher said I had made a lot of progress recently.
---I’m glad to hear that. But I think you still _______.
A. have a long way to go B. have a rest C. live in the present
( ) 13. ---I went swimming last Sunday.
---_________. I like it very much.
A. So I do B. So I did C. So did I
( ) 14. ---We haven’t been to the Great Wall. ---_________.
A. So has she B. Nor she has C. Neither has she
( ) 15. ---Did you know _______?
---They had a quarrel about the answer to the question.
A. what did they happen B. what happened to them C. what they happened
1. Neither 2. increasing 3. treatment 4.prefer 5. rises
1. take measures 2. works well 3. short of 4. even though 5. got lost
1 What’s the population of, has, about / around
2. carry on, one-child, Though, growing more, still seems , serious
3. The number, is, a quarter, are
5. What kind/ sort / type, in, extended, nuclear
1----5 ABCBA 6----10 AABCA 11----15 BACCB
九年级英语上册教案(篇7)
目标本学期的主要目标是让学生能够用英语描述我的家乡,家乡的变化情况。人口问题,让学生了解我国是世界上人口最多的国家,用英语谈论实行计划生育的重要性。第三单元是环保问题,让学生掌握如何保护环境,即how to improve envirinment .第四单元关于电脑的利与弊,中学生用太多的电脑对学习有一定的影响,教育学生要适当地用电脑。学生掌握现在完成时,have been to/have gone
教学效果良好,学生能够用英语写我的家乡,人口问题, 环境保护问题,电脑问题,能够用现在完成时写句子与文章,能够用以上的话题进行简单的对话及讨论,能够运用现在完成时。掌握了have been to/ have gone to 的用法,能用定语从句造句,也掌握了本学期的重点内容之一就是eithe…or neither.. nor的用法。教学存在不足在实际教学中没能充分重视词汇教学,词汇教学方法偏于机械、简单,形成了一种只重视词汇简单拼读记忆,轻视词汇情境应用的词汇教学方法。导致一些学生会写单词,但不注重单词的形式词汇的灵活运用能力较差。 对英语听力未能给予足够重视,听力材料少、部分学生缺乏听力题中应有的答题技巧。学生的阅读量、阅读难度、阅读速度远远不适应考试对阅读能力的要求,写作训练少。今后教学改进措今后要依托词汇教学, 突出语言运用。强化阅读训练,努力培养语感。加大书面表达训练力度,提高写作技能。优化课堂教学,积极创设情景,加强口语交流。树立信心,明确目标,采取灵活多变的教学方法。总之,我会拿出三个月的时间、拿出十分的力气磨练自己,精心备课,精心上课,认真总结。争取在中考中取得优良的成绩,在竞争中立于不败之地,为学校争光添彩。
九年级英语上册教案(篇8)
I. 重点词组
1. get lost 迷路
2. each other 彼此
3.at least 至少
4take place发生
5because of 因为
6.be strict with sb. 对某人严格要求
7.carry out 实行
8.be short of 缺乏
9.take measures to do sth.采取措施做某事
10.be known as… 作为……而著名
well in doing…在……方面起作用
12.a couple of 一些
13keep up with赶上,跟上
II.重点句型
1. Have you found him yet? 你已经找到他了吗?
2. ——I really hate to go shopping. 我的确讨厌购物。——So do I.我也如此。
3. But it seems that their living conditions were not very good.但是似乎他们的生活条件不太好。
4. But great changes have already taken place in China recently.但是近来中国已发生了巨大的变化。
5. Because of the one-child policy, now most families have only one child.
由于我国独生子女政策的实行,现在大部分家庭只有一个孩子。
6. What’s the population of the U.S.A.?美国的人口是多少?
7. ——What’s more, the population in developing countries is growing faster. ——So it is.
而且,发展中国家的人口在更快地发展。 的确如此。
8. Our government has taken many measures to control the population.
我们的政府已采取了许多控制人口的措施。
III.语法:
常用于现在完成时的时间状语:already, just , yet, ever, never, recently.
e.g. 1. I have just called you.
2. ——Have you ever been to France? ——No, I’ve never been to any European countries.
3. ——Have you seen him yet? ——Yes, I have seen him already.
九年级英语上册教案(篇9)
i like music that i can dance to.
学习目标:
1. 学会表达自己对某人或某物的喜爱和理由。
2. 能对自己看过书和电影,听过的cd进行评述。
4. prefer... to... 比...更喜欢...
11. be lucky to do sth 很幸运...
三、日常用语
1. rosa likes music that’s quiet and gentle.
2. --- what kind of music do you like?
---i like music that i can sing along with.
3. --- what kind of singers do you love?
--- i love singers who write their own music.
4. ---why do you like this cd?
---this music is great because you can dance to it.
section a:
1. i like music that i can sing along with. 我喜欢可以跟着唱歌的音乐。
sing along with the music 和着音乐一起唱,类似的还有:
2. i prefer music that has great lyrics. 我比较喜欢歌词好的歌曲。
prefer v. 更喜爱,更喜欢.相当于like very much. 具体用法如下:
(1)prefer + n. (名词),例如:
i prefer groups that play quiet and gentle songs. 我更喜欢演唱轻柔音乐的组合。
jennifer prefers musicians who write their own lyrics.
(2)prefer to do sth 宁愿做某事,例如:
i preferred to stay behind rather than go with you.
我宁愿留下来不愿和你们去。
she preferred to write to him rather than telephone him.
她宁愿给他写信也不愿给他打电话。
(3)prefer sth to sth 比…更喜欢…, (此句型中的to是介词,后接名词、代词或动名词) 相当于like a better than b.意为 “喜欢a,不喜欢b;宁愿a,不愿b” 使用这个句型,最重要的原则就是“前后一致”,也就是说,prefer和to后面的部分,不论词性、形式都要相同。例如:
i prefer fish to meat. 我喜欢鱼,而不喜欢肉。(prefer名词to名词)
九年级英语上册教案(篇10)
Unit 1 The Changing Word
Topic 1 My hometown has become more and more beautiful.
SectionA
【学习目标】
1.掌握现在完成时的构成,初步了解其用法,并学会运用have/has been to 和have/ has gone to 结构:
2.比较并找出一般过去时与现在完成时的不同用法;
3.学会描述假期生活。
【预习案】
一、读1a,完成1b的表格所缺的地点
二、 在文中找到,划出并背诵下面的短语和句子
1.变化的世界________________________________ 9.一个合适的地方________________10.拍照________
2.长假过后__________________________________ 11.提高我的英语水平__________________________
3.度过一个愉快的暑假________________________ 12.顺便问一下___________13.根据1a的内容________
4.从…回来__________________________________ 14.孩子们的假期经历__________________________
5.巨大的变化_________________6.发生____________ 15.查出…和…的不同__________________________
7.越来越漂亮________________________________ 16.填空_____________________17.感觉舒服________
8.如此(那么)多的人___________________________ 18.患感冒______________19.很长时间_____________
【探究案】
一、 语法重点导入--- (根据句意在横线上填入谓语动词的适当形式)
1. He ______________ (play) soccer on the playground now.
2. He ______________ (play) soccer on the playground yesterday.
3. He ______________ (play) soccer on the playground when I saw him yesterday.
4. He ______________ (play) soccer on the playground every day.
5. He ______________ (play) soccer on the playground tomorrow afternoon.
6. He ______________ (play) soccer on the playground 注意(6)句中的时间状语,看P118现在完成时讲解, 总结现在完成时用法
总结:
(1) 现在完成时中谓语动词的形式是---________________________ 看P140-142过去分词表,做P3---1b
(2) 经常搭配的时间副词有: just, already, yet, ever, never, before…
(3) 现在完成时句型转换
写出(6)句的否定句:___________________________________________________________________ 写出(6)句的一般疑问句并肯定回答:_____________________________________________________ 写出(6)句的划线提问句:_______________________________________________________________ 写出(6)句的反意疑问句:_______________________
(4) 观察1a中出现的现在完成时的句子并翻译理解
1. You have just come back from your hometown. 译:_________________________________________________
2. Great changes have taken place there. 译:_________________________________________________________
3. My hometown has become more and more beautiful. 译:_____________________________________________
4. Where have you been? I have been to Mount Huang with my parents. 译:________________________________
5. Where’s Maria? She has gone to Cuba to be a volunteer. 译:___________________________________________
(5) 现在完成时考点:have / has been to --- have / has gone to
练习:参看P118现在完成时讲解,完成P2(2)
区别:have / has been to表示曾经______________,现在_____________;
have / has gone to表示已经______________,现在______________.
二、在文中划出下面的句子并分析
注意: taken是take的______________形式
点拨:change有名词/动词两种词性,名词词意是_________/__________等; 动词词意是_________
1take place --- 发生、举办,指非偶然性事件的―发生‖,即这种事件的发生一定有某种原因或事先的安排 区别:happen --- 发生、碰巧,一般用于偶然或突发性事件
注意:take the place of…--- 取代某人的`位置
练习:a. Jason ___________________________ Miss Li to teach us French next term.
b. The Olympic Games of 2008 ________________________ successfully in Beijing.
c. What ___________________________ to you yesterday?
’思考:so…that…意思是__________,引导_______状语从句 区别:so that…意思是_______,引导_______状语从句 练习:a.为了拍照,他爬得很高。____________________________________________________________________ b.他他爬得那么高,以至于能拍照。____________________________________________________________
3. There goes the bell. 译:_____________________________ 思考:这是个there提前引起的__________句 回忆:副词here, there 提前到句首要引起主谓倒装,但是当主语为人称代词时不倒装。
练习:a. Here comes the No.31 Bus. 译:________________________b. There they are. 译:___________________
c. Jim跑过来了。译:___________________________ d.他跑过来了。 译:____________________________ 拓展:看课本P105注解写出(3)句的同义句a.__________________________ b.____________________________
【归纳】
一、 根据首字母提示完成单词,使句子完整通顺。
1. The b______ is ringing. Let’s begin our class.
2. She has made great p______ in English with the help of her teacher.
3. Miss Lin decided to help Mary as she f______ sorry for her.
4. By the w______, where’s your library?
5. I have been to an English training school to i______ my English.
二、 根据句意及汉语提示完成单词或短语。
1. We have just ______ (回来) from London.
2. They were very tired. I ______ (同情) for them.
3. We haven’t seen our English teacher ______ (很长一段时间).
4. Where is Lin Mei? I have ______ (告诉……一些事) her.
5. He ______ (已经去) New York, in the USA.
三、 用所给词的适当形式填空。
1. —Why is the room so clean?
—Because I ______ just ______ (clean) it.
2. Wang Hai spent a whole night ______ (work) on the computer.
3. They have no house ______ (live) in.
4. My father ______ (be) to the People’s Park many times, so he knows it very well.
5. I heard Lin Hong ______ (sing) a song when I went past.
2 / 195
SectionB
【学习目标】
1.继续学习现在完成时的用法;
2.比较新旧社会青少年的生活状况,启发同学们珍惜新社会的幸福生活。
【预习案】
一、读1a,回答下面的问题
1. Has Maria taken part in some volunteer activities during the summer holidays? __________________________
2. What has she done? _____________________________________________________________________________
3. What does she think of it? ________________________________________________________________________
二、 读2a, 完成2b
三、 在文中找到并划出下面的短语
1.参加…_______________________ 20.过着艰苦的生活______________________________
2.志愿者活动________________________________ 21.详细地描述…__________________________
3.在暑假期间________________________________ 22.支付他们孩子的教育经费______________________
4.残疾儿童__________________________________ 23.度过他们的童年______________________________
5.为…打扫房间______________________________ 24.为了…__________25.support their families________
6.喂他们吃饭____________7.为他们做饭___________ 26.做童工_________________________
8.一段美好的经历_______________________________ 27.日日夜夜_______________________
9.从…学到很多_________________________________ 28.足够的吃的__________________________________
10.the different forms of the verbs___________________ 29.现在的青少年________________________________
11.做一个关于…的调查__________________________ 30.飞速地发展__________________________________
12.make conversations_____________ 31.为贫困家庭提供帮助__________________________
13.跳绳______________14.网上聊天_______________ 32.受到很好的教育______________________________
15.暑假补课_________________________ 33.随着中国的发展______________________________
34.leisure activity___________35.a balanced diet______ 16.做农活___________________________
36.play musical instruments_____________ 17.一篇有关青少年的文章________________________
37.some other training__________________18.世界各地__________________19.过去___________
【探究案】
一、在文中划出下面的句子并分析
1. You have taken part in some volunteer activities during the summer holidays, haven’t you?
译:___________________________________________________________________
思考:haven’t you? 构成了句子的_____________部分
练习:根据时间状语的变化写出谓语动词的不同形式并完成后面的反意疑问句
a. He ____________(take) part in some volunteer activities during the last summer holidays, ________________? b. He ____________(take) part in some volunteer activities during the next summer holidays, ______________?
c. He ___________(take) part in some volunteer activities during the summer holidays every year, ________________? d. He must ________(take) part in some volunteer activities during the summer holidays every year, ______________?
2. What a wonderful experience! 译:________________________ 同义句:How _______________________ 感叹句转换练习:(根据P5---1a的图下提示词用what和how写感叹句)
a. 多么狭窄的公路啊!What______________________________! / How___________________________________! b. 多么艰苦的生活条件啊!What___________________________! / How__________________________________! 注意:如果对行为动词感叹,只能用How引导! c. 看!他跑得是多么快啊!_________________________________!
3. Though I had no time to travel, I still felt very happy. 译:_______________________________________________ 思考:你能将上句改为用but的形式吗?______________________________________________________________ 看课本P105注解并总结:though和__________引导______________从句,语气较弱,不与__________连用; ___________________和___________________也用于引导______________从句,带有强调的意味,语气较强。
4. Is that so? 译:________________________ 区别:Is that all? 译:________________________
链接:a. Do you think it’ll rain soon? I think so. 译:_____________________________________________________ b. Do you believe China will become No.1 in the world one day? I believe so. 译:________________________ 拓展:我希望如此___________________ 我猜是这样的____________________
注意:I hop not. _____________________ I don’t think so.____________________
5. In order to help support their families, they had to be child laborers.
思考:你能将上句改为…so that…形式吗?____________________________________________________________ 总结:in order to + 动词原形,在句子中做目的状语;so that 后面引导的是目的状语从句
练习:为了赶上早班车,他们起得很早。a.____________________________________________________________ b._________________________________________________________________________________________
【归纳】
一、 根据汉语提示完成句子,每空一词。
1. His parents couldn’t afford his ______ (教育).
2. The government gives ______ (帮助;赞助) to poor families.
3. With the ______ (发展) of China, many more children live a happy life.
4. I think we can ______ much ______ (向……学习) the farmers.
5. To make us understand what has happened, he told us about the accident ______ ______ (详细地).
二、 用所给词语的适当形式填空。其中一项是多余的。
describe, feed, though, article, education, develop
1. Li Ming failed in the exam again ______ he tried really hard.
2. China is the largest ______ country in the world.
3. The police asked her ______ the two men.
4. Mike, you come from the countryside. Have you ever ______ sheep?
5. In the past, many children couldn’t get a good ______.
三、单项选择。
1. —Have you ever been ______? —Yes. I have been to Australia.
A. abroad B. alone C. here D. healthy
2. —The radio says it’s going to rain. —______ Bad luck! We can’t go for our picnic.
A. Is that so? B. Thank you. C. Don’t worry. D. Pardon?
3. ______ it rains heavily, ______ farmers are still working in the fields.
A. Though; but B. Though; still C. Though; / D. Although; but
4. Athletes from more than 200 countries ______ the 2008 Olympic Games in Beijing.
A. took part in B. attended C. joined D. held
5. China is still a ______ country at the present time.
A. developed B. more developed C. highly developed D. developing
SectionC
【学习目标】
1.继续学习现在完成时;;
2.对比新旧北京,了解中国发生的重大变化;
3.同学们要珍惜现在的美好生活。
【预习案】
一、先看图,再读1a,完成1b(写出每段的段意)
二、 在文中找到并划出下面的短语
1. infer the main idea________________________ 18.接受良好的教育_____________________________
2. the key words______________3. at present_________ 19.与…保持联系_________________________(P105)
4. compare your idea with Kangkang’s_______________ 20.远方的亲戚_________________________________
5.狭窄的公路___________________________________ 21.通过书信和电报的方式________________________
6.又小又黑的房子_______________________________ 22.改革开放____________________________________
7.艰苦的生活条件_______________________________ 23.变得更加高大明亮____________________________
8.简洁而缓慢地通讯_____________________________ 24.改善很多____________________________________
9.宽阔的环形公路_______________________________ 25.享受更加多样的业余活动______________________
10.高大而明亮的楼房____________________________ 26.不但…而且…_______________________
11.舒适的生活条件______________________________ 27.在互联网上______________28.另外还有_________
12.more kinds, quick and easy communications 29.变得更加简单而快捷__________________________
___________________________________________ 30.传真机_________________31.等等…____________
13.my report on Beijing___________________________ 32.取得飞速的进步______________________________
14.四十多年____________________________________ 33.成功地举办奥运会_____________________
15.(她)亲眼目睹北京的变化______________________ 34.记住过去_________________________
16.在20世纪60年代____________________________ 35.立足现在_________________________
17.有机会干…__________________________________ 36.展望未来_________________________
【探究案】
一、在文中划出下面的句子并分析
1. Usually, a big family were crowed in a small house.
译:________________________________________________
点拨:crowd --- 拥挤, 挤,聚集(动词);人群,群众;一群(名词) crowded --- 拥挤的(形容词)
练习:a. There is a crowd of people in the hall.
译:________________________________________________
b. He succeeded in crowding into the train.
译:______________________________________________
c. Look! A crowd of ants are crowded in the hole.
译:_________________________________________
注意:拥挤的交通不能直译为 crowded traffic, 而是__________ /___________traffic
2. Life was so hard that people had no time or money to enjoy leisure activities.
思考:你能将上句改为too…to形式吗?yjS21.coM
Life was _______ ______ ______ people ______ ______ time _______ money to enjoy leisure activities.
提高:The bed is so small that Tom can’t sleep well on it.
_____________________________________________
3. China has developed rapidly since the reform and opening-up.
译:_________________________________________
九年级英语上册教案(篇11)
Language Focus:
Words: dinosaur, display, natural, guide, underground, fossil, desert, disappear, disappearance, discovery, feather
Phrases: on display, Gobi Desert, human being, dinosaurs discovered by you, feathered dinosaur
Sentences: So these eggs were laid long long ago by dinosaurs.
Teaching objectives:
Read the passage and try to understand its meaning.
Read it fluently and correctly.
Properties: Tape recorder; picture
Teaching Procedures:
2. Revise the useful expressions and some new words.
Take out a picture and ask the students:
What’s this animal called?
Ask some students to talk about the dinosaur.
Read over the questions with the students. Have the students guess the meaning of “on display” from the context. Then have the students discuss the questions in pairs.
1. At first, ask students to read over the questions in the Exercise 1 in the workbook.
2. Then close books and listen to tape.
3. Play the tape again and answer the questions.
*a visit to a place, be on a visit to a place
*guide; n. v. guide sb. to a place
*fossil, eg. He is an old fossil.
the fossil of…
*be laid by…
He disappeared in the dark. I care a lot about his disappearance.
*discover; discover sthhow to do sth. that…
*dinosaurs discovered by you;
eg: books borrowed by you, things done by you(过去分词含有被动意思)
the children playing in the park(现在分词含有主动意思)
Let the students find out these sentences with the Passive Voice in the Past Simple Tense.
Have the students make sentences with the Passive Voice in the Past Simple Tense.
Ⅷ. Workbook.
Do Exercise 2 , and write down the answers.
Read the passage.
Finish off the workbook exercises.
九年级英语上册教案(篇12)
一、学习目标:
知识目标:能正确使用Mdule 12中的单词和短语;
能力目标:能表述某一课程的情况;正确掌握主谓一致。
情感目标:通过了解其他国家暑期培训班、夏令营等相关信息,拓展视野。
二、重点、难点:
重点:
1. 应用本模块交际用语,如:Welce t…; Please give a ” I std up and englishcurse-suer.c.
试题答案
一、1. A 2. B 3. C
4. A 解析:the rest在此处指“其余的钱”,ne为不可数名词,因此the rest所指为单数意义,谓语动词要用单数。此外,“give sth. t sb.”的`被动形式为“sth. be given t sb.”,故选A。
5. B 6. D 7. B 8. C
9. D 解析:该题考查主谓一致。由nt nl…but als连接两个并列主语,其谓语动词的单复数形式同与其最靠近的主语保持一致,故谓语动词应用单数形式。又据句意“他们都还没有回来”,可知用has gne而不用has been。
10. A 解析:该题考查主谓一致。neither…nr是一组连词,可连接两个并列主语,其谓语动词应同最靠近它的主语I保持一致,因此选A。
11. A 解析:该题考查主谓一致。这个句子的主语是a nuber f deer,是一个复数概念,因此谓语动词应用复数形式。(deer的单复数同形)
12. B
13. D 解析:“分数或百分数+f+名词”构成的短语作主语时,其谓语动词的单复数形式要由f后的名词而定。One third f the是指“三分之一的学生”,f后的the是指学生,为可数名词的复数,故谓语动词要用复数。
14. B
15. C 解析:此句意为“当我来访时,他们全家人正在吃晚饭”,fail是指家里的每一个人,故谓语动词要用复数。
二、1~5 DABCD 6~10 AAABD
三、(A) CDADB (B) ABDBC
四、1. sunglasses 2. curse 3. bed 4. rest 5. prgress 6. experienced
7. Mer 8. relatinships 9. applicatin 10. activities
五、1. have taen place 2 give a 5
九年级英语上册教案(篇13)
1.aloud adv.出声地(使别人能听得到)朗读是学英语的一个好方法。
▲loud adj.大声的,声音洪亮的,loud—louder—loudest 他说话声音很大以便于每个人都能听得到他。▲adv.loud—louder—loudest don’t talk so loud.the kids are reading. 说话小声些,孩子们正在看书。(speak)louder,please!请再说高一些!▲loudly adv吵吵闹闹地,噪声地 我听到有人在使劲敲门。
they are talking loudly in the next room. 他们在隔壁说话声很大。她声音很甜美。
她提高了嗓音队便于别人能听清楚。因为咳嗽,他失声了。▲noise n噪音,吵闹 别弄出那么大的噪音。
i heard a strange noise outside. 我听到外边奇怪的声音。
▲sound n.(自然界中的)声音,响声 声音的传播比光慢。
3.memory n.(计算机的)储存器
a lot of information is stored in the memory. 计算机的储存器能储存很多信息。▲n.记忆力
车祸后他的记忆力很差了。▲n.回忆,怀念
我对童年有美好的回忆。
▲memorize/memorise vt.记住,背过 他能很快记住很多单词。
4.frustrate vt.使失望,使沮丧 他上大学的梦想遭受挫折。
▲frustrating adj.令人失望的 他所说的话很令人失望。
她觉得看英语电影很令人失望(因为看不懂)。▲frustrated adj.失望的,沮丧的 当他再次考试没及格后,他很失望。5.add vt.增加,加
she tasted the soup and added more salt. 她尝了尝汤,又加了些盐。▲add to 增添
他的到来给我们添了很多麻烦。
▲add up to 总计达„„,加起来„„ 我们班上学生的数目加起来是55人。▲vt.补充说,又说
他和我们说了再见,又说他会再来看我们的。我们队赢了的消息令所有的人很激动。那场足球赛很令人激动。
当听到那个消息,我们很激动。
7.speak(speak—spoke—spoken)说(语言),讲话 你会说法语吗? 你知道谁要在会上发言? 当我给他打电话时,他正在和他的朋友谈话。你们在说什么? ▲say 说(后接说的内容)他在会上说了什么? 她说下周回来。▲tell 告诉
tell sb sth 告诉某人某事(接双宾语)是谁告诉你的那个消息? ▲讲,说
tell stories讲故事,tell a lie撒谎,tell the truth说实话 我小的时候,奶奶经常给我讲故事。
don’t believe him!he is telling a tie. 别信他!他在撒谎。
老实说,我不太同意你的意见。▲adj.巧完整的,完全的 你会造完整的句子吗? 他对我来说完全是陌生的。
那时我们之间的秘密,所以不要告诉别人。▲adj.秘密的
咱们不让别人知道此事。泄露秘密。
10.impress vt.使感动,给„„深刻印象 他的事迹给在场的人留下了深刻的印象。那个国家的美景打动了我们所有的人。、、▲impressed adj.(被)感动的 我们被他的话所感动。
11.native n.当地人,本国人
我们在巴西度假时,就像当地人那样生活。the kangaroo is a native of australia. 袋鼠是产于澳洲的动物。
▲native speaker 生来就说某种语言的人
他的英语说得太好了,我们都认为他是个本地人。▲native language 母语
马克思出生在德国,法语是他的母语。important phrases(重点词组)2.first of all 首先
5.spoken english 英语口语 8.1ater on 以后;随后
10.native speakers 生来就说某种语言的人 11.not at ail 根本不;一点也不 12.end up 结束
14.make up 组成;编造
15.enjoy doing sth 喜欢做某事 16.take notes 做笔记 17.make mistakes 犯错误 19.read aloud 朗读
20.have trouble(in)doing sth 做某事有困难 你怎样准备考试? ▲study for a test prepare for a test 准备考试 一 昨天晚上我打电话时你在干什么? 一 我在准备数学测验。我听录音准备英语测验。
▲by 靠,用(方法,手段等),后接动名词(doing„)he makes a living by repairing bikes. 他靠修车为生。
▲listen vi.后加to再接名词。当我到家时,姐姐正在听音乐。听!有人在敲门。
他靠求助于老师来学习。
▲ask sb for help求助于某人
— 如果你有麻烦,你可以求助于我。一 谢谢。我会的。
你曾经和朋友练习过会话吗? ▲ever adv.用于疑问句和否定旬中,“曾经” 你担心考试会不及格吗? 听录音怎么样? 今晚去看电影怎么样? 靠朗读来练习发音怎么样? read aloud 朗读
reading aloud is very helpful in leaning english. 朗读在学英语中很有帮助。
▲a lot 代表一个不可数名词。例如: 他虽然很小,但他知道很多。别那样和父母说话。
8.it improves my speaking skills. 它能提高我的口语技巧。
▲improve vt.改进,改善,提高 他的工作在慢慢改进。他的发音大大提高了。▲speaking skill 口语技巧 listening skill 听力技巧 听懂不同的声音很困难。
▲too + adj./adv.+ to do “太„„而不能„„”。又如: 他太小,不能上学。她跑得太慢追不上我。
▲ask sb about sth 询问某人关于„„的情况
ask her about the pen that you lost.she may have found it. 问问她你丢的钢笔,也许她捡到了。谁能告诉我记单词的最好办法是什么? 她说记流行歌曲的歌词也有点帮助。教英语是我的工作。
▲a little有点,代表不可数名词,其反义词为a lot。你的咖啡里想加糖吗? 一yes.just a little. 好,要一点点。
12.he’s been learning english for six years and really loves it. 他学英语有六年了,并且很喜欢它。
▲“has/have been doing sth”现在完成进行时,表示从过去某一时间开始持续到现在,还要进行下去的动作。又如:
she has been learning english for 5 years. 她学英语有五年了。
he has been reading for 2 hours and hasn’t finished it yet. 他看书有两个小时了,但还没有完成。
他发现看英语电影很令人失望,因为人们说话太快。i like playing basketball. 我喜欢打篮球。
▲find sb/sth + n./adj./doing “发现某人„„”,后面的“n./adj./doing”作宾语补足语。又如:
我发现他是个勤奋的学生。我发现物理很难学。
当她到家时,她发现他躺在床上病了。她补充说和朋友练习会话一点帮助都没有。照看孩子们是她的工作。
▲not„at all 一点也不,用来加强语气,又如: 我一点也不同意他的意见。
我们会因为某件事变得很激动,最后用汉语来描述。▲end up达到某种状态或采取某种行动,又如:
at first he said nothing but he ended up apologizing. 一开始,他什么也不说,到头来还是道了歉。
我正在就关于学习英语作调查。我能问你几个问题吗? ▲do a survey about sth/doing sth 关于„„作调查 上周,我们就网上冲浪作了个调查。
▲some用于疑问句时,表示希望得到肯定回答,如果只是询问信息,可以用any代替some用于疑问句和否定句中。又如: 你能借给我些钱吗?(希望得到肯定回答)did you buy her any gifts? 你给她买礼物了吗?(询问信息)17.1 often keep an english notebook. 我经常记英语笔记。
▲keep vt.记录(某事),在某物上做书面记载 她写日记有20多年了。
i have the habit of keeping notes. 我有记笔记的习惯。
most of the students love reading. 多数学生喜欢看书。
19.1 make mistakes in grammar. 我在语法方面老犯错误。
▲make a mistake/make mistakes 犯错误 当说英语时不要怕犯错误。by mistake 错误地.
你知道炸薯片是被错误发明的吗? 我不知道怎样使用逗号。我不知道该做什么。你能告诉我何时出发吗? 你为什么不加入一个英语俱乐郝来练习说英语昵? 当交通很拥堵时,你为什么不骑白行车上学呢? ▲join加入某组织成为其中的成员,take part in参加某种活动,attend参加会议,报告,演讲等。例如:
his father joined the party in 1976. 他爸爸是1976年入的党。
工作之余人们经常参加体育活动。
i attended an important meeting yesterday. 昨天我参加了一个会。我没有同伴一起练习英语。老师有话要说。
he has no room to live in. 他没有房子住。
起初,对我来说听懂老师在班里讲话都不是件容易的事。▲first of all 最初,首先
first of all she just smiled,then she started to laugh. 最初她只是笑,后来才放声大笑。对我来说学好物理很难。
it is important to learn english.学英语很重要。
一开始,她说得太快了,我不能听懂所有的话。他起初没钱,可是后来相当富有了。
▲not„every + 可数名词单数 = not all + 复数名词表示部分否定“并非所有的”又如: 你没必要记住所有的字。不是所有的学生都住得离学校远。
后来,我意识到如果有些词听不懂没关系。▲later on 后来,以后
起初事情进展地很顺利,但后来他们遇到了麻烦。▲realize vt.意识到,认识到(有一个逐渐认识的过程),不用于进行时和被动语态。例如: 总有一天你会意识到你错了。
▲that引导的是realize的宾语从句,在宾语从句中又出现了if引导的条件状语从旬。例如:
如果你不会开车没关系。
我还害怕在班里发言,因为我怕同学会嘲笑我。
▲be afraid of sth/to do/of doing sth 害怕/不敢/恐怕做某事 i used to be afraid of the dark. 我过去常常怕黑。
she’s afraid to go/of going out alone at night. 她害怕夜晚独自出去。▲might 表示可能性
他可能知道她的电话号码,但我不确定。▲laugh at sb 嘲笑
it’s bad manners to laugh at people in trouble. 嘲笑陷入困境的人不礼貌。
我认为做大量的听力练习是成为一名好的语言学习者的秘诀之一。他是喜欢足球的学生中的一员。
另一个我发现很困难的东西是英语语法。▲that引导的是定语从句,修饰another thing,that在定语从句中作found的宾语。又如: 我能为你做点什么?(你买什么?)然后我用学过的语法造有独创性的句子。
▲start/begin to do sth = start/begin doing sth 开始做某事 真是不可思议了,这样做很有帮助。
▲it's amazing + 从句/to do sth “„„真是太惊奇了”。在国外遇到老朋友,真是太惊喜了。
现在我很喜欢英语,并在这学期得了个“a”。▲注意:“a”前边用不定冠词,选用冠词时要看字母的发音,即元音音素开头的用“an”。例如:
在单词“hour”里面,有一个“u”和一个“r”。她造完整的句子有困难。
▲have trouble in doing sth 做某事有麻烦/困难 he had trouble in understanding native speakers. 他听外国人说话有困难。
九年级英语上册教案(篇14)
学习目标
1.通过学习短文,掌握如何处理我们在学习、生活中遇到的问题和挑战。
2.掌握下列知识点:
■重点词汇:soft,unless,solve,regard,influence,friendship,lose,development
■重点短语:①look up ②write down ③make up ④deal with
⑤regard as ⑥be angry with ⑦go by ⑧as a second language
■重点句型:
①If you don't know how to spell new words,look them up in a dictionary.
②As young adults,it is our duty to try our best to deal with each challenge in our education with the help of our teachers.
预习导学
Ⅰ.预习单词,完成下列各词。
1.unfair(反义词)________ 2.friend(形容词________ 3.easy(副词)
4.important(反义词________ 5.agreement(反义词
Ⅱ.预习Reading部分,回答下列问题。
6.How do we deal with our problems
合作研讨
一、重点单词与短语
1.unless conj.如果不;除非
例如:l won't go to the party unless I am invited.
除非我受到邀请,否则我不会去参加晚会的。
【拓展】unless 作连词,引导条件状语从句,含有否定意义,相当于if...not...
【跟踪训练】
(1)You will fail the exam unless you work harder.(同义句转换)
You will fail the exam the exam ________ you ________ work harder.
2.regardv.将……视为
【拓展】regard...as...意为“把……当作……”,后接名词或形容词。
【跟踪训练】
(2)我们把老师当作的朋友。
We ________ our teachers ________ our best friends.
3.deal with处理;应对
例如:How do you deal with your challenges in your study
你如何处理学习中的挑战
【辨析】deal with/do with
deal with的同义短语为do with,意为“处理”。deal with与how连用;do with与what连用。
【跟踪训练】
例如:How do we deal with our problems(同义句转换)
Do we ________ ________ our problems
二、重点句型
1.If you don't know how to spell new words,look them up in a dictionary.
如果你不知道如何拼写生词,查一下词典。
【精解】①证引导条件状语从句,主句是一般将来时、祈使句或含有情态动词can、may等时,从句要用一般现在时。
【跟踪训练】
(4)如果明天下雨我就不去公园了。
I go to the park if it tomorrow.
【精解】②look up“动词+副词”短语,意为“查阅;查找”,若名词作宾语,可以置于副词叩之前或之后;若代词作宾语,只能置于look叩中间。例如:look the new words up=look up the new words查阅生词;look it/them up查阅。
【辨析】look up/look at
Look at“动词+介词”型短语,意为“看……”,名词或代词作宾语时,只能置于介词之后,而不能置于短语中间。
【跟踪训练】
(5)—His telephone number is 701-5538 —Have you
A. Written it down B. written down it C .written them down D. written down them
2.As young adults,“is our duty to try our best to deal with each challenge in
our education with the help of our teachers.
作为年轻人,在老师的帮助下尽努力来应对教育中的每一个挑战是我们的义务。
【精解】①It is +n./adj.(for sb.)to do sth.意为“做某事(对某人来说)是....”,其中北是形式主语,真正的主语是后面的动词不定式。
【跟踪训练】
(6)学好英语对我们来说不容易。
It’s not easy for us ________ ________ ________ ________ my teachers.
【精解】②with the help of sb.意为“在某人的帮助下”,同义短语为with one’s help。
【跟踪训练】
(7)I passed the exam with my teachers’ help(同义句转换)
I passed the exam ________ ________ ________ ________ my teachers.
当堂检测
Ⅰ. 根据句意及首字母提示完成单词
1.U ________ you tell me the truth,I won’t believe you.
2.My students r ________ me as their best friend.
3.EducatiOn is an important part of our d ________ .
4.P1ease go home. Your mother is w ________ about you.
Ⅱ.用所给单词的适当形式填空
5 .The math problem isn't difficult. I can work it out ________ (easy).
6.Though Stephen Hawking has many physical problems, he becomes very famous and (success).
7.Our ________ (friend)has 1asted for years.
8.He has failed four times,but he wanted to have a ________ (hive)time.
Ⅲ.根据汉语提示完成句子
9.昨天我妈妈生我气了。
My mother ________ ________ ________ me yesterday
10.保护环境是我们的责任。
to protect the environment.
11.我们应当把这个难题当作一次新的挑战。
We should ________ the problem ________ a new challenge.
Unit 2
Section B(1a—2c)
学习目标
1.谈论自己过去喜欢的事情。
2.掌握下列知识点:
■重点词汇:hate,candy,chew,gum
■重点短语:①walk to school ②on the soccer team ③all the time
④worry about ⑤chew gum
■重点句型:
We have to take the bus to schoo1.
■语法:反意疑问句
预习导学
Ⅰ.英汉短语互译。
1.步行去上学
2.chew gum
3.一直;总是
4.nt he soccer team
Ⅱ.预习Section Bla,1b,写出你小时候喜欢的事情。
5.I used to like
6.I used to
7.I used
合作研讨
一、重点单词与短语
1.hateu.讨厌;恨;不喜欢
例如:I used to hate music class.我过去讨厌音乐课。
【拓展】hate后跟名词、代词、动名词或不定式作宾语,同义词为dislike,反义词like。
【跟踪训练】
(1)他不喜欢在晚上开车
He hates________________at night.
2.chew.嚼;咀嚼
【跟踪训练】
(2)吃饭要细嚼慢咽。
You must________________your food well before you swallow it.
3.worry about担心;焦虑
【拓展】与be worried about同义
【跟踪训练】
(3)不要担心她。
Don'ther.
二、重点句型与语法
■句型
We have to take the bus to schoo1.
我们不得不乘公共汽车去上学。
【精解】①have to意为“必须;不得不”,后跟动词原形。
【辨析】have to/must
have to具有客观性,不以人的主观意志为转移;而must强调主观性。have to可以用于各种时态,而must则不能。
【跟踪训练】
(4)他不得不早起赶早班车。
Heget up early to catch the early bus。
(5)我们必须学好英语。
We________________learn English________________.
【精解】②take the bus意为“乘公共汽车”,“take+the+交通工具”,相当于“by+交通工具”。
【跟踪训练】
(6) go to school by bus every day.(同义句转换)
I ________________to schoo1 every day.
■语法
反意疑问句
反意疑问句,表示说话人提出某种情况或建议,询问对方是否同意。
(1)反意疑问句的结构
反意疑问句是由“陈述句+反意疑问部分”构成,其反意疑问部分的结构是:be动词/助动词/情态动词+主语。否定形式要用缩略形式。
①主句为肯定陈述句,反意疑问部分为否定形式,即“前肯后否”式。
【跟踪训练】
(7)You are a student,
②主句为否定陈述句,反意疑问部分为肯定形式,即“前否后肯”式。
【跟踪训练】
(8)He hasn't finished his homework,
(2)反意疑问部分的主语和谓语的确定
①反意疑问部分的主语用代词而不用名词。
【跟踪训练】
(9)My brother likes playing basketball,
②陈述句中含有否定意义的词,如little,few, never ,hardly,nothing,nobody等,其反意疑问部分用肯定形式。
【跟踪训练】
(10)He knows little English,
③陈述句是“there be”结构时,其反意疑问部分用“be+there。
【跟踪训练】
(11)There is a post office near the school,
④以Let's开头的祈使句,反意疑问部分为shall we;以Let us开头的祈使句,反意疑问部分为will you;主句为祈使句,反意疑问部分为will you。
【跟踪训练】
(12)Let's go home,
(13)Don't be late again,
⑤陈述句中含有情态动词must时,若must表示“必须”时,反意疑问部分用needn't。若must表示推测“一定;想必”之意时,其反意疑问部分的动词应根据must后面的动词来确定。
【跟踪训练】
(14)We must work hard,
(15)She must have finished her homework,
⑥当陈述句为含有宾语从句的主从复合句时,反意疑问部分的动词和主语通常与主句的动词和主语保持一致。若主句的主语是第一人称I/we,其谓语动词又是think,sup-pose,believe,imagine等,则反意疑问部分的主语和动词应与从句的主语和动词保持一致。
【跟踪训练】
(16)Tom said that he would visit China next month,
(17)I think she can solve the problem,
(3)反意疑问句的答语
应根据具体的语言环境确定用肯定回答或否定回答,即根据事实回答。对“前否后肯”式的反意疑问句的回答要注意其回答形式要一致,即肯定用Yes,后面的部分用肯定形式,Yes译为“不”;否定用No,后面的部分用否定形式,No意为“是的”。
【跟踪训练】
(18)—Your father isn't a doctor, is he -(不,他是).
当党检测
Ⅰ.根据句意及首字母或汉语提示完成单词
1.I used to c________________gum a lot. What about you
2.一Do you like________________(糖果) 一No,I don't.
3.Some students usually go to school on(步行).
4.She used to________________(讨厌)gym class.
5.He is a basketball P________________.
Ⅱ.根据汉语提示完成句子
6.I don't (担心)tests.
7.Li Lei often (乘公共汽车)to school.
8.She (不得不)look after her little brother because her mother isn't at home.
九年级英语上册教案(篇15)
(一)(学习目标)Language Goals
1. Talk about imaginary situations. (谈论一些假设的、虚拟的情况。)
2. Hypothetical Conditionals. (初步学习虚拟语气)
3. Give some advice with the target language. (使用虚拟句提出建议)
(二)语言结构(Language Structures)
1. 虚拟语气(掌握与现在事实相反或与将来事实相反的虚拟条件句)
(三)目标语言(Target Language)
1. If I were you , I’d wear a shirt and tie.
如果我是你,我就会穿衬衫打领带。
2. If I were you , I’d take an umbrella.
如果我是你,我就带把伞。
3. What would you do if you won a million dollars ?
如果你赚了一百万美元,你会做什么?
4. What if I don’t know anyone ?
如果我一个人也不认识怎么办?
5. You should eat lots of fruits and vegetable and drink lots of water.
你应该吃大量水果、蔬菜,大量喝水。
6. What are you like ? I think I’m outgoing.
你的性格如何?我想我很外向。
(四)Key phrases (重点词组)
1. won the lottery 赢得抽奖
2. in public 公共的、公众的
3. in the slightest 一点也;根本
4. plenty of 很多的、足够的
5. get along with 与…相处
6. let …down 使…失望、沮丧
7. come up with 提出、想出(问题)
8. medical research 医学研究
9. what if 如果…怎么办
10. be late for 迟到…
11. be nervous 紧张的
12. get nervous (变得)紧张的
13. take a long walk 散步
14. ask one’s permission 征求某人的许可
15. without permission 没得到许可
16. introduce oneself 自我介绍
17. rather than 而不是
18. a circle of good friends 朋友圈子
(五)语法重点(Grammar Focus)
虚拟语气
1. 语气就是我们常说的说话人说话的口气。
在汉语中,语气是由说话人说话的语调、情节等等表现出来的,动词没有任何变化。而在英语中,除了
语调之外,最主要的是动词发生变化而表示不同的语气。
在英语中语气分为三类:陈述语气、祈使语气、虚拟语气。
2. 虚拟语气:如果我们所说的不是事实,也不是要求、命令、劝告等,而只是一种假设、愿望、建议或
是一种实现不了的空想就用虚拟语气。
3. 虚拟语气常用在条件句中,及其他一些从句中。
注意:条件句分两种,真实条件句和虚拟条件句。只有在虚拟(非真实)条件句中,才用虚拟语气,而
在真实条件句中,要用陈述语气。
请比较:
(1)If it is sunny tomorrow , we’ll go to the zoo.
如果明天天气好,我们将会去公园。在这句话中,明天天气好是完全有可能实现的,并非虚拟、幻想,
因此是真实条件句。在本句中,适用“主将从现。”
(2)If I were you , I would go at once.
(如果我是你的话,我立刻就走。)在这句话中,条件句,“如果我是你”,但事实上,我不可能成为
你,这只是假设的情况,没有实现的可能。当条件实现的可能性很小,甚至可以说没有时,就需要用虚拟语
气来表示,动词发生了变化。
4. 在虚拟语气中,句子动词的时态比真实条件句中的时态后退一步
即:
现在时→过去时(该用现在时时,用过去时)
过去时→过去完成时(该用过去时时,用过去完成时)
将来时→过去将来时(该用将来时时,用过去将来时)
过去将来时→过去将来完成时(该用过去将来时时,用过去将来完成时)
在这一单元中,我们只要求初步接触虚拟语气的用法及结构,学习表示与现在事实相反的情况下如何体
现虚拟语气。
5. “表示与现在事实相反的情况”的虚拟语气
请看例句:
If I were you , I would take a small present.
如果我是你的话,我就带上一个小礼物。
(注:在这个句子中,即“If I were you 中,一定用were ,而不能用was”)
(这句话中,是与现在的事实相反,“现在如果我是你的话。”事实上,我不可能成为你,也就根本没
有实现的可能)
请大家注意主句与条件从句中动词时态的变化。
形式:
从句(用过去时) 主句(用过去将来时)
If +主语+
主语+
注:虚拟语气中的were 除了在If I were you 的结构中不能改动外,其它情况下有时可用was。
又如:
If I won a million dollars , I’d give it to charities.
如果我赢了一百万英镑,我要捐给慈善机构。
(在此句中,If条件句中,动词用过去式won,主句则用should / would 加动词原形。现实情况是我没
赢一百万英镑;虚拟的情况是假如我赢了一百万,这种虚拟是不可能变成现实的,因此用虚拟语气。)
6. 虚拟语气的疑问式,除了动词相应的变化外,其他变化与陈述语气相同
如:
(1)What would you do if you were in the lion’s cage ?
如果你在狮子笼里,你会怎么做?
(疑问词在句首,主句中助动词提前,从句跟在主句后面。)
If I were in the lion’s cage , I’d call for help.
如果我在狮子笼里,我会大呼救命。
If I were in the lion’s cage . I’d get out fast.
如果我在狮子笼里,我会迅速出来。
(2)What would you do if you won the lottery ?
如果你赢了抽奖,你会做什么?
I’d give it to medical research.
我会用于医学研究。
Or I’d put it in the bank.
我会存到银行。
Or If I were a millionaire , I would buy a big house in the country.
如果我是百万富翁,我就在乡村买座大房子。
关于虚拟语气,我们要学习的东西还有许多,同学们会在今后的学习当中,慢慢接触到。
(六)Key points (疑难解析)
1.
bring的意思是把某人或某物“带来”,“拿来”,强调方向,即从别处拿到说话人这儿来。
e.g. Next time you come , bring me that book , please.
下次你来的时候,把我的书带来。
take的意思是把人或物“带走,拿走”,即从说话人这儿带到别处去。
e.g. Who has taken away today’s newspaper ?
谁拿走了今天的报纸?
另外,相似的词还有get 和fetch ,表示到某地找到某人或某物并带回来,强调一去一回。
e.g. Go and get some water. 去弄点水来。
Can you fetch me some paper ?
你能给我取点纸吗?
2. He might not know anyone at the party.
他可能在晚会上谁也不认识。
might 的用法如下:
(1)是情态动词may的过去式
eg. He said that I might borrow his bike.
他说我可以借他的自行车。
(2)是may的虚拟语气形式,不表示过去,而表示现在或将来“可以,可能”,但语气更委婉、客气,
有时表示对可能性有所怀疑。
e.g. a. Might I borrow your bike ?
我可能借你的自行车吗?
(语气比may更委婉)
b. He might come today .
今天他可能会来。
(对“他来”的可能性有所怀疑)
3. What if “如果…怎么办”、“即使…又有什么关系?”
这是一个固定搭配,引导带条件从句的疑问句。
eg. What if they don’t come ?
他们不来怎么办呢?
What if I don’t know anyone ?
如果我一个人也不认识,怎么办呢?
4. I get nervous before big parties.
在大的晚会之前,我会感到紧张。
get nervous 变得紧张,get是系动词,nervous 是形容词做表语。
又如:be nervous 或feel nervous 均可表达同样的含义。
5. in public 公共的、公开的
eg. Lily is very shy , and she is afraid to speak in public.
莉莉很害羞,她害怕在公众场合讲话。
6. ask one’s permission 征求某人的同意。
without permission 没有得到许可。
7. introduce vt. 介绍
introduce sb to sb. 把(某人)介绍给(某人)
eg. It’s my honor to introduce my teacher to everyone.
很荣幸,我把我的老师介绍给大家。
introduce oneself 自我介绍
8. Sometimes you might annoy people because you’re so confident.
有时候,你可能会激怒别人,因为你太自信了。
9. You would also rather stay at home and read a good book than go to a party.
你可能宁愿呆在家里读书,也不愿去参加晚会。
rather …than …宁愿…也不…(注:than与形容词比较级无关)
rather , than 既可分开用,也可合在一起用,译成“而不是”
如:
(1)rather die than surrender 宁死不屈
(2)I , rather than you , should do the work .
该做这个工作的是我,而不是你。
10. in the slightest 根本,一点也
eg. Social situations don’t bother you in the slightest.
社会环境根本影响(干扰)不了你。
11. plenty of 充足的、大量的
12. enjoy the company of other people. 享受他人的陪伴
13. a circle of good friends. 朋友圈子
14. let sb down 使(某人)失望、沮丧
15. come up with 提出问题
【模拟试题】
一. 写出下列词组
1. 一点也、根本不_________
2. 与…相处_________
3. 使…失望、沮丧_________
4. 如果…怎么办_________
5. 赢得抽奖_________
6. 变得紧张_________
7. 征求某人的许可_________
8. 宁可…也不…_________
9. 迟到_________
10. 公共的、公众的_________
二. 补充完整下面虚拟语气的句子,(注意区分主句与从句的位置变化)
1. I’d be a millionaire if __________________________
2. If I had more free time. __________________________
3. If I were you . __________________________
4. She would buy that if __________________________
5. If my house were on fire. __________________________
6. I’d travel around the world if __________________________
7. If I could change one thing about my life. __________________________
8. I wouldn’t do that if __________________________
9. If I could make three wishes. __________________________
10. I would be a better student if __________________________
三. 根据不同情境,首先判断这个情景是真实可能发生的,还是虚拟的,然后填空。
Situation A
EXAMPLE : Gao is a doctor , but if he were (be)a truck driver, he would have (have)
very different skills.
(Gao不可能是个卡车司机,因此这个情境是虚拟的)
2. Gao’s wife is a doctor , too , but she is planning to change her career . If she
_________ (change)her career , she ___________ (study)to become a lawyer.
Situation B
3. Antonieta is Brazilian , but she has lived in the United States and New Zealand , so she
speaks excellent English . If she __________ (stay)in Brazil , her English _________ (not)
(be)so good.
4. However , Antonieta _______ (speak)French too if she _________ (move)to France next
year.
Situation C
5. Mary’s car is old . If it ________(break down), she ________ (buy)a new one.
6. Because Mary has a car , she has driven to school every day this term . But if she
_______ (not)(have)a car , she ________ (take)the bus.
Situation D
7. Marcia has applied to graduate school . She _______ (start)school next fall if she
_____(get)accepted.
8. When Marcia was twenty-one , she quit school for several years to get married and raise a
family . If she ________ (continue)her studies instead of raising a family , she _____
(begin)graduate school a long time ago.
四. 假设你现在在一个孤岛上,除了图中所示的物品,你一无所有,你该怎么办?完成下题。
Imagine you are on a desert island . You have nothing with you except these objects . What
would you do with them ?
If we were on a desert island , we would use this to
_______ . We would _______ with this
If we had this with us on the island , , we would use it to
___________ . With this , , we
_____________ . And finally , we _________ with this
五. 看图
What would you do if you were in prison ? At least 5 sentences .
假设你在监狱里,你做些什么?
【试题答案】
一. 1. in the slightest
2. get along with
3. let sb down
4. what if
5. won the lottery
6. get nervous
7. ask one’s permission
8. rather …than …
9. be late for
10. in public
二. Answers will vary . 答案可多种多样,但必须符合虚拟语气的结构
eg. I’d be a millionaire if I won the lottery.
三. 2. changes will study (真实的)
3. had stayed would not be (虚拟)
4. will speak / moves (or would speak / moved)(真实或虚拟均可)
5. breaks down will buy (真实的)
6. did not have would take (虚拟的)
7. will start gets accepted (真实的)
8. had continued would have begun (虚拟)
四. The objects are knife , sock , fishhook , rope , plastic bags .
Answers will vary.
五. Answers will vary.
Yjs21.coM更多幼儿园教案延伸读
三年级上册英语教案十五篇
教案课件是老师在课堂上非常重要的课件,因此就需要我们老师写好属于自己教学课件。教案是教师教育教学能力的提升工具。以下是幼儿教师教育网小编为您收集的最新有关“三年级上册英语教案”的范文,有需要的群众请前来筛选!
三年级上册英语教案 篇1
教学目标
1、能听、说、认读单词red、yellow、green、blue并能在实际情境中运用。
2、通过用Lets do部分“Show me...”的指令练习和运用有关颜色的单词,训练学生的动手能力。
3、通过学习,学生能根据自己喜欢的颜色设计东西,培养其动手的能力。
教学重难点
重点:掌握颜色单词red、yellow、green、blue。
难点:会用句型I see...描述自己看到的颜色。
教学工具
PPT课件、人物头饰、单词卡片、图片
教学过程
1、Warm-up
(1)T:Hello,boys and girls.I'm your newteacher today.My name is ChengGuangRui.So you can call me Mr.Cheng
Ss:Hello.Mr.Cheng.
T:Today we will learn Unit2 Colours(课件出示Colours单词,教师领读),Doyou know colours?
引导学生也可用汉语回答颜色
T:Let'ssing a song about colours,the song's name is《colours》,Please stand up,clap your hands.(师生齐唱歌曲)
2、Presentation:
(1)课件出示学校的平面图和本课中出现的人物图,让生进行操练,为本课的学习做好铺垫。
T:Let's go on,Look,what's this?(课件出示学校图)引导学生说出school,教师领读(注意升降调)At school,we have many friends,Look,they are coming.(教师逐一介绍四个人物的名字) Let's say “hello” tothem.
(2)课件出示公园图片,引导学生说出在公园里看到的景色,同时呈现本课的录音视频。
T:Today is a very sunny day.Our friends are going to the park(呈现公园图片)领读单词park.Do you want to gothere?Let's go,Listen(课件播放公园里鸟的叫声)What do you see in the park?(学生也可用汉语回答)
T:Yes,it's a beautiful park.Do you see the flowers?Do you see thetrees?Do you see the rainbow?
Ss: Yes/No.
T:What do you see in the park? Let's go,listen carefully(播放课文录音,让学生仔细的听)
T:What do you see in the park? Do you remember?引导学生利用句型I see...(板书)进行描述。
引导学生分别说出:I see red/yellow/green/blue.(出示四种颜色的图片贴到黑板上)
T:How many colours do you see in the park?Do you remember?Let's listenagain,This time pay attention to the words.(再次播放视频让学生跟读)
T:How many colours do you see in the park?(课件出示四种颜色的图片,引导学生说出这几种颜色)Theyare red/yellow/green/blue.(板书四个单词,同时对学生进行书写规范训练)
播放chant伴奏,让学生看黑板跟唱。操练四个颜色单词。
T:OK,Ihave these colours.Look(分别呈现四个单词卡片)
教师领读、齐读、分组读
(3)T:OK,now,listen(再次播放chant伴奏,师生看黑板齐唱)
(4)活动:I say,you do
T:Here are the colours,(出示四种颜色的彩笔)Look,on your desk, you have the crayons,listen,when I say red,youcan take up the red crayon quickly,let's try.
(5)课件出示四个句子,让学生进行操练。
T:Look here,In the park,we see many colours(课件呈现四个人物说的句子,学生齐读)OK,showme your finger(让生手指四个句子齐读)
(6)让生打开课本自己读,然后呈现chant文本,让生跟唱。
(7)活动:Colour your park
T:Now you have a new park,colour your park colourful.
学生开始活动,教师在下面巡视指导。
(8)找学生汇报自己的作品,利用句子I see...进行描述。
3、Homework:
绘制一个公园和你的家人一起分享。
人教版小学三年级上册英语教案 篇2
教学重难点
教学重点:学生学习早上问候语Good morning.及介绍人物用语This is…。
教学难点:介绍人物用语This is …一句的发音较难,口型和发音不易到位,教师要适当提示,切不可盲目纠正发音,从而挫伤孩子的学习积极性。
教学工具
ppt课件
教学过程
1、热身、复习(Warm-up/Revision)
(1)教师播放第一单元的歌曲Hello,师生共唱。
(2)用所学打招呼用语,师生互相问候。
2、呈现新课、操练(Presentation/ Practice)
A(1)教师出示自己的照片:It's me .I'm MR Ma .
Now I show another photo to you .Look who is he? Yeah he is Ma Yun , he is MR Ma too .We are all man . Man引出MR 。
Who can read it? Rise your hands please !
(2)Teacher:I have a beautiful girl's photo,look,she is Yang Mi. Your can call her Miss Yang .
Look ,who is she ? Yeach she is FanBingbing . Miss Fan .
They are all girls .引出Miss .
Who can read it? Rise your hands please !
Can you inteoduce yourself with MR or Miss ?
I'm …
B(1) T:What's this?
引导学生用已经学过的:This is a pencil ./This is aruler …
展示Miss Green的照片
引出:This is Miss Green .
This is Miss White .
This is Mr Jones .
(2)Practice:
练习
用图片展现进一步练习this is。介绍某人
(同时练习使用MR MISS)
(3)用所学知识this is Mr/Miss介绍同桌。
C:morning
(1)、出示一个时钟,从6点到十二点都伴随着morning这个词,帮助学生理解morning这个词的时间段。
(2)、教读操练morning.
教师向学生打招呼:T: Good morning.引出Good morning.
学生操练Good morning.
D:FLASH来展示Let's talk部分的对话时
学生跟读并模仿Let's talk部分的内容.
学生分小组,扮演对话中的人物或其他人物,进行实际交流。
学生展示练习情况。
3、活动、操练(Activities/ Practice)
介绍好朋友给你的同桌: Good morning, this is….
Draw and Say:画一画,说一说。画画你认识的人介绍给大家。
4、课外活动(Add-activities)
广文博见。熟人见面问候语:Hello!你好!
上午见面问候语:Good morning!早上好!
下午见面问候语:Good afternoon!下午好!
晚上见面问候语:Good evening!晚上好!
人教版小学三年级上册英语教案 篇3
教学总目标:
激发学生对英语的好奇心,使他们喜欢听他人说英语,能根据教师简单的指令做动作、做事情、做游戏。能做简单的角色表演。能唱简单的英文歌曲,说简单的英语歌谣。能在图片的帮助下听懂和读懂简单的小故事。能交流简单的个人信息,表达简单的感觉和情感。能模仿范例书写词句。在学习中乐于模仿,敢于表达,对英语有一定的感知能力,读应学习中接触的外国文化习俗感兴趣。
教学措施:
1.以活动为课堂教学的主要形式,设计丰富多彩的教学活动,让学生在乐中学、学中用,从而保证学生英语学习的可持续发展。
2.在教学过程中,采用情景教学法,让学生身临其境,积极主动参与到课堂教学中去,调动学生的非智力因素,提高学生实际运用语言的能力。
3.通过听、说、读、写、唱、游、演、画、做等形式,进行大量的语言操练和练习。
4.培养学生拼读单词的能力,确保学生自主学习的质量。
5.设计全面、高效的课外作业,培养学生良好的书写习惯,做到整洁、规范、正确地书写。
6.活用教材,根据学生的实际情况,将每个单元各个板块进行整合,重组,降低难度。
实施方案:
1.激发学生的学习欲望,设计真实的场景,真实的人物,在学中学会交际。
2.在日常生活中要求学生多说多练。
3.规范学生的书写,养成良好的书写习惯。
4.引导学生的各种感官来学习英语,如眼、耳、口、鼻、身等。充分利用学生的各种才能组织安排课堂,如唱歌、跳舞、画画等。
人教版小学三年级上册英语教案 篇4
教学目标:
1、 技能与知识目标
(1)能听懂并会说、会读Good afternoon. 和What’s your name? I’m x x.的句型。
(2)能听懂并会说、会读词汇 your, name, afternoon.
2、运用能力目标
能在不同时间段,正确地向他人问好。(上午:Good morning! 下午:Good afternoon!)能用What’s your name?来询问他人姓名。通过歌曲的学习培养孩子的乐感与美感,增强学科间的'融合。
教学重点:
能听懂并会说会读Good afternoon! What’s your name? I’m… 及词汇your ,name, afternoon.
教学难点:
name 中的 /m/ 与 afternoon中 /n/的发音。
教学过程:
一、Warm up
1.运用所学问候语进行师生间,生生间对话练习。 “Good morning! I’m …” “How are you? I’m fine. And how are you? I’m fine ,too. Thank you.”
2.同学们今天表现不错,那我们一起来做个游戏吧。活动帮助学生分清“boys与girls”的用法。速度由慢到快,指令可交替进行。
二、Lead in
OK!boys and girls ,you’ve done a good job. Look!老师左右手各持一手偶,通过变换音调来演一段对话,引出本课重点:What’s your name ? 手偶1:Hi, I’m Mr.Li . What’s your name? 手偶2: Hello, I’m Sam.
三、Text teaching
1.同学们现在我是Mr.Li不是Ms.Liu,老师说话的声音变粗。老师将Mr. Li的头饰带在头上与学生对话: Mr. Li: Hello! Good morning. Ss: Good morning. Mr. Li: what’s your name? Ss: I’m x x.
2.播放一遍录音,要求学生听录音指图片。再次播放对话,要求学生跟读2—3遍; 老师纠正学生的发音。
3.让学生以小组为单位开始朗读对话内容,并对个体学生进行抽查。
4.传话游戏 大家在班里男女生之间要用礼貌的语言互相问候,这个游戏就是看男生与女生谁的礼貌用语说的。举例: 老师:Girls whisper. 女孩:(耳语)Good morning, boys. 老师:Boys low. 男孩:(低声说)Good morning, girls. 用“Good afternoon”做同样的游戏。
5.歌曲“Good morning,Sam”。同学们今天我们要学习一首好听的英文歌曲,学完后四人小组把歌词进行改可将“Good morning!”改为“Good afternoon”。由四人小组向大家表演改编后的歌曲,评出优秀小组。
四、Sum upw
We’ve learned a very sweet new song and done some interesting exercise.
五、Homework
Sing the new song to your parents and listen to the tape twice.
人教版小学三年级上册英语教案 篇5
A Let’s talk Let’s play Let’s sing
一、教学分析:
Let’s talk部分主要是会话学习。通过Miss White和学生第一次见面打招呼的情景,提供学生要学习的核心句型Hello/Hi, I’m … 要求学生能理解对话大意,能正确理解对话大意,能用正确的语音语调朗读对话,能在语境中运用Hello/Hi跟别人打招呼并用I’m …介绍自己。本课时的学习内容在儿童英语有相关的学习单元,学生对打招呼和简单的自我介绍有初步的了解。本课为接下来的询问对方姓名对话学习打下基础。这是正式学习英语的第一节课,对培养学生的学习兴趣,激发英语学习热情尤为重要。Let’s play部分让学生在游戏活动中巩固练习所学问候语及自我介绍用语。Let’s sing部分通过学唱歌曲“Hello!”,让学生感知英语学习带来的快乐。
二、教学目标:
1.知识目标:听懂、会说 Hello./Hi.I'm….
2.能力目标
(1)能够在真实情景中在教师的帮助下理解对话大意,会使用见面打招呼、自我介绍的日常用语。
(2)能够按照正确的语音、语调及意群朗读对话,并能进行角色表演。能够听懂、会唱歌曲“Hello”。
(3)能够在情境中运用Hello!Hi!与别人打招呼;能够在情境中运用举行I’m...自我介绍。
3.情感、文化目标
(1)情感态度:培养学生乐于开口,敢于开口讲英语的习惯,激发学生想学、乐学英语的兴趣和愿望。
(2)文化目标:了解中西方名字的不同形式。
三、教学重、难点:
1.重点:主要是见面打招呼和自我介绍的会话学习,使学生在不同的生活情景中听懂、会说 Hello./Hi.I'm….
2.难点:自我介绍用语I’m … 的发音不容易到位,学习起来较难,教师要适时纠正,切不可挫伤孩子的学习积极性。
四、教学过程:
教学设计参考 个性化备课
Step 1 Preparation
1. Free talk
T: Hello, boys and girls.I’m….I’m your English teacher.(PPT教师作简单自我介绍)Welcome to my English class!
2. Introduce English
教师用交谈的方式与学生讨论一下英语的作用以及学习英语的意义。让学生知道虽然还没学习英语,但是我们已经会说一部分英语了!引导学生说说我们日常生活中已经会说或比较熟知的词汇,如TV,CD,VCD,DVD,OK!Yeah!Hi!Bye!Cool!Wow!E-mail,cartoon等等来激发学生想学英语的兴趣和愿望。对回答较好的学生进行评价,鼓励。
3. Enjoy the song “ Hello ”.师播放录音,让学生欣赏歌曲,并提问你在歌曲中听到那些单词,试着说一说。
Step 2 Presentation
1.Look and guess.What are they talking about? (观看文本视频,猜一猜老师和同学们正在讨论什么?A 打招呼 B 数数字)鼓励学生勇于表达,建立学好英语的信心。
2.教学Hello!
T: Hello, boys and girls.教师与学生见面打招呼,呈现hello,引导学生跟老师打招呼用Hello!师与生用Hello!打招呼,板书。师教读、示范发音,注意重音、领读,板书,生跟读,生齐读,开火车读。
3.教学Hi!
以同样的方式呈现练习Hi!
告诉学生Hello!一般可作为熟人、亲朋好友之间的打招呼用语,语气比较随便,还可以用Hi!替换,Hi!语气更随便一些。展示一些场合的图片师生间用Hello!/Hi!打招呼。
师与一生用Hello!/Hi!打招呼,然后师与全体学生打招呼,生生练习打招呼。
4.教学I’m….
(1)展示情境图,教师先介绍自己,Hello, I’m….You can call me Miss/Mr....师板书Miss/Mr,教读,并解释学生对老师的称呼用Miss/Mr…Miss/Mr表示某老师。
(2) T: Hello, I’m….鼓励并引导学生学说Hello, I’m….名字直接用汉语拼音,教师戴上Sarah等人的头饰分别介绍并配以体态语,说:
Hello!/Hi!I’m Sarah/Wu Yifan/John/Mike/Miss White/Liu Xin/Zoom/Zip.板书(中西方姓名分开板书,初步了解东西方文化的差异),让学生看口型强调I’m的发音。师教读、示范发音、领读,生跟读,个读。
(3)学生观察板书,引导学生归纳总结中文名字和英文名字的区别,以及学生对男女教师的英文称呼。
(4)学生戴上Sarah等人的头饰说Hello!/Hi!I’m….学生用真实姓名简单介绍:Hello! /Hi! I’m….
Step 3 Practice
1.T:Listen and point. 观看视频,注意正确的语音、语调。
T:Listen and repeat. 生跟读,模仿正确的语言、语调。
2.Read in roles.先师生示范,再小组内生生角色朗读课文。
3.Let’s play.将对话中的名字换成自己的真实姓名,进行练习,小组内练习。
4. 游戏“击鼓传花”。教师有节奏的敲击小鼓,学生传花。当教师的鼓声停止时,拿到花的同学站起来说:Hello/Hi! I’m….如果学生已有英文名字,在此处进行练习,如果没有,可先用中文名字代替。
Step 4 Production
1.教师为每小组准备若干名字的头饰或卡片。一人佩戴自己喜欢的名字头饰,小组内的其他同学抽卡片进行打招呼练习。先师生示范,再小组交流,最后全班展示交流。
2.自我介绍,互换自制名片
由于师生第一次见面,先师与一生用Hello/Hi! I’m…进行正式自我介绍互换自制名片。再小组交流,最后全班展示交流。
Step 5 Progress
1.Summary:What have you learned today?教师指板书,引导学生总结本课所学内容。如:见面打招呼、自我介绍用语等等。
2.Homework:
(1)听录音,跟读会话。
(2)给自己选择一个英文名字,并制成英文名卡。师可提供部分男孩女孩的英文名字,也可附上名字含义供学生选择。
三年级上册英语教案 篇2
a部分
第 1 课时 / 共 6课时
教学目标(含重点、难点)
及设置依据
教学准备
教 学 过 程
内容与环节预设
个人二度备课
教师先示范说单词,如pencil ,教师说show me your pencils. 学生出示铅笔,又快又正确的同学为小组赢得一分。用同样的方法找学生说其它文具单词的口令,继续游戏。(注意:教师应参加学生的游戏,与学生一起展示文具。)
播放教学录音,学生模仿录音说对话。注意模仿语音正确、语调自然
做活动手册本单元第一部分的练习
板书
设计
unit 3 we love animals
act like a … 动物图片
作业布置
或设计
教后整体
反思
作业设计:
必做题:
1.听录音,跟读p41的learn 和chant5遍;
2.边演边说let’s do 5遍;
补充题:
你能把句子与表示动作的图片对应起来吗?
1.act like a rabbit.
2.act like a cat.
3.act like a panda.
4.act like a duck.
三年级上册英语教案 篇3
一、教学目标 第一课时
知识方面:
使学生能听、说、认识、口头运用单词:teacher, boy, girl
能理解并口头运用:What’s his/her name?
能力方面:
通过学习怎样和别人打招呼,怎样来介绍自己,向他人介绍事物来培养学生的交际能力,锻炼语言的组织能力和知识的运用能力。
情感目标:
通过本课的学习,让学生知道怎样有礼貌地进行打招呼,如何做简要的介绍,做个有礼貌的好孩子。
二、教学重点:
1、 认识新单词三会(会说、会听、会读):
teacher 教师 boy 男孩 girl 女孩
his 他的 her 她的
2、掌握新句子:两会(会听、会说):
This is a______. 这是______。
What’s his name? 他叫什么名字?
His name is ______. 他的名字是______。
What’s her name? 她叫什么名字?
Her name is ______. 她的名字是______。
三、教学难点:区分his和her的用法。
四、教具、学具:录音机、图片
五、教学流程:
Class opening
1、 Greeting:Hello!/Hi!
2、 Review: What’s your name?
New Concepts
1、利用班里的男孩引出boy,并对其进行介绍:This is a boy.领读boy,接着介绍His name is _____ 。(说出这位学生的名字),教师可以重复这句话,使学生理解它,如果学生不能明白,教师就多举几个例子,例如:
T: What’s his name? His name is __A___.
What’s his name? His name is ___B__.
What does this word ‘his’means?
在学生理解his的含义后教师指着某个男生问学生:What’s his name?
试着让学生回答:His name is _____ 。反复进行几组后就要放手让学生自己来练习了。
教授单词girl, teacher和句子What’s her name?同上述方法。
设计意图:根据年龄特点,用创设情景的方法,直观的将所学内容展示给学生,生动活泼,使学生容易接受新知。激发学生的学习兴趣。
2.Listen to the tape,and read after it.
设计意图:让学生在模仿练习进一步熟练课文内容,并同时进行听力训练。
第二课时
3.Play a game。
Memory name。游戏规则:让几名自告奋勇的学生面对全班站在教室的前面,教师站在这一排学生得一端。
第一个人说:My name is Hong.
第二个人说:My name is Bing.和Her name is Hong.(指着第一个人说)
第三个人说:My name is Ming.和 Her name is Hong.( 指着第一个人说) His name is Ming.(指着第二个人说)这个游戏一直进行到这一排的最后一个人,要求教师必须记住所有学生的名字。
设计意图:通过游戏使学生能有亲身体验,并激发他们的学习兴趣,在游戏中轻松愉悦地获得新知。
4.Make a dialogue in groups.
设计意图:使学生在活动中发散思维,并培养他们的合作创新精神,能够运用所学知识进行简单的口语交流,培养自主学习能力。
Class Closing
Goodbye!
六、板书:
Lesson 2: Boy,Girl and Teacher
teacher boy girl
What’s his name? His name is 。
What’s her name? Her name is 。
课后反思:
三年级上册英语教案 篇4
一、教学重点
本部分主要是见面打招呼、自我介绍及道别用语的会话学习,使学生在不同的情景中听懂、会说Hello. / Hi. Goodbye. / Bye-Bye. I’m .
二、教学难点
自我介绍用语I’m 。的发音不容易到位,学习起来较难,教师要夸张示范并适时纠正,但切不可挫伤孩子的学习积极性。
三、课前准备
1、将教师用书后所附的本套教材主要人物的图片复印或剪下,涂色后制成头饰。
2、为班上学生准备出男女生常用的英文名字。
3、为Let’s play中的游戏准备相应的道具。
四、教学时间:2课时
课型:新授课
五、备时:
8.15
六、授时:
x
七、教学步骤
【一】热身(Warm-up)
不妨请学生说说他们在现实生活中已经了解的英语词汇或日常用语。同时可利用我们生活中学生已经会说或较熟知的词汇如TV,CD,VCD,DVD,OK!Hi! Yeah! Bye! Cool! Wow! E-mail, cartoon等等来激发学生想学英语的兴趣和愿望。
【二】新课展示(Presentation)
新课展示一:教师播放本课的歌曲“Hello”的录音,自然引出师生之间的打招呼。
(1)通过教师的自我介绍自然引出Hello, I’m… /Hi, I’m…
(2)教师可戴上Sarah的头饰介绍Hello! I’m Sarah.并用同样方式介绍其他人物。
(3)让学生到讲台上来,戴上Sarah,Chen Jie, Mike的头饰说:Hello! I’m…
(4)教师戴上Wu Yifan的头饰说Hi! I’m Wu Yifan.并与戴Sarah头饰的学生相互问好,并有意在分手时说Goodbye.
(5)听录音来展示Let’s talk部分的教学内容。
【三】趣味操练(Practice)趣味操练一:
(1)请戴着Wu Yifan, Chen Jie,Sarah,Mike头饰的学生站在讲台前,另选一同学用眼罩蒙住眼睛,让Sarah等四位同学中的一个说Hello,让蒙住眼睛的同学猜。如果猜中,要说Yes, I’m…如果猜错,要说No, I’m…猜对得一分。
(2)表演A部分对话,教师应指导学生注意语音,语调,特别是I’m的发音,应为/aim/不能读成/em/。
(3)玩Let’s play中的游戏“击鼓传花”。新课展示二:教师播放Let’s sing两遍,学生边听边跟唱,让能力强的学生唱一遍,教师适当进行奖励或表扬。教师领唱,学生跟唱,全体同学一起唱。分小组唱,对于唱得好的小组进行表扬。趣味操练二:(1)请学生在限定时间内找出在小村庄里出现的字母,对于找得又快又好的的学生要加以奖励,有能力的学生让他们读出这些字母。(2)教师和学生一起校对。(3)让学生跟随录音一起学唱歌曲ABC song.
【四】课堂评价(Assessment)
要用Hello!/ Hi!打招呼并作自我介绍。
【五】课外活动(Add-activities)
(1)听录音,仿读会话,并在实际情景中运用所学内容。
(2)遇到老师、同学和家长时要用Hello!/ Hi!打招呼;分手时要用Goodbye./ Bye-bye.道别。
三年级上册英语教案 篇5
Unit 3 Lesson 15 Left and Right 教学目标:
1.掌握单词、词组foot(feet), time, turn, left, right, hand, leg, 2.能听懂、会说、会读和会写句型Put … on …, Touch … with …
3.能听懂、会说、会读日常交际用语Stand in a line.Let’s do some exercise.Now, listen carefully.Jump up and down.教学重点:
单词lift与left, hand与head, lie与line, order的正确发音。教学难点:
初步了解掌握句型Put … on …, Touch … with … 教学过程
第一步:重难点突破
用时:10分钟
T: Hello, boys and girls.Nice to meet you.同学们,大家好。很高兴认识你们。
T: Today, we are going to learn Unit6 A PE lesson.T: First, let’s do warm-up!首先,让我们一起来热热身吧。先来看看这几位同学是如何做的。(学生示范chant)
Left, left, right, right, everybody, stand up!Left, left, right, right, walk carefully, run fast!Left, left, right, right, dance beautifully, jump high!Left, left, right, right, everybody, stop!T: Wonderful!他们做得真棒!你一定也想试试吧。那么就让我们来学一学这节热身操吧。先来认识几个新单词,请跟我读:(同时教授:left, right, everybody, stop)
T: Now, please read after me.T: Good!下面,我们配上节奏,一起来读读看。T: 最后,请你配上动作,和你的小伙伴一起做一做吧!
T: Well done, boys and girls!同学们做得可真棒!做完了热身运动,让我们来认识一下我们的身体吧。
第 1 页 Please say after me.head, hand, legs, foot(feet).这几个人体部位,你记住了吗?老师现在来考考你,请你根据我所指的部位,迅速说出单词,看看谁说的又快又好!hand, head, leg, feet 同学们,你们都说对了吗?
T: Now, look at me.Where are my hands now? Yes, they are on my head.I put my hands on my head.Boys and girls, can you put your hands on your head? Good!Now, follow me: Put … on … Put your hands on your head(带读)
T: Now, listen carefully.Put your hands on your legs/feet.T: 怎么样?你都做对了吗?Now, please read after me.(带读以上句子)T: 同学们,刚才我们认识了一些人体部位,再来看看,我们脸上有哪些器官呢? Yes, we have two eyes, two ears, a nose, a mouth and a lot of hair.Now, let’s play a game: Listen and touch!(教touch)Touch your … with your hands.请你用双手来触摸你听到的部位。T : Are you ready? Let’s begin!Touch your eyes/ nose/ mouth/ hair/ ears with your hands.T: 怎么样?你都做对了吗?We touch them with our hands.刚才,我们是用双手来触摸这些部位的。下面,老师要加大难度了,还记得left和right吗?Show me your left me your right hand.下面听清楚了,老师要你用哪只手来触摸。
Touch your mouth with your left hand.(中文)你做对了吗? 跟读句子 Touch … with … 提示:请同学们注意了,在中文里,我们先说用什么部位,而在英文中,我们要先说触摸什么部位,清楚了吗?再来试试看。Touch your nose with your right hand.跟读句子 老师再把难度加大一点儿,看看你会不会了。
Touch your left eye with your left hand.跟读句子 Touch your right ear with your left hand.跟读句子
第 2 页 下面,就请你和同桌也来互相发一发指令吧。(操练句型Touch … with …)第二步:课文学习
用时:15分钟
1.T: Now, boys and girls.Look at this young man.Who’s he? Do you know? He’s Mr Ma.He’s a PE teacher.What are Mr Ma and his students doing? Let’s listen!(播放引言)
教order, give orders, follow, try to follow the orders 2.T: What orders are Mr Ma going to give?马老师将会发出什么样的指令呢?Let’s watch the cartoon together.(播放课文第一段)
在这一段中,马老师都发出了哪些指令呢?让我们一起来学习一下吧。Stand in a line.(line)Let’s do some exercise.(exercise)Put your feet together.Jump up and down ten times.(time)现在,就请你自己把这些指令读一读吧。
3.T: 接下来,学生们又将做什么练习呢?让我们接着往下看吧。(播放课文第二段)
这一次,马老师请同学们做了什么呢?你能说说看吗?
Yes, he says, Put your hands on your head and turn left and right.Do this ten times.(turn, turn left and right)3.T: 最后,同学们又要做什么高难度的练习了呢?Let’s go on watching.这一次,练习的难度果然又加大了,同学们做了哪些动作呢?
Lie on your back.Lift up your left leg and touch it with your right hand.Then lift up your right leg and touch it with your left hand.Do this ten times.(lie, lie on one’s back.lift up)How do the students feel at last? 最后,学生们都觉得怎么样?
第 3 页 Yes, they are very tired.请你自己再来读读这些指令吧。
5.T: Good!Now let’s listen and repeat.现在,让我们打开书,翻到44页,跟读课文。Are you ready? 准备好了吗?Let’s begin.(PPT出示课文内容,放录音学生跟读。)5.T: Now please read the text by yourselves.现在请你们自己来读一读课文吧!你可以和同桌分角色朗读,还可以边读,边做动作,把课文表演出来,试试看吧!第三步:巩固操练
用时:5分钟
T: 同学们,今天,我们跟随马老师和他的学生们一起上了一堂体育课,你一定掌握了不少本领吧。如果请你也来当一当体育老师,你会吗?让我们一起来复习一下体育老师的上课用语吧:(PPT罗列本课主要知识点)Stand in a line.Let’s do some exercise.Put your feet together.Jump up and down … times.Put your hands on your head and turn left and right.Do this … times.Lie on your back.Lift up your left leg and touch it with your right hand.T: 同学们,这些句子你都会说了吗?请你课后认真复习,下节课我要请你来做一做体育老师的哦!
See you next time!Bye, children!
第 4 页
三年级上册英语教案 篇6
一、教学内容与分析
1、letsquo;s learn
本部分将继续学习有关学校及学习用品的词汇:school, bag, book, pencil-case, sharpener.
2、letsquo;s do
本部分主要让学生听懂一些简单的指示语,并按照指令做出相应的动作。通过听听做做的活动,让学生练习并运用所学的词汇。
二、课前准备
教师自备与本课教学有关的文具(实物)和教师卡片。
三、教学步骤
1、热身/复习(warm-up/revision)
(1)“开火车”:学生一个接一个进行口语问答,要求又快又好。
(2)通过图片和单词卡片复习学过的单词crayon, ruler, eraser, pen, pencil. (可通过做touching game或matching game来复习)
2、新课展示 (presentation)
(1)letsquo;s learn
a、通过实物教pencil-case, bag, book, sharpener, 用图片教school.
在教“铅笔袋”pencil-case时,出示“铅笔盒”pencil-bo, 并说明它们的区别,即:用软皮或塑料制成的通常称为pencil-case, 用铁等较坚硬材料制成的叫做pencil-bo. 同时教pencil-bo.
b、新单词的教学也可通过旧单词来引出。如:pencil 到pencil-case.
(2)、letsquo;s do
教师边做打开书的动作边说open the book. 然后边做合上书的动作边说close the book. (重复两次)。再拿起铅笔袋,做打开、合上的动作,并说:open the pencil-case. close the pencil-case. 请学生说出open, close的意思。 用同样的方法教show me your sharpener. carry the bag. 等句子。
3、趣味操练(practice)
(1)、让学生将所有学过的文具全部摆在桌上。教师说:“show me your book.” ,学生须快速举起并大声说:“book”.
(2)、游戏:画文具。
(3)、在本课教学中,教师也可以采用 “选词竞赛”的游戏。
(4)、通过游戏simon says练习以show, open, close, put, carry 所引导的祈使句。
4、课堂评价(assessment)
做活动手册本单元第5部分练习。学生根据录音,圈出所听到的文具。(1)、学生看图,用英语说出图中每样文具物品。(2)、教师讲解题目的意思并指导做的方法。(3)学生听录音做练习。(4)、核对答案.
5课外活动(add-activities)
(1)、要求学生听本课所学内容的录音,跟读单词和句子,并在实际生活中自然运用。
(2)、将学习用具逐个用英语说给家人听。
第三课时
一、教学内容与分析
1、letsquo;s check
本部分通过听力练习,检查学生对本课所学内容掌握的情况。
2、letsquo;s chant
本部分通过有节奏、有韵律的歌谣,让学生进一步复习和巩固本单元所学的词汇。
二、课前准备
准备一个装有本单元所学的文具的书包,与本课教学内容相关的词卡和图片。
三、教学步骤
1、热身/复习(warm-up/revision)
(1)、唱”hello”歌。
(2)、通过实物和单词卡复习有关文具。
(3)、用show me your… 请学生将他们的文具摆出来。
(4)、用游戏simon says复习第8页所学的指令性的动作。
2、新课展示(presentation)
教师从自己准备的书包中拿出一本书,并指着自己说:i have a book. 随后再掏出笔袋,对学生说:i have a pencil-case. 再从笔袋里拿出一支铅笔说:i have a pencil. 拿 出一把尺子说:i have a ruler. 等等。待学生熟悉了i have a … 是“我有一个…“后,请学生们用自己的文具来说:i have a … 告诉学生如果你有与别人东西相同时,可说me too!
3、趣味操练 (practice)
(1)、操练letsquo;s chant
a、全班听录音,边听录音边拍手有节奏的吟唱letsquo;s chant 部分的内容。
b、将全班分成两大组。第一组举起铅笔齐读i have a pencil.第二组齐读me too!并拍手。读第二句时两组交换,以此类推。
c、待学生读熟后,可让他们自由发挥,用其他文具替换书上的几种,并在小组内朗读。
(2)听力练习:letsquo;s check
根据听到的句子,让学生圈出相应的图a或图b。
4、课堂评价 (assessment)
做活动手本单元第6部分练习。此项练习旨训练学生的观察和反应能力。
5、课外活动(add-activities)
让学生听录音,跟读a、b部分letsquo;s do和letsquo;s chant的内容,边读边做出相应的动作。
三年级上册英语教案 篇7
教学内容:
A Let's talk Count and say
教材分析:
本课时为第六单元第一课时,包括两部分Let’s talk 和Count and say 。Let’s talk部分通过Sam和妈妈在蛋糕店买蛋糕的场景让学生感知核心句型How many…?的语意及语用情境。Count and say部分呈现了准备生日派对的物品,其作用是通过一个生日派对的情境图进行数数活动来操练How many…? Five/Two…。的句型。
教学目标:
1、能力目标
(1)能理解对话大意,并能用正确的语音语调朗读对话。
(2)能在图片和老师的帮助下,在语境中运用How many…?等询问物品的数量。
2、知识目标
(1)听懂、会说句型:How many…? Five.
(2)听懂、会说one, two, three, four,five.
(3)在语境中理解句子This one ,please. Sure.
3、情感目标
培养学习英语的积极态度,鼓励学生勇于开口说英语。
教学重点:
听懂、会说句型:How many…?
教学难点:
在语境中正确运用How many…?等询问物品的数量。
教学过程:
Step1 Preparation.
1、利用主情境图导入本单元话题,引导学生了解本单元的主要内容。
T:(师呈现本单元主情境图课件或使用教学挂图或让学生看书)Who can you see in the picture? Sarah, Chen Jie, John,Mike. Who is this boy?生回答,引出新的人物T:Yes, he is Sarah’s brother. Sam. 出示头饰领读。What are they doing? They’re having a birthday party. Whose birthday party? Yes, today is Sam’s birthday. Let’s say:Happy birthday to Sam.生齐说,引出本节的话题。
2、 吟唱歌曲 《Happy birthday》
T: Boys and girls, let’s sing birthday song to Sam.
Step2 Presentation.
1、看图预测,整体感知。教学句子This one ,please. Sure.
T: Look at the picture 。 Who are they? Sam and Sam’s mother. Where is Sam now ? At the baker’s. This is the shop keeper. What do Sam and his mother buy ? A cake. T: Look, so many cakes. PPT出示好多蛋糕的图片,师接着问:Guess. Which one does Sam want to buy?学生猜测。Now, Listen and choose. Which one? 听音选图片。校对答案,引出句子This one ,please.播放录音,学生跟读,板书句子,领读,齐读,小组读,个别读。师戴Mum头饰, 指着蛋糕说:This one please. How does the shop keeper say? 播放录音,引出句子Sure. 板书领读,小组读,个别读。师PPT出示购物图片,师指一西瓜,问生,This one , please.引导生用Sure回答。生生操练,小组展示。
2、 听音答题,教学句子How many plates? Five.
T: Sam and Mun buy a cake. What else do they buy? 除了蛋糕还买了什么?生回答Plate。出示图片,领读,齐读,小组读,男女读,个别读 板书,粘贴图片。出示一盘子,教学one plate, 接着出示第二个盘子,教学two plates,领读,齐读,小组读,个别读,逐一增加盘子,three/ four/ five plates.板书plates, 描红强调复数S及发音/s/。 (此处数字1-5,只要求生会认读,不出现形)T: They buy some plates. Listen and answer:How many plates do they buy?出示问题,播放录音,教学领读句子How many plates? 小组读,个别读,开火车读。听音答题,引出数字five, 板书教学领读。
Step 3 Practice
1、听音正音 T: Listen and repeat. 生跟读录音,模仿正确的语言、语调。
2、师生、生生、同桌分角色朗读课文。
3、角色表演:让学生戴上头饰,表演展示Let's talk 的对话。
4.Count an say
利用课本第58页Count and say图,教学数字 1-4
T:Today is Sam’s birthday. Sam got so many gifts. Look,so many gifts. What gifts?生看图回答,books/pencils/bears/。.。 师接着问生How many books?引导生回答three, 教学数字three, 领读,齐读,小组读,个别读,开火车读。接着问生How many pencils? 引出数字four,出示图片,教学领读,小组读,个别读。同样教学其他数字one, two。两人一组,看图谈论,操练句子How many.。.? One/。.。
Step 4 Production
语用活动:Go shopping! 四人一小组进行购物活动。组长在桌子上放好文具,动物等卡片,其余三人购买礼物。教师可与几个学生先示范。
T: Sam has a birthday party today. Do you want to go ? Let’s go shopping for some gifts.
A: Hello!
B: Hi! I’d like some pencils, please.
A: Sure. How many ?
B: Four.
A: Here you are.
B: Thank you.
A: Hello!
C: Hi! This bag, please.
A: Here you are.
C: Thank you. …
2、小组合作,1-2组展示。
Step5 Progress
1、做当堂达标题。基训45页3、4题。
2、 Summary. What have you learned today? 引导学生总结本课时所学知识。
3.Homework:听录音仿读。将所学的数字说给家长听。
三年级上册英语教案 篇8
教学目标:
1、会听、说、读、认:blue, pink, black, white.
2、会认读have, pet, it, rabbit, color, star, teacher…。.
3、会说I have a… What color is it? It’s…。
4、能听、说、读、写R r, S s, T t
教学重点:
1、会听、说、读、认:blue, pink, black, white.
2、能听、说、读、写R r, S s, T t
教学难点:
会说I have a …。 What color is it?It’s…。
教学过程:
一、复习Lesson 13, say a chant,
Yellow, yellow, yellow, a yellow banana
Green, green, green, a green frog
Orange, orange, orange, an orange fish
Red, red, red, a red apple
二、由以上四种颜色,引出另外四种颜色的教学,拿出四张不同颜色的图片,教学:blue, pink,black,white
三、出示四张图片教学并操练
1、出示一张a black cat的图片,教学:
T: I have a cat. What color is it?
S: It’s black.
2、出示一张a pink fish的图片,教学:
T: I have a fish. What color is it?
S: It’s pink.
3、出示一张a white rabbit的图片,教学:
T: I have a rabbit. What color is it?
S: It’s white.
4、出示一张a blue kite的图片,教学:
T: I have a kite. What color is it?
S: It’s blue.
四、听录音,跟读课文
五、字母教学
1、学习字母R r
出示a rabbit的图片,问“What’s this?”操练a rabbit,接着问:“What’s the first letter?”
出示字母卡片,辨别大小写,教读音。
指着卡片:“Big letter R, small letter r, R r is for rabbit, R r, R r. R r.”
2、同法教学S s
3、同法教学T t.
4、范写,书写。
六、完成Listen and circle the right picture.
七、总结
指导学生完成课本中的自我评价
八、Homework
1、朗读课文
2、完成《活动手册》Lesson 14
【教学反思】
这单元涉及的主要的句型是What color is my.(衣服)/it? Its.(颜色)。所以我整个的教学设计思路是:首先我由一首歌(color song)导入这堂课的课题colors。接着是让学生根据白板上的提示(Look at my.;Its.和已学的服饰)选择自己喜欢的衣服编短话。这一环节不仅复习了前一单元所学的主要内容,还能引出下个环节Guessing game其目的在于激发学生上课的'激情,让学生在玩中学。接着是创设一个情境,我有一个魔术表演,将学生带入今天所要学的内容当中,杨玲的魔术表演。然后通过听,说,读三方面来整体感知对话,以及处理对话中的重难点。在读的方面采用不同的朗读方式来操练。例如男生女生分角色朗读,跟在电脑后面读,齐读等。最后是通过学生展示来检测学生有没有掌握本堂课的重点,并给与评价。
当然我也发现了一些不足之处和值得改进的地方。
1、教授单词时没有注重单词的拼读,给人感觉就是一带而过。
2、有几张课件不是很合理,比如在变魔术的时候,课件上文本显示的是变完魔术后的颜色。还有一张课件上的图片太小以至于做在后面的学生不是看得很清楚。
3、教具准备得不是太充分。
4、忘了板书。
5、说话语速太快。
在接下来的教学当中,我将会不断自我反思,不断创新,不断提升自己的专业素养,提高专业知识水平。与此同时,虚心像前辈请教,共同讨论并解决教学过程中的疑点。希望经过自己不懈的努力成为一名优秀的英语老师。
三年级上册英语教案 篇9
【教具准备】
1 教材配套的录音带。
2 教师和学生分别准备废旧的硬纸盒/纸版、剪刀、胶水。
3 教师准备一个自己已制作好的键盘。
4 教师准备字母卡片和真正的键盘一个。
【教学过程】
1 热身、复习 (Warm-up/Revision)
(1)师生之间进行英语对话或进行日常口语活动。
(2)学生之间自编对话并表演。
(3)教师播放Unit 6 B Let's chant 的录音,让学生边拍手边说歌谣。
(4)游戏:Silent Speech
教师换一种方法说字母------唇说,说字母的时候不发出声音。学生看教师的口形,猜教师“说”的内容。说的字母为Aa----Zz 。
2 呈现新课 (Presentation)
(1)教师出示字母卡片,学生认读字母Aa----Zz。
(2)学生字母背诵Aa----Zz。
(3)教师播放歌曲 “A B C Song ”,告诉学生“试一试”“比一比”,看看谁能通过自己试唱学会歌曲。
(4)学生间相互练唱,再次让学生掌握歌词和节奏。
(5)教师出示一个真正的键盘,教师说字母,让学生在键盘上找到字母。可将此活动作为比赛的形式出现,Boys Group and Girls Group. 谁先找到谁获胜。
(6)教师出示自己已制作好键盘:This is a Keyboard. 重复 a Keyboard,学生跟读
a Keyboard This is a Keyboard.并贴在黑板上。
教师指着制作所需的工具建议:Let's make a Keyboard.
(7)教师按照课本上呈现的制作程序,一边用英语讲解,一边给学生做示范。
3 趣味操练 (Practice)
(1)请学生拿出他们事先准备的材料,教师指导学生按步骤制作键盘。键盘上的字母教师可以事先复印好发给学生。告诉学生键盘上的字母排列顺序是固定的,不能任意排列组合。
(2)键盘游戏:
按照书中的程序,分三种游戏进行操练。
·找出字母的位置。
·在键盘上敲击出单词。请学生先跟着教师学习正确的指法,再玩游戏。
·一边敲,一边唱 “ABC Song”。
(3)展览学生的作品。评出秀的键盘。
4 课堂评价 (Assessment)
(1)做活动手册43页的练习。
(2)让学生自我评价本单元学习情况,可在第73页上做标记。
5 扩展性活动(Add-activities)
小组对抗赛
教师将学生分为6个组,教师说英文,小组成员共同画出相应内容,又快又准的加一分。如教师说:Draw a blue eye. Draw an orange mouth. Draw the green ears. …
教师还可出示图片,让学生说单词,说对的加分。
【板书设计】
Recycle 2
教师出示一个自己已制作好键盘贴在黑板上。小学三年级英语教案《下学期 Recycle 2 第三课时》
三年级上册英语教案 篇10
一、教学重点有关文具的五个词汇crayon、pencil、pen、eraser、ruler 的学习,并用英语介绍文具。
二、教学难点较准确读出各单词,尤其是crayon,eraser 两个单词的发音。
三、课前准备
1、 教学课件。2. 本课相应的文具(实物)和教师卡片。3. 学生卡片。
四、教学时间:2课时
五、备时:8.15
六、授时:_
七、教学步骤
1、热身/复习(Warm-up/ Revision)
(1)唱 ABC song歌
(2)师生互相问候
2、 新课展示 (Presentation)
(1)老师指自己说Hello! I’m Miss / Mr… 然后用My name’s… 再重复两遍自己的名字。接着对一名学生发问What’s your name? (用清晰、缓慢的语调问两遍)边问边指他,并用口型揭示他回答Myname’s… 用类似的方法在教室里与学生进行问答练习,注意引导学生用My name’s… 回答问题。
(2)跟读、模仿What’s your name? 注意学生对name的发音。
(3)教道别语Goodbyeye, 告诉学生意思是“再见”
(4)听录音来展示B部分Let’s talk的内容。
3、趣味操练 (Practice)
(1)Pair work: 可让学生戴上头饰,表演书上Let’s talk的对话。
(2)Let’splay中的游戏。(3)四人或六人为一小组,先将学生自制的头饰收集在一起,再由每组的“小老师”通过问What’s your name? 同学回答My name’s… 的方式练习,答对的同学拿回头饰戴在头上。
4、课堂评价(Assessment)
四人或六人为一小组表演Let’s talk的对话。5、课外活动(Add-activities)
(1)要求学生听录音,然后仿读课本第4-7页的内容并拌有动作表演。
(2)鼓励学生用第4-7页所学的内容与同学和老师进行交流。
板书设计:_
三年级上册英语教案 篇11
【教具准备】
单词卡片。
小动物头饰。
3、教材相配套的教学课件。
4、教材相配套的教学录音带。
【教学过程】
热身/复习(Warm-up/Revision)
1、Listen and do
教师发出口令,(big/small …), 孩子听到口令后用动作表演。
2、说反义词
教师说small,孩子说出big。
呈现新课 (Presentation)
1、教师出示Let's learn部分的挂图,让孩子说说What can you see?
让孩子用学过的词描述一下看到的动物。
2、出示Let's learn部分录像,学生认读tall short giraffe deer四个单词;教师出示词卡,让孩子用动作表现词义。
3、黑板上贴出所有学过的描述性单词,让孩子把单词和相应的形象连在一起。
然后用完整的句子描述。教师可告诉学生或让学生自己归纳:单词short有两种意思, 所以有两个反义词long和 tall。
4、Sing the song
教师在黑板上贴出所有学过的动物图片,让孩子说一说。
听录音,让孩子边听,边上前指出。
听录音,边听边举手中的动物头饰。
小组里表演歌曲,带上头饰表演,边演边唱。
(三)趣味操练 (Practice)
活动一:听一听,做一做
教师出示单词卡片(形容词+物品名称。如:a long ruler), 孩子根据要求,找到物品,最快的获胜。
活动二:Listen and draw
听一听,画一画
教师用英语说出要求:Draw a big bag/…
孩子根据要求画出物品,然后小组比一比谁画的好,比一比谁的大,谁的小。
三年级上册英语教案 篇12
第一课:Greeting and Introduction(问候与自我介绍)
目标:学生能够用英语进行简单的问候和自我介绍。
教学步骤:
1. 问候学生并介绍自己。
T: Hello, everyone! My name is Mr./Mrs. [教师姓名]. What's your name?
2. 学生回答教师的问候。
S: Hello, Mr./Mrs. [教师姓名]. My name is [学生姓名].
3. 教师示范学生回答并提问其他学生。
T: Nice to meet you, [学生姓名]. How are you?
4. 学生回答教师的问题。
S: I'm fine, thank you. And you?
5. 教师回答学生的问题并示范其他学生回答。
T: I'm great, thank you.
6. 学生模仿教师回答问题。
7. 教师引导学生进行自我介绍。
T: Now, let's practice introducing ourselves. Say "Hello, my name is [学生姓名]. I'm [学生年龄] years old. Nice to meet you."
8. 学生模仿教师自我介绍并自由发挥。
S: Hello, my name is [学生姓名]. I'm [学生年龄] years old. Nice to meet you.
9. 教师和学生互相问候并自我介绍。
10. 拓展练习:学生分成小组,进行互相问候和自我介绍的练习。
评估与反馈:
教师观察学生的回答和自我介绍是否准确流利。可以根据学生的表现给予鼓励或提出改进的建议。
第二课:Numbers(数字)
目标:学生能够正确地拼写和朗读1-20的数字。
教学步骤:
1. 教师出示数字卡片,介绍数字1-20。
T: Look at these cards. This is number one (1), two (2), three (3), and so on up to twenty (20).
2. 教师大声读出数字,学生跟读。
3. 学生和教师一起读出数字。
4. 教师出示数字卡片,学生回答数字。
5. 学生自己拿一张数字卡片,全班一起读出该数字。
6. 拓展练习:教师说一个数字,学生找出对应的数字卡片。
7. 学生在黑板上写下数字1-20,教师进行指导。
8. 教师出示错乱的数字卡片,学生帮助教师正确排序。
评估与反馈:
教师观察学生对数字的正确理解和发音。可以进行一些口头或书面测试,检查学生的掌握程度。
第三课:Colors(颜色)
目标:学生能够正确地命名常见的颜色。
教学步骤:
1. 教师出示彩色卡片,介绍颜色的名称。
T: Look at these cards. This is red, blue, green, yellow, and so on.
2. 学生一起跟着教师读出颜色的名称。
3. 教师出示彩色卡片,学生回答颜色的名称。
4. 学生观察物品的颜色,并说出对应的颜色。
5. 教师出示彩虹图片,学生用英语说出彩虹上的颜色。
6. 学生分组进行颜色拼接游戏,每组选择一张图片,选择合适的颜色拼接在一起。
7. 拓展练习:教师描述物品的颜色,学生猜测物品并说出对应的颜色。
评估与反馈:
教师观察学生对颜色的正确理解和表达能力。可以进行一些练习,考察学生的颜色识别和命名能力。
这只是一个简单的教案示例,实际的教学过程可能涉及更多的细节和教具。教师在编写教案时应根据自己的经验和教学环境进行适当的调整和修改。希望这篇教案能对您有所帮助!
三年级上册英语教案 篇13
冀教版二年级英语上册教案
Lesson 1 A new friend
一、教学内容: Hello!Nice to meet you!What‗s your name ?-? = 2 ? + ? = 13 ?? = 11 Step 10.Song Ask the students to sing a song Step 11.Homework 1.Read the dialogue 2.Do the exercise book Lesson 20 Letters 教学重点: 学习在四线三格中正确书写英文字母 Bb , Dd, Ff , Hh , Kk , Ll , Tt的大小写。教学难点: 大写 F, 和小写 k , t的笔顺,小写 k 的书写格式。教具准备: 1.写有大小写字母卡 2.教材相配套的教学录音带 教学过程:(一)热身、复习(Warm-up/Revision)1.听写。教师发给学生每人一张四线三格纸,教师随意读出字母 Aa-Rr , 学生要在 纸上书写所听到的字母。听写完毕后学生要把写好字母的纸交给教师。2.教师出示字母卡让学生认读字母。
3.复习单词。注:要求听说的单词,让学生看图说单词。要求听、说、认读的单词, 让学生看单词卡读单词,并说出中文含义。
(二)呈现新课(Presentation)1.教学字母 Bb 教师出示单词卡 bag , 让学生读出来并说出中文。
教师问学生 bag 单词的第一个字母是什么:What letter is this? 学生回答:b。教师出示 字母卡,让学生辨别字母 Bb 的大小写。
教师在四线三格中教学字母大小写 Bb。2.教学字母 Dd , Ff , Hh , Kk , Ll , Tt.6.让学生在练习本上把所学字母 Bb--Tt每个写一行。教师在教室中巡视,及时给学 生进行辅导。7.让学生听录音带跟读模仿。让学生看单词卡拼读单词。
教师让学生看单词回答:How many letters in this word?学生回答后,让他们背着拼出单 词。教师让学生在四线三格中默写字母 b,d , f , h , k , l , t.教师教学生在四线三格中书写单词。告诉学生首先要把每个字母书写正确, 然后按照单 词的拼写把字母写在一起, 注意单词的每个字母间要有一点距离。让学生照板书抄字头, 然后每个单词写一行。(三)趣味操练(Practice)游戏:Bingo 让学生把本课所学的字母和部分单词随意写在游戏板中。教师任意说出一个字母或单 词。学生在游戏板中迅速找出教师说的字母或单词并用铅笔在字母或单词上画一个圈。每画 出完整的一行或一列字母或单词, 学生就说 Bingo!直到所有的字母和单词都圈完。让学生擦 去画的圈, 重新再做一次游戏。由于教师念字母或单词的顺序不一样, 每次圈的顺序也不一 样。在游戏结束以后,全班一起复习词汇。(四)扩展性活动(Add-activities)Looking for the letter‘ s family
准备好已学过的字母卡片。把大小写字母卡片发给学生。告诉学生字母和其相应的单词组成 一个家庭,看谁能帮字母找到家庭。教师发出指令,学生开始寻找。Lesson 21 Let‗s write.教学目标:
1、能听、说、读、写单词 school..2、能熟练运用对话中的交际用语并会写句型 May I have„ ?Sure!I‗m sorry.I don‗t have.教学过程:
一、Warm up 1.Sing a song :Hello.2.Greetings: May I come in ? Yes ,come in ,please.3.Free talk.May I have „ ? Yes /Sure.使用学过的交际用语进行对话。
二、Revision.学生用自己的实物表演 Read and say中的对话。1.师引导学生对话 2.学生之间交际练习。
三、Presentation and practice.1.学习单词 a pen ,a pencil ,a marker , a notebook ,a book.(1)利用实物学习单词 : a pencil.T: What‗s this in English ? Oh ,It‗s a pencil.Do you like pencil ? S: Yes.听录音,生跟读。
(2)同法学习单词 a marker,a book ,a notebook.2.Play a game : What‗s missing ?
游戏规则:将 a book ,a marker ,a notebook ,a pencil的图片贴在黑板上,让一学生背对黑板 , 师拿掉任一张图,让学生猜出缺少的那张图片。T:What‗ missing ?
S: The pencil.(指学生将图片放回原位)(这个游戏的目的是为了让学生在听、说、读方面巩固这些单词。)3.拼写单词。
T:(出示一支钢笔):What ‘ s this in English? S:It‗s a pen.T :(出示单词卡片 a pen)Now Let‘ s read and spell the word ― pen ‖ : Pen , p-e-n, pen.让 学生练,拼读,并进行单词背诵。Ss: Pen ,P-E-N, pen.(让学生拼读,书写单词 a pen).4.同法拼写单词 a ruler ,a pen ,a book ,a pencil , a marker, a notebook.师指导单词的拼写方式,例如利用新旧单词的迁移(a book— a notebook)教会学生有效地 记忆单词。
四、Work in pairs.1.出示 C 部分 Ask and answer的图画。(以图 1为例,引导学生问答)T :May I have the pencil? S: Yes /Sure.Here you are.2.师板书句型 May I have „ ? Yes /Sure.Here you are.3.创设语言训练情景:将学生带来的物品分类,通过开设文具店的形式进行对话操 练。(此处练习时将学生分成组进行)如:a pen , a ruler.Lesson 22 My body.Language focus: Using nouns to identify parts of body e.g.eye,mouth,nose,ear,hand,arm,toe.Using pronouns to refer to particular things.e.g.This is my hand.Using imperatives to catch people‗s attention.e.g.Look!Using possessive adjectives to express possession e.g.This is my arm.Using imperatives to give simple instructions.e.g.Wave your hand.Touch your nose.Language skills: Listening: Locate specific information in response to simple instructions.Indentify key words in an utterance by recognizing stress.Speaking: Prounce words properly.Use modelled phrases to communicate with other learners.Materials: Student‗s Book A Pages 44-45 Cassette A Cassette player Workbook 44 Some pictures Teathing method: 交际法,全身动作反应法,演示法.Teathing Procedure: Pre-task preparation 1.Revise the classroom instruction language students have learnt,e.g: Stand up, please.Give me...Raise your hand.Put it down, etc.Ask the students to listen and act.2.Greetings with boys ang girls,e.g.:What do you like? Do you have a...? How old are you?Then sing a song:Read,read,I can read...Ask the weather of today,get the ss to draw on the board.Teather draws an eye on the sun‗s face,invite one student to finish drawing(the other eye),teach the word — eye.3.Draw a boy and a girl(not finshed),ask: What‘ s missing? Teach the words— mouth, nose,ear in the same way.Get the ss to do the actions like these: Open /Close your mouth /eye.(朗读时声音 起伏变化,由低到高,或听掌声的次数朗读单词.)4.Have a match between boys and girls----Listen and touch the word.Put the boy and girl‗s pictures on the Bb,get the ss to listen to the commands and touch the pictures.If any of them wins, he/she can get a red star,e.g.: T: Eye!/Mouth!/Ear!/Nose!While-task procedure 1.Ss do the actions after the tescher: Touch your ear/nosr/mouth/hand!Teach the word— hand,ask: How many hands are there? One hand, two hands.Review – Raise your hand, Teach – Wave your hand,explain the meaning of the expression in English(Good-bye).2.Teach the words – arm/toe in the same way.Ask :How many arms/toes are there? Get the ss tocount them.Ss look at the Bb,listen and repeat the seven new words.3.Play the tape for the ss to listen and do the actions for twice.(注:教材中富有节奏的 chant 和欢 快地歌曲激发了学生很强的表演欲,使学生在欢乐中体验英语的趣味与巩固新知识) in pairs.Ask the ss to do the actions in pairs.One student give a command, the other student does the action, then change the roles.Finally, get some individual ss to order in the front.Play the tape for the ss to listen and repeat.Post-task activities 1.Teacher points to her nose and says---Look!This is my nose./ Look!This is my eye /toe/hand!Ask the ss read togdther when they do the actions.Pay attention to pointing their body first when they say. in pairs for some minutes.Then ask individual ss to show in the nsolidation: Workbook page 13: Listen and draw the part of the body.Draw the missing parts on the face, then ask them to talk about it Homework: Listen and repeat Lesson 22 on pages 44-45 Lesson 23 Letters 教学重点: 学习在四线三格中正确书写英文字母 Vv , Ww , Xx , Zz 的大小写。教学难点: 大写 X, 和小写 x 的书写格式。教具准备: 1.写有大小写字母卡 2.教材相配套的教学录音带 教学过程:(一)热身、复习(Warm-up/Revision)1.听写。教师发给学生每人一张四线三格纸,教师随意读出字母 Aa-Tt , 学生要在 纸上书写所听到的字母。听写完毕后学生要把写好字母的纸交给教师。2.教师出示字母卡让学生认读字母。
3.复习单词。注:要求听说的单词,让学生看图说单词。要求听、说、认读的单词, 让学生看单词卡读单词,并说出中文含义。
(二)呈现新课(Presentation)1.教学字母 Vv 教师出示字母卡 Vv , 让学生想象它像什么。
教师带着学生一起书写 Vv.教师在四线三格中教学字母大小写 Vv。2.教学字母 Ww , Xx , Zz.6.让学生在练习本上把所学字母 Vv---Zz 每个写一行。教师在教室中巡视,及时给学 生进行辅导。7.让学生听录音带跟读模仿。让学生看卡片读字母。玩炸弹游戏
教师让学生在四线三格中默写字母 Vv , Ww , Xx , Zz.注意每个字母间要有一点距离。(三)趣味操练(Practice)游戏:Bingo 由于教师念字母的顺序不一样, 每次圈的顺序也不一样。在游戏结束以后, 全班一起复习字母。(四)扩展性活动(Add-activities)Looking for the letter‘ s family
准备好已学过的字母卡片。把大小写字母卡片发给学生。告诉学生字母和其相应的单词组成 一个家庭,看谁能帮字母找到家庭。教师发出指令,学生开始寻找。Lesson 24 Again , please!教学目的: 1.通过复习,学生能熟练掌握本单元所学的单词和字母。2.通过复习与活动,学生能综合运用本单元所学的日常用语。教学过程: Step 1 Free talk 1.本单元教师可采用比较活泼的问候方式, 例如:教师唱:― Hello!hello!How are you? Hello!Hello!How are you?‖学生用歌声回答:― I ‘ m fine, thank you.I‘ m fine, thank you.‖教师 唱― Good morning!Good morning!Good morning to you.‖学生也以歌声作答.2.师生进行接歌比赛。(此举旨在活跃气氛, 调动学生的情绪。为下面的复习活动做好准备。)Step 2 Guessing game 1.师生各自在手里拿一样东西,背在身后。用― Is this„? Is that„?‖提问,用 ― Yes , it is./No, it isn‘ t.‖ 回答.如果猜对了 , 一方可再问 ― Can I have a look?‖ , 并用 ― Sure, here you are.‖ 来回答。教师要引导学生用这样的方式互相要对方的东西看 , 并会用 ― What a nice„!‖ 来表达赞叹.2.使用课件。1)看图猜物。
出示一幅被覆盖的图, 每点击一次鼠标就会露出一小部分, 逐渐显露出被覆盖的全图。学生 在此过程中用 ― What ‘ s this? It‘ s „.‖来猜。(尽量使用后半学期的单词图片。)2)辩音猜物。
屏幕出现若干窗户,鼠标点击不同窗口发出不同声音,学生根据各种声音猜测,如果猜对, 则开窗出现所猜物品;猜错则怪叫不开窗。(此项活动适用于乐器、动物及交通工具等单词。)教师同时与学生讨论― What do you play? Do you like„? Do you play„?‖ Step 3 Role play 1.在上一个情景的基础上,引导学生邀请 Danny 去打排球,引入 ― Where is he? Is he in the „?(复习六个房间的名称), Where is he? He is in the shop.‖转入 Look and say的第一 部分,让学生根据图画遍对话并进行表演配音。
2.由― Where is Li Ming ?‖转入 Look and say的第二部分,引导学生看图并自编对话进行 表演,以此复习第 21课的教学内容。Step 4 Listen and circle 1.由教师藏起铅笔提问― Where is the pencil ?‖引导学生猜想并回答,之后学生间互 相问答铅笔,彩笔等学习用品在哪, 2.教师自制录音带,学生通过听对话完成 Listen and circle。同时复习17课的内容。3.通过歌谣复习数字,并通过数学算式复习加减法。4.通过 What ‘ s missing ?的游戏复习所学的字母。Step 5 Homework 1.经过以上几个环节, 本单元复习内容基本都以涉及到, 但并未全部按书上的原有形式出 现。2.将所学的字母作为家庭字母复习。Lesson 25: Tall and short
一、教学内容 tall shortWho is tall?
二、教学目标
1、知识方面:能听懂、会说并口头运用下列词汇:tall ,short
2、能力方面:① 促进学生思维能力的发展,提高学生的语言运用能力。② 培养学生熟练用单词、流利说英语的能力。
三、教学重难点 Tall and short
四、教具准备课件 , 录音机
五、教学步骤 Step 1: Greeting The student know the subject of this lesson from a game that they played in Unit 3.Step2: New Concepts
1、·Tell the students to think about what do the studentsthink Danny is doing in the top panel ? What has happened in the lower panel? Disscuss as a class possibilities of what is happening in these pictures?
2、Listen.Ask the student to listen the first time,then follow the audiotape the second time.Give each student a page for printing.3、Sing a song.Before you play the audiotape ,go over the words of the song and translate them Paly the song again,and ask the students to sing along this time as they do the actions.Step 3: Game: Am I Tall or short? 1.Divide the class into groups with five or six students per group.2.Tell the students to make himself appear to be taller or shorter.Step4:Read after the tape.Stp5:Use the activity book· Page 51 Listen and write.Tall or short?students write a t for tal or an s for short beside each picture.Stop the audiotape.Tell the students that the next question will be a challenge.This question is about someone from a long time age:the class learned about this person in Grade 1!Step 6: Ending Lesson 26: Clothes for boys and girls
一、教学内容 Skirt, pants ,shirt and blouse.Learn to sing
二、教学目标
1、知识方面:能听懂、会说并口头运用下列词汇:Skirt pants shirt and blouse.2、能力方面:① 促进学生思维能力的发展,提高学生的语言运用能力。② 培养学生熟练用单词、流利说英语的能力。
三、教学重难点 Skirt, pants ,shirt and blouse.四、教具准备图片、录音机
五、教学步骤 Step 1:Free Talk T:How do you feel? Step2: New Concepts ·1 Hode up your copy of the student book and name each of these four items of clothing as you point to them.2 Who can find the same word on the page 53? Tell them that the column of words on the left is the days of the week.What words listed beside Sunday? What word is listed beside Monday? 3 Listen to the tape 4 Have every one point to the matching picture as you say the words:skirt,pants,blouse,shirt.5 Girls can wear pants and shirts ,too,but boys never wear blouse ,skirts or dresses.Step 3:Use the activity book Page 53.Write the words.Students write the appropriate word beside each picture,using the words at the bottom of the page as a guide.Step4: Sing a song.1 Go over the words to the song.Listen and read.Step 5: Ending Lesson 27:Favourite colour
一、教 学 内 容 :white, black, pink and brown.二、教学目标
1、知识方面:能听懂、会说并口头运用下列词汇:white, black, pink and brown.2、能力方面:① 促进学生思维能力的发展,提高学生的语言运用能力。② 培养学生熟练用单词、流利说英语的能力。
三、教学重难点 What ‘ s your favourite colour?
四、教具准备录音机,单词卡片
五、教学步骤 Step 1: Greeting Step 2: Review Create a chart display of the colours that students already know(blue,green,yellow,red,orange,purple)Step3: New Concepts 1.Using the chart introduce them to the new colours 2.Hode up the book so that everyone can see page 54,and have the students point to on the two characters.3.Point to each words and have the class say its name together with you.Step 4: Text 1.Open your books.2.Listen to the tape.3、Read after the tape.Step 5:Game 1 Ask the students to form two circles around the perimeter of the classyoom,an inner circle and an outer circle.2 The sudent say a dialogue to each other ,outlind below.3 Tell the inner circle of students to shift to the left,ask the students in the outer circle to begin the dialogue this time.4 Ask the outer circle to the shift to the right.Step 6: Ending Lesson 28:Socks and shoes
一、教学内容 Socks, shoes, T-shirt and shorts
二、教学目标
1、知识方面:能听懂、会说并口头运用下列词汇:Socks, shoes, T-shirt and shorts
2、能力方面:① 能运用所学单词进行熟练的对话。② 培养学生熟练用单词、流利说英语的能力。
三、教学重难点 _ is wearing _
四、教具准备课件、录音机
五、教学步骤
Step 1:Free Talk Step 2: Review ·Continue to display your chart of the colours.Step3: New Concepts ·1 Have one of the volunteers hode up his foot so that everyone can see.Point to the sock and the shoe,naming each item in English,and have the class repeat these words.2 Listen 3 Students learned a similar word in the first lesson :short.What‗s the opposite of short? 4 Explain that long is also the opposite of short.The article of clothing called shorts is similar to pants but shorter in length.5 Divide the class into pairs of students.The students ar to respond in English using the vocabulary from this unit about clothing and colour.Step 4: Game.Hold up four vocabulary cards so that everyone in the class can see.Tell the class to look at the cards for one minute, then close eyes.remove cards.Ask them to open eyes and fingure out which card you have removed Show the class the missing card to verify the answer.Step 5:Use the activity book Page 56.Listen and point.PAGE 57.Find the card.Word search.Step 6: Ending Lesson 29:Old and new.一、教学内容 Old and new
二、教学目标
1、知识方面:能听懂、会说并口头运用下列词汇:old ,new.2、能力方面:① 促进学生思维能力的发展,提高学生的语言运用能力。② 培养学生熟练用单词、流利说英语的能力。
三、教学重难点 New and old
四、教具准备录音机
五、教学步骤 Step 1: Greeting Step 2: Review Review the number from one to twenty.Step3: New Concepts Who remembers what is the opposite of old? Explain the young and old describe living things:people or animals.·When we are talking about things we still use the word old,but instead of young ,we say new.Step 4: Text 1.Open your books.2.Listen to the tape.3.Read after the tape.Step5: Sing a song.Listen to the tape.Read after it.Ask for two volunteers.One of them chooses a colour and the other chooses an item of clothing.Step 6:Use the activity book Page 58Listen and colour.Page 59.Make the new clothes old.Step 7: Ending Lesson 30: Let‗s learn the letters.一、教学内容 g ,j,p,q,y
二、教学目标
1、知识方面:会拼,读,写下列字母:g ,j,p,q,y
2、能力方面:① 促进学生思维能力的发展,提高学生的语言运用能力。② 教给字母表
三、教学重难点 g ,j,p,q,y的拼,读,写
四、教具准备课件、录音机
五、教学步骤 Step 1: Greeting Step 2:Review Sing the alphabet song.Step3: New Concepts 1.Tell the class that the words beside the girl describe something that she is wearing.2.Tell the class that they will find out by listening to the audiotape.3.Listen 4.Discuss: Did anyone understand what Danny said? 5.Simply translate the line.6.Listen and discuss,what ‗s the same about the letter y in yellow and the letter p in pants? 7.Tell them tio say each letter as you point to it on your chart.Step 4: Text 1.Open your books.2.Listen to the tape again.3.Read after the tape.Step 5: Use the activity book ·Page 60.Write the letters with tails.Students practice writing the new letters they learned today.Step 6 :Game Everyone should have one letter.You will have a complete set.Is this letter tall or short? This letter is a _.Who has a _? The students may do the actions along with the words they speak out.Step 7: Ending Lesson 31: Shapes and clothes
一、教学内容复习本单元学过的单词,与颜色。
二、教学目标
1.知识目标 : 复习本单元学过的单词,与颜色。
2.情感态度 : 对所进行的英语活动感兴趣,进一步提高学习英语的积极性。
三、教学重难点将颜色与形状有机的结合
四、教具准备录音机
五、教学步骤 Step 1: Review Review the letters that students learned in the previous lesson(g,j,p,q,y).Review the entire alphabet in the correct order.Step 2: New Concepts 1.Students pointing first to the picture of the appropriate item,then to the words ,and repeat the words with you.2.Who remembers Danny said? Which items of clothing has green circle?How many triangles are in the dress? How many triangles are there all together on page 62? Disscuss briefly,or simply translate ,then move on.3.Hve the class notice how these shapes are used to form articles of clothing.Each time ask the class:Who can tell me what this word says.Craft :encourage your students to make whatever they like using different kinds of shapes.Step 4: Use the activity book Page 62-63.Ask them to guess how many circle there unt circles.Tell the correct answer.Ask the m how many triangles there are.Repeat with the shapes.Step 5: Ending Lesson 32: Again, Please!
一、教学内容 复习字母:g,j,p,q,y 复习形容词:tall and short new and old 复习名词:blouse ,shirt,pants,shoes and clothes
二、教学目标
1、知识方面:①能听懂、会说、会写、会运用本单元四会单词、四会句型。②能听懂、会说、会运用本单元的教学内容进行会话。
2、能力方面:①根据知识目标,学生能够在真实情景中运用单词、句型表达情感。②在自主的学习、成功的体验中进一步提高学生学习英语的积极性和主动性。
三、教学重难点
1.本单元的四会单词、四会句型。2.将所学的指示联系起来。
四、教具准备课件、录音机
五、教学步骤 Step 1: Greeting Step 2: Review Today we will rewiew some of the things that that they learned in Unit 4,and have fun.Remember that the list of the words and phrases displayed on page 64.Step 3:Test Games: Am I tall or short? Double circle.Song and charts:The clothes song;New and old;Tall or short.Use the activity book..Page 64.Listen.Write the words.Students write the listed words in the space provided.Page 65.Fill in the words.Students add letters to complete each word with the grid,using the words at the bottom of the page as a guide.Step 4: Ending
三年级上册英语教案 篇14
教学总目标:
激发学生对英语的好奇心,使他们喜欢听他人说英语,能根据教师简单的指令做动作、做事情、做游戏。能做简单的角色表演。能唱简单的英文歌曲,说简单的英语歌谣。能在图片的帮助下听懂和读懂简单的小故事。能交流简单的个人信息,表达简单的感觉和情感。能模仿范例书写词句。在学习中乐于模仿,敢于表达,对英语有一定的感知能力,读应学习中接触的外国文化习俗感兴趣。
教学措施:
1.以活动为课堂教学的主要形式,设计丰富多彩的教学活动,让学生在乐中学、学中用,从而保证学生英语学习的可持续发展。
2.在教学过程中,采用情景教学法,让学生身临其境,积极主动参与到课堂教学中去,调动学生的非智力因素,提高学生实际运用语言的能力。
3.通过听、说、读、写、唱、游、演、画、做等形式,进行大量的语言操练和练习。
4.培养学生拼读单词的能力,确保学生自主学习的质量。
5.设计全面、高效的课外作业,培养学生良好的书写习惯,做到整洁、规范、正确地书写。
6.活用教材,根据学生的实际情况,将每个单元各个板块进行整合,重组,降低难度。
实施方案:
1.激发学生的学习欲望,设计真实的场景,真实的人物,在学中学会交际。
2.在日常生活中要求学生多说多练。
3.规范学生的书写,养成良好的书写习惯。
4.引导学生的各种感官来学习英语,如眼、耳、口、鼻、身等。充分利用学生的各种才能组织安排课堂,如唱歌、跳舞、画画等。
三年级上册英语教案 篇15
教学目标:
1、 技能与知识目标
(1)能听懂并会说、会读Good afternoon. 和What’s your name? I’m x x.的句型。
(2)能听懂并会说、会读词汇 your, name, afternoon.
2、运用能力目标
能在不同时间段,正确地向他人问好。(上午:Good morning! 下午:Good afternoon!)能用What’s your name?来询问他人姓名。通过歌曲的学习培养孩子的乐感与美感,增强学科间的'融合。
教学重点:
能听懂并会说会读Good afternoon! What’s your name? I’m… 及词汇your ,name, afternoon.
教学难点:
name 中的 /m/ 与 afternoon中 /n/的发音。
教学过程:
一、Warm up
1.运用所学问候语进行师生间,生生间对话练习。 “Good morning! I’m …” “How are you? I’m fine. And how are you? I’m fine ,too. Thank you.”
2.同学们今天表现不错,那我们一起来做个游戏吧。活动帮助学生分清“boys与girls”的用法。速度由慢到快,指令可交替进行。
二、Lead in
OK!boys and girls ,you’ve done a good job. Look!老师左右手各持一手偶,通过变换音调来演一段对话,引出本课重点:What’s your name ? 手偶1:Hi, I’m Mr.Li . What’s your name? 手偶2: Hello, I’m Sam.
三、Text teaching
1.同学们现在我是Mr.Li不是Ms.Liu,老师说话的声音变粗。老师将Mr. Li的头饰带在头上与学生对话: Mr. Li: Hello! Good morning. Ss: Good morning. Mr. Li: what’s your name? Ss: I’m x x.
2.播放一遍录音,要求学生听录音指图片。再次播放对话,要求学生跟读2—3遍; 老师纠正学生的发音。
3.让学生以小组为单位开始朗读对话内容,并对个体学生进行抽查。
4.传话游戏 大家在班里男女生之间要用礼貌的语言互相问候,这个游戏就是看男生与女生谁的礼貌用语说的。举例: 老师:Girls whisper. 女孩:(耳语)Good morning, boys. 老师:Boys low. 男孩:(低声说)Good morning, girls. 用“Good afternoon”做同样的游戏。
5.歌曲“Good morning,Sam”。同学们今天我们要学习一首好听的英文歌曲,学完后四人小组把歌词进行改可将“Good morning!”改为“Good afternoon”。由四人小组向大家表演改编后的歌曲,评出优秀小组。
四、Sum upw
We’ve learned a very sweet new song and done some interesting exercise.
五、Homework
Sing the new song to your parents and listen to the tape twice.
九年级英语上册教案6篇
以下内容“九年级英语上册教案”是幼儿教师教育网小编从网络收集整理的。上课前准备好课堂用到教案课件很重要,又到了写教案课件的时候了。做足了教案课件的前期准备,这样才能达到预期的教学目标。还请多多关注我们网站!
九年级英语上册教案(篇1)
一、教学目标:
1、语言知识目标
基本词汇:restroom, stamp, bookstore, postcard, pardon, washroom, bathroom, normal, rush, suggest, staff, grape, central, mail, east, fascinating, convenient, mall, clerk, corner, polite, politely, speaker, request, direction, correct, direct, whom, address, underground
基本句型:Excuse me, do you know where I can buy some medicine?
Sure. There’s a supermarket down the street.
Could you please tell me how to get to the post office?
Sorry, I’m not sure how to get there.
I wonder where we should go next.
Could you tell us when the band starts playing this evening?
You should try that new ride over there.
2、 技能目标:
(1)能用宾语从句礼貌的寻求帮助。
(2)能用正确的方法指路。
3、情感目标:
培养学生尊重他人,对人有礼貌,热爱生活。
二、教学重难点:
1、教学重点:
(1)礼貌的向他人寻求帮助。
(2)正确使用宾语从句。
2、 教学难点:
运用宾语从句礼貌的寻求帮助。
三、教学步骤:
Section A 1 (1a-2d)
Step 1 Warming –up
Greeting
Step 2 Presentation
(1)Guessing game
Show pictures to the whole class, one student explains the places in English and another one who doesn’t look at the blackboard guesses what place it is. For example, one student say: We can save money or exchange money in this place, another one guess it is a bank. Get students to guess the places like bank, post office, bookstore, museum, bathroom, washroom, mall and so on.
(2)Show some stamps to students and present the new sentences:
Could you tell me where I can buy some stamps?
Could you please tell me where I can get a dictionary?
Do you know where I can get some magazines?
Step 3 Practice
1) Match each thing with a place in the picture in 1a.
2) Read the phrases.
___ get some money
___ get some magazines
___ have dinner
___ get a dictionary
___ get some information about the town
___ buy a newspaper
___ buy some stamps
___ get a pair of shoes
Step 4 Listening
Listen and complete the conversations in the picture in 1a. Then check the answers with the whole class.
Step 5 Practice
Make conversations using the information in 1a. Then talk about your own city. For example:
A: Excuse me, could you please tell me how to get to the bookstore?
B: Sure, just go along Main Street until you pass Center Street. The bookstore is on your right, beside the bank.
A: Thanks. Do you know when the bookstore closes today?
B: It closes at 7:00 p.m. today.
A: Thank you!
B: You’re welcome.
Step 6 Listening
1. Listen and number the directions in the order that you hear them.
2a You will hear some of the directions below. Number the directions in the order you hear them.
___ Go to the bird floor.
___ Turn left.
___ Go to the second floor.
___ Turn right.
___ The supermarket is between the flower store and the bookstore.
___ Go past the bookstore.
2. Listen again. Show how the boy walks to the supermarket. Draw a line in the picture in 2a. Then get one student draw the line on the blackboard.
3. Listen the third time and answer the questions.
1) Excuse me, can you tell me where I can buy some medicine?
2) Do you know how to go there?
3) OK, great. Oh, and one more thing. Do you know when this shopping center closes tonight?
4) OK, thanks a lot.
Step 7 Pairwork
Make conversations about the other places in the picture in 2a.
A: Excuse me. Can you tell me where I can buy some stamps?
B: Yes, there’s a post office in this shopping center.
A: Do you know how to go there?
B: Yes. Go to the third floor and turn right. Then go past the bank. The post office is between museum and library. You should be able to get stamps.
A: OK, great. Oh, and one more thing. Do you know …
B: I’m not sure, but you …
A: OK, thanks a lot.
B: You’re welcome.
Step 8 Reading
1. Read the conversation in 2d and answer the questions.
2. Role – play the conversation.
3. Explain the language pints in 2d.
(1) Go along Main Street until you pass Center Street.
1) until和 till同义为“直到……” ,till多用于口语,until可以放在句首,till则不能放在句首。
2) l“直到……才”,表示直到某一时间, 某一行为才发生, 之前该行为并没有发生。
e.g. I did not study English until 9 o'clock last night.
(2) Pardon? Restroom? You already want to rest? But we haven’t even started yet!
1) pardon用作动词,后面既可以跟宾语,也可以跟双宾语;pardon sb. for doing sth.意为“原谅/宽恕某人做某事”
e.g. Can you pardon me for not passing the exam, Mom?
2) 在没有听懂对方的话,请对方重复一 下时也可说 pardon。
e.g. Pardon? I’m sorry I can’t follow you.
(3) I’m excited to try the rides!
excited和 exciting的区别:
1) excited意为“激动的;兴奋的”,作表语时,主语通常是人;作定语时,常用来修饰人,说明激动的表情。
e.g. All of us were excited when we heard the good news.
The excited child opened his present quickly.
2) exciting意为“激动人心的”,作表语时,主语通常是物;作定语时,常用来修饰物。
e.g. The movie is very exciting.
My father told me an exciting story.
(4) I mean … you know, a washroom or bathroom.
mean作动词有以下含义:
1) 有……的意思,指(多作及物动词),其后可跟名词或代词,也可跟从句。
e.g. What does this word mean?
2)意味(着)(及物动词),常跟名词,有时可跟动词-ing形式或从句。
e.g. Carl really could not do that — it would mean the end of his career.
3)有……意图,打算,想,常跟名词、代词或动词不定式。跟带不定式
的复合结构时,还可用于被动语态。
e.g. I never meant to hurt you.
四、总结
(略)
九年级英语上册教案(篇2)
【教材分析】
1、教学内容分析:本模块的话题是谈论书、作家、思想家、戏影、诗歌等,九年级上册教案。语法是一般现在时被动语态。
2、学情分析:谈论书、作家、思想家等是学生感兴趣的话题。本模块的学习是通过该话题的讨论,学习并掌握一般现在时被动语态的肯定句、否定句、一般疑问句和特殊疑问句。对于本单元,需要学生能应用所学知识点读懂介绍和评价文学作品的.文章,谈论自己喜欢的文学作品,写短文介绍和评价自己所喜欢的文章。
【学法指导】
1、虚心向同学学习,分工合作完成任务。
2、将本校的三体五环多元评价的模式与现有科技资源结合为学习和生活服务。
【学习目标】
1、knowledgeaims:Keyvocabulary---behaviour,cave,freedom,funeral,social,theme,treasure,clever,dead,pleased,alive,southern,state,runaway,for a time,grow up,talk aboutKeystructures---Passive voice.
2、Abilityaims:To getinformation from the reading passage about The Adventures of TomSawyer;To write ashort passage about your favourite great book.
3、Feelingaims:Reading books is an importantway to get knowledge them to read more books andreadgood books by learning this lesson hemown morewisdom and improvetheirquality by reading books.
【重点难点】
1、Newwords and phrases.
2、How tointroduce a book.
【课型】
Reading and writing.
【教具】
cards,tape recorder,a smallblackboard,paper.
【教学过程】
Step 1导学激趣
1、Arousethe Ss’ interest by using some questions:
(1) Have youread novels?
(2)What novels have you read?
(3)What doyou think of it?
2、 Learnnew words(cards )Intentions: To draw attention to this lesson.
Step 2 自主质疑
1、listento the tape,pay attention to the pronunciation and try to masterthe main ideas of eachparagraph.
2、read thepassage by yourself and go on thinking the main idea of eachparagraph,and underline the problems you cant solve by e same time ,think about two questions.
Step 3互动释疑
Discussthe problems in groups and try to solve them and summarize thecheckpoints ,write them in the paper they have.
Step 4 知识梳理
Let thestudents show the checkpoints in front of the class ,the teacherexplain the difficult points.
Step 5 反馈提高
1、Group them discuss whatre themainelements if they want to introduce abook.
2、Think about a good book they read,andintrouduce it to the others,if necessary write them down on theirpaper .
九年级英语上册教案(篇3)
冀教版英语九年级上册说课稿 Lesson 1: Higher, Faster, Stronger
作为一位杰出的老师,时常要开展说课稿准备工作,说课稿有助于学生理解并掌握系统的知识。那么问题来了,说课稿应该怎么写?以下是小编整理的冀教版英语九年级上册说课稿 Lesson 1: Higher, Faster, Stronger,希望能够帮助到大家。
我说课的内容是冀教版初中英语第五册Unit1 The Olympics Lesson 1: Higher, Faster, Stronger.下面我主要从教材分析、教学方法、学法指导和教学过程等四个方面作具体的说明。
一、教材分析:
本单元的中心话题是The Olympics,而第29界奥运会去年在北京举行,学生对奥运会很感兴趣,这就为学好本课提供了保障。本课是本单元的第一课时,题目是“更高,更快,更强”,既是奥林匹克的口号,也是国际奥委会对所有参与奥林匹克运动的人们的号召,号召他们本着奥林匹克的精神奋力向上。本课课文围绕着“奥运会的起源,发展以及奥运选手”而展开的。学生通过本课学习掌握一些与奥运会有关的单词、短语和句型。使学生更加了解有关奥运会的常识,培养他们为国争光的爱国情感;在学习中发扬“更快、更高、更强”的奥运精神。
根据《英语课程标准》的要求、教材特点以及我校九年级学生的实际情况,我将本课时的教学目标及重难点确定如下:
知识与技能:
1、学习并掌握有关奥运的词汇及短语:modern, gold, record, event, twentieth, win a gold medal. ancient, medal, shooting, athlete, silver, bronze, sprint.
2、能听懂、读懂有关奥运话题的语段。
3、能够谈论奥运会的起源、运动项目及自己喜欢的运动员。
过程与方法:
1、利用北京奥运会主题歌及精彩的奥运图片导入新课,创设情境,激发学生兴趣。
2、通过分组学习,使学生加深对课文的理解程度,培养学生自主学习、合作探究的能力。
3、通过学习中外著名运动员的经历,培养学生的竞争意识。
情感态度与价值观:
在学习中,敢于用英语来表达自己的'看法,培养学习英语的兴趣和学好英语
的勇气,乐意了解异地文化。通过了解著名的奥运人物,增强为国争光和努力、勤奋、拼搏的意识,培养爱国情感,发扬自强不息的精神,为实现自己的理想而奋斗。
教学重点和难点:
1、正确理解课文,对奥运会有更充分的了解,并能用英语表达相关的单词,短语和句子。
2、用英语描述奥运会及奥运风云人物。
二、教学方法:
为了体现《英语课程标准》的理念,更好地突出重点、突破难点。本节课主要采用任务型教学方法(Task-based Language Teaching),以三个任务为核心,引导学生在做和玩的过程中学习英语,体验成功,感受英语学习的乐趣,培养学生的团队意识,提高学生的主动性和参与性,使学生成为课堂的真正主人。同时、采用多媒体辅助教学,更好地激发学生的学习兴趣。通过歌曲、图片等为学生创设生动活泼的语言环境,激发他们学习的欲望。
三、学法指导:
美国著名心理学家布鲁纳说过:“对学生的最好刺激乃是对所学教材的兴趣。”在设计本节课时我适当整合了部分内容,以任务为核心、以学生为主体,倡导自主学习、合作学习,在课堂教学中引导学生进行小组讨论、猜测游戏、竞赛等与他人合作,鼓励学生通过感知、体验、实践、参与与实践等方式,积极思考,实现任务的目标,感受成功的喜悦。
四、教学过程:
本节课以任务型语言教学为原则,设计了三个主要任务:一个是The history of the Olympics.第二个是Olympic sports.第三个是Your favourite Olympic ath- lete.
Task One:The history of the Olympics.
在这个任务中,首先播放由刘欢、莎拉·布莱曼演唱的北京奥运主题歌《我和你》,学生在老师的带领下随着歌声的旋律,能自然地联想到奥运场景,通过三个问题,引出本节课的课题——Higher, Faster, Stronger、歌曲引入营造了热烈的课堂气氛,让学生在不经意中积极发言、探讨问题,为后续活动打下基础。紧
接着分组讨论Think about it中的问题,然后引导学生欣赏一组奥运会的图片并学习本课的生词和短语,再听录音,回答关于奥运会起源的问题,将孤立的单词和图片相结合,便于学生接受,并创设问题情境,引发学生认知需要。最后各小组作出汇报。整个任务由易到难,层层深入,充分调动学生的眼、耳、口、手、脑等各个器官,学生在愉快的氛围中锻炼了听和说的能力。
Task two: Olympic sports.
首先带领学生欣赏奥运比赛的精彩图片,把Task One和Task two连接起来。然后分组讨论奥运项目,再进行竞赛,说出项目最多的小组获胜,学生对于体育项目有着浓厚的兴趣,表现欲很强,在讨论和竞赛时,不但能踊跃地说出图片中的运动项目,而且还能说出图片中没有的项目。最后做猜测游戏,教师先做一个项目的示范,学生猜测名称,再由学生轮流做动作,其余学生猜。给学生提供展示才能的舞台,把整个课堂推向高潮,学生感受到学习英语的乐趣,从而有效地培养他们的语言运用能力。
Task three: Your favourite Olympic athlete.
为了避免对课文内容的单纯讲解,充分培养学生自主学习的能力,检查学生个体的阅读能力,在这个任务开始时,让学生带着问题自己默读课文并回答,然后引导他们分小组谈论自己最喜欢的奥运明星,最后通过调查找出哪些同学喜欢的奥运明星相同。同学间加强了了解,增进了友谊。,
在课堂小节时,先播放全文录音,让学生从整体上回顾本课。之后学生自己说出奥运会的起源、项目以及奥运明星,教师点评补充,布置作业,加深学生对课文内容的理解,达到巩固提高的目的。
九年级英语上册教案(篇4)
教学目标
1. 能力目标
能听、说、认读一些常见的动物单词cat,dog, monkey, duck, panda, rabbit, 并能用英语介绍这些小动物。
能听懂一些简单的指示语,并能按照指令模仿动物做出相应的动作。
2. 情感目标
培养学生爱护动物、保护动物的意识。
教学重难点
能听、说、认读一些常见的动物单词cat,dog, monkey, duck, panda, rabbit, 并能用英语介绍这些小动物。
能听懂一些简单的指示语,并能按照指令模仿动物做出相应的动作。
教学工具
ppt课件。
教学过程
1、Warm-up
(1)Free talk(1分钟)
a. ---- Good afternoon, Fangfang.
---- Good afternoon, Lanlan.
b. ---- Hello, Xiaoling. How are you?
---- Hi, I'm fine, thank you. And you?
---- Very well, thank you.
(2)播放歌曲 Teddy Bear(要求学生边拍手边吟唱,营造一个欢乐活泼的英语气氛。)(1分钟)
(3)大小声游戏:rabbit, monkey, panda, zoo(1分钟)
教师轻声说一个单词,学生则需大声朗读。教师大声说,学生则轻声说。
(设计思路:活跃气氛,融洽师生情感,激发学生参与课堂活动的热情,使学生迅速进入英语学习的状态,并帮助学生巩固了上节课的单词。)
2.entation
教师课前在黑板上用彩色粉笔画一个动物园的图案。
(1)教学duck
a.教师画一个duck的简笔画,微笑着问学生:Hello, boys and girls. What's this? Do you know? 你们认识它吗?它的叫声是怎样的呢?
b.课件出现duck的画面及叫声
T: Look at my mouth. d-u-c-k, d-u-c-k (注意元音字母u的发音)然后把图片鸭子贴在黑板上。
(2)教学rabbit
T: Hello. I'm an animal. I have two long ears, and I have a white body. And, I have two red eyes. Do you know? What am I? 从此谜语中引出单词 rabbit。
(设计思路:悬念式激情导入,激发学生的好奇心和兴趣,提高学生的听力水平。)
(3)教学panda
出示课件。
T: Look, it's a lovely animal. What's this?
引出熊猫单词panda,出示卡片,领读,进行音标渗透。然后说:Hello! My name is Panda. Nice to meet you.(引导学生用所学问候语向熊猫打招呼。)
(设计思路:在熟知的语言中呈现单词,在真实的情境中交际,避免了枯燥无意义的机械重复,使课堂生动、鲜活、富有生活情趣。)
(4)老师模仿声音Woof!Woof!引出单词 dog. I'm a dog. (做小狗的动作)Dog, dog, I'm a dog, woof woof woof. 声音woof 引出单词dog。
接着出示cat的图片,引导学生说出Cat, cat, I'm a cat, meow, meow, meow. 同法教学monkey.
(设计思路:在展示单词的同时,配上相应的动物动作。小学生的自控力不是很强,很难长时间保持注意力,所以动手,动脑,惟妙惟肖的滑稽动作,让学生体会到了英语学习的乐趣。)
(5)教师以故事形式出示课件,引导学生再次认读动物单词。
(设计意图:根据学生好表现的心理,一步一步循序渐进,层层深入,由易到难地从本课单词迁移到课外内容,既激发了学生的学习兴趣,又丰富了课堂内容。)
3.tice
(1)让学生拿出准备的玩具或头饰,扮演自己喜爱的动物。
(设计意图:小学生都非常喜爱小动物,每位学生最喜爱的动物也不同,针对这一生活实际,通过学生戴上自己最喜爱的头饰,介绍自己,提高了学单词的趣味性,使每位学生都跃跃欲“说”,即能寓教于乐。)
(2)教师播放Let's learn部分的课件,让学生跟着说,注意语音语调。
(3)教师示范表演,学生模仿。看谁表演得最逼真、最生动。
4. Consolidation
(1)教师让学生手拿自己的玩具,两至四人一组练习说 Look!I have a rabbit / dog ...其他同学说上节课学过的感叹词:Cool! Super! Great! Wow!
(2)比一比,看谁模仿的动物叫声最逼真。
(3)赛一赛,看谁模仿的动物形体特征最生动。
5. Add-activities
(1)教师将一只大萝卜放在讲台台上,并戴上rabbit的头饰,并找若干名学生,师生同表演“拔萝卜”故事情节。
(2)Let'sChant
Cat, cat, I'm a cat, meow, meow, meow.
Dog, dog, I'm a dog, woof, woof, woof.
Duck, duck, I'm a duck, quack, quack, quack.
Monkey, monkey, I'm a monkey, hei, hei, hei.
Rabbit, rabbit, I'm a rabbit, jump, jump, jump.
Panda, panda, I'm a panda, ha, ha, ha.
6. Homework
(1) 把你知道的动物单词说给家长听。
(2) 和同伴一起做模仿动物表演。
(3) 小组合作进行编对话或儿歌。
九年级英语上册教案(篇5)
教学目标
1.能听、说、认读单词red、yellow、green、blue并能在实际情境中运用。
2. 通过用Lets do部分“Show me...”的指令练习和运用有关颜色的单词,训练学生的动手能力。
3.通过学习,学生能根据自己喜欢的颜色设计东西,培养其动手的能力。
教学重难点
重点:掌握颜色单词red、yellow、green、blue。
难点: 会用句型I see...描述自己看到的颜色。
教学工具
PPT课件、人物头饰、单词卡片、图片。
教学过程
1、Warm-up
(1)T:Hello,boys and girls.I’m your newteacher name is you can call me g
g.
T:Today we will learn Unit2 Colours(课件出示Colours单词,教师领读),Doyou know colours?
引导学生也可用汉语回答颜色
T:Let’ssing a song about colours,the song’s name is《colours》,Please stand up,clap your hands.(师生齐唱歌曲)
2.entation
(1)课件出示学校的平面图和本课中出现的人物图,让生进行操练,为本课的学习做好铺垫。
T:Let’s go on,Look,what’s this?(课件出示学校图)引导学生说出school,教师领读(注意升降调)At school,we have many friends,Look,they are coming.(教师逐一介绍四个人物的名字) Let’s say “hello” tothem.
(2)课件出示公园图片,引导学生说出在公园里看到的景色,同时呈现本课的录音视频。
T:Today is a very sunny friends are going to the park(呈现公园图片) 领读单词 you want to gothere?Let’s go,Listen(课件播放公园里鸟的叫声)What do you see in the park?(学生也可用汉语回答)
T:Yes,it’s a beautiful you see the flowers?Do you see thetrees?Do you see the rainbow?
Ss: Yes/No.
T:What do you see in the park? Let’s go,listen carefully(播放课文录音,让学生仔细的听)
T:What do you see in the park? Do you remember?引导学生利用句型I see...(板书)进行描述。
引导学生分别说出:I see red/yellow/green/blue.(出示四种颜色的图片贴到黑板上)
T:How many colours do you see in the park?Do you remember?Let’s listenagain,This time pay attention to the words.(再次播放视频让学生跟读)
T:How many colours do you see in the park?(课件出示四种颜色的图片,引导学生说出这几种颜色)Theyare red/yellow/green/blue.(板书四个单词,同时对学生进行书写规范训练)
播放chant伴奏,让学生看黑板跟唱。操练四个颜色单词。
T:OK,Ihave these (分别呈现四个单词卡片)
教师领读、齐读、分组读
(3)T:OK,now,listen(再次播放chant伴奏,师生看黑板齐唱)
(4)活动:I say,you do
T:Here are the colours,(出示四种颜色的彩笔)Look,on your desk, you have the crayons,listen,when I say red,youcan take up the red crayon quickly,let’s try.
(5)课件出示四个句子,让学生进行操练。
T:Look here,In the park,we see many colours(课件呈现四个人物说的句子,学生齐读)OK,showme your finger(让生手指四个句子齐读)
(6)让生打开课本自己读,然后呈现chant文本,让生跟唱。
(7)活动:Colour your park
T:Now you have a new park,colour your park colourful.
学生开始活动,教师在下面巡视指导。
(8)找学生汇报自己的作品,利用句子I see...进行描述。
3、Homework
绘制一个公园和你的家人一起分享。
九年级英语上册教案(篇6)
一、 说教材
(一)教材的作用和地位
"牛津英语"教材把语言结构、 语言功能和主题内容有机地结合起来, 所以语言的信息输入量大, 选材广泛、 主体有序、 内容集中, 学习内容非常贴近学生的生活实际和思想实际。本节课的内容是:Unit 4 的综合技能训练(Integrated Skills),是将听说读写糅合在一起进行综合训练,以提高学生综合应用英语的能力。我要求学生直接借助于网络进行查阅相关资料,并在此基础上进行归纳,使学生的信息量有了大大的增加,由学生的被动的接受变成了主动的学习.
(二)教学目标
1.知识目标:学会一些表示动物名称的单词,学会运用动词smell, understand, believe, remember等。能熟练运用所学句式描述、询问奇闻轶事,并对别人的描述作出反应。
2.技能目标:通过真实的语境,重点培养学生听、说及综合运用语言的能力。
3.情感目标:培养学生的参与意识、竞争意识和合作精神,激发学生对我们所处的世界的热爱和不断探索未知世界的兴趣。
二、说教法
(一)教学设计的原则
1.坚持"自主学习,合作学习"的教学原则:
教师打破了以教师为中心, 单项灌输的陈旧模式, 在课堂教学中尽可能发挥学生的主动性和合作精神, 营造了良好的学习氛围, 更重要的是在频繁的交流中, 学生的语言表达能力提高了。
2.遵循英语教学的交际性原则:
交际性原则是英语教学中的一个指导性原则, 教学最终的目的不仅要使学生掌握知识, 更重要的是使学生在理解的基础上, 在交际性练习中培养交际能力, 而培养这种交际能力, 就是反映在课堂教学中学生以主人翁态度, 积极、 主动、 大胆地参与英语课堂练习活动的主体意识上。
3.追求和谐的课堂活动:
学生主体性的发挥, 要在民主, 平等的氛围中体现, 更要在科学, 和谐的教学活动中进行. 课堂教学不仅要处理好老师、学生、教材等关系, 还要尽可能地发挥三者各自的特长, 这就是教学的化。在课堂教学中, 既要有意识的让学生去感知、理解,又要让学生不断地感悟。
4.拓宽学生的视野:
现代外语教学理论认为, 一定量的语言输入是语言输出的基础, 即语言的输出有赖于语言的输入。只有在大量吸收的基础上才能提高表达的技能, 也只有在吸收信息和表达自己意愿的过程中才能培养语言交际的能力。因此,教师根据教材做了很大的扩展, 要求学生尽可能用英语向同学展示你学习后的成果, 你的爱好及缘由等, 使教学更趋向真实。
(二)教学手段
1、教法:运用情景、听说、直观、游戏等方法,展开以教师为主导,以学生为主体的师生、生生多边的交互式活动。
2、学法:自主、合作学习。创设教学情景,使学生好学、会学、乐学。
3、主要以现代化电教手段--多媒体辅助教学,贯穿整个教学过程。以此期望增加直观性和趣味性,加大课堂密度,提高教学效果。
三、说教学程序 (Teaching procedures)
第一部分:听
Step 1:听前:(Pre-listening)
1. 热身(warming up): 以游戏"which is missing"让学生迅速根据图片说出动物的名称,将学生的热情调动起来,并了解了本课的主题与动物用关。
2. 呈现生词,为下一步听扫除障碍。
a. 通过free talk, 引出生词bone, smell.
b. 通过英文释义,图片连线的形式呈现表示动物的4个单词,同时链接了giraffe、tortoise和camel相关的信息,扫除听的过程中的障碍。
Step 2 听中。(while-listening)
1. 听整段对话,完成P66的notes。听前要求学生先阅读notes,让学生了解所缺信息,以便学生听时有重点的听。
2. 对话巩固。学生获取所缺信息后,大声朗读完整的句子,并进行一分钟的快读竞赛。然后通过对话形式进行pair work, 再次进行巩固。同时,在对话中自然呈现remember, believe, words等词,并且使他们在情境中得到了操练。
3. 精听。截取整段对话中的一个段落,提供给学生进行精听。听前先设疑:What's the use of camels' eyelids, do you understand?激发学生听的兴趣,培养学生通过听获得细节信息的能力。
Step 3 听后。(post-listening)
1. 运用所听信息完成书上短文,并熟练朗读。
2. 就短文中的细节展开讨论:
If you see ants on your dinner table,
what will you do?
How can you keep ants away?
并留以足够的时间让学生就这个开放型的问题发表自己不同的见解。
第二部分:说
Step 1 Present.
运用书上的对话先设计了一个听的任务:Listen and do T or F。并且在核对答案之后通过图片巧妙生动的呈现对话中的生词weight。
Step 2 Practise.
1. 开书跟读,训练语音语调。
2. 运用对话中的结构:
Is there anything about...?
Yes, it says that....
That's ...
来谈论本课所出现过的amazing things.这样,既复习了本单元前一阶段的所学的奇闻趣事,又在情境中操练了上述新授句式。
Step 3 Produce.
1. 由书内延伸到书外,为学生提供一些useful expressions,并引导学生借助这些习惯表达谈论自己从电视、广播、因特网上所了解到的各种各样的奇闻趣事,这样,就为学生创造了真实的交际环境,并让学生通过自主的交流,享受了合作学习的乐趣。
2. 在学生小组自由交流并在全班汇报之后,让学生用信的形式描述自己了解的奇闻趣事。这时候,学生在前面的学习步骤中大量输入的基础上在进行笔头的输出,就是轻而易举、水到渠成了。
Step 4 Homework.
1.完成信,并展览。
2. 在"讲英语时间"与学习伙伴交流更多的奇闻趣事。通过这样的作业,旨在培养学生的竞争意识、合作精神及探索精神,为学生的终生学习打下基础。
7B Unit 4 Integrated skills
课堂教学评析要点
每一个教学环节的设计都从学生的兴趣出发,符合初中生的心理需求,贴近他们的生活,从而使他们整节课至始至终都兴趣盎然。学生和老师在整节课中都保持了学习的激情。对于学生的回答和表述,老师及时给以后续性的评价,拉近的师生间的距离,学生在获取知识技能的同时,也享受了用英语交流和被老师赏识的快乐。课堂活动丰富,通过生生互动、师生互动,学生合作、探究学习,达到了本课预定的知识、技能和情感目标。提高了学生的人文素养,培养了终身学习的能力。
本堂课采用任务型教学策略,让学生在完成任务的过程中体验、实践、参与、交流与合作,实现任务目标,主要呈现以下亮点:
1.注重发展学生学习策略,培养和提高学生的创新精神和语言运用能力。让学生走出课堂,从网上、报上寻找相关资料,直接接触地道语言,使他们有足够的空间和自由度,进行自主学习,促使学生个性发展。
2.利用小组讨论交流形式,使学生在活动过程中,互相学习,互相交流,培养他们团结合作精神。
3.这堂课注重学生听、说能力的培养,尤其能通过填表格回答问题形式让学生对自寻资料进行归纳,提高他们的语言理解能力。
4.教师本身教态自然大方,素养较好,整堂课结构合理,各环节目标明确,以学生为主体进行教学,体现了二期课改精神,是一堂较为成功的课。
九年级英语上册教案15篇
教案课件是老师上课做的提前准备,因此想要随便写的话老师们就要注意了。 学生的反应可以反映教学质量,什么样的教学课件才是好的?今天幼儿教师教育网编辑为大家推荐了一篇与“九年级英语上册教案”相关的好文阅读,所列举信息仅供参考请依据实际情况做出判断!
九年级英语上册教案【篇1】
Unit 1 The Changing Word
Topic 1 My hometown has become more and more beautiful.
SectionA
【学习目标】
1.掌握现在完成时的构成,初步了解其用法,并学会运用have/has been to 和have/ has gone to 结构:
2.比较并找出一般过去时与现在完成时的不同用法;
3.学会描述假期生活。
【预习案】
一、读1a,完成1b的表格所缺的地点
二、 在文中找到,划出并背诵下面的短语和句子
1.变化的世界________________________________ 9.一个合适的地方________________10.拍照________
2.长假过后__________________________________ 11.提高我的英语水平__________________________
3.度过一个愉快的暑假________________________ 12.顺便问一下___________13.根据1a的内容________
4.从…回来__________________________________ 14.孩子们的假期经历__________________________
5.巨大的变化_________________6.发生____________ 15.查出…和…的不同__________________________
7.越来越漂亮________________________________ 16.填空_____________________17.感觉舒服________
8.如此(那么)多的人___________________________ 18.患感冒______________19.很长时间_____________
【探究案】
一、 语法重点导入--- (根据句意在横线上填入谓语动词的适当形式)
1. He ______________ (play) soccer on the playground now.
2. He ______________ (play) soccer on the playground yesterday.
3. He ______________ (play) soccer on the playground when I saw him yesterday.
4. He ______________ (play) soccer on the playground every day.
5. He ______________ (play) soccer on the playground tomorrow afternoon.
6. He ______________ (play) soccer on the playground 注意(6)句中的时间状语,看P118现在完成时讲解, 总结现在完成时用法
总结:
(1) 现在完成时中谓语动词的形式是---________________________ 看P140-142过去分词表,做P3---1b
(2) 经常搭配的时间副词有: just, already, yet, ever, never, before…
(3) 现在完成时句型转换
写出(6)句的否定句:___________________________________________________________________ 写出(6)句的一般疑问句并肯定回答:_____________________________________________________ 写出(6)句的划线提问句:_______________________________________________________________ 写出(6)句的反意疑问句:_______________________
(4) 观察1a中出现的现在完成时的句子并翻译理解
1. You have just come back from your hometown. 译:_________________________________________________
2. Great changes have taken place there. 译:_________________________________________________________
3. My hometown has become more and more beautiful. 译:_____________________________________________
4. Where have you been? I have been to Mount Huang with my parents. 译:________________________________
5. Where’s Maria? She has gone to Cuba to be a volunteer. 译:___________________________________________
(5) 现在完成时考点:have / has been to --- have / has gone to
练习:参看P118现在完成时讲解,完成P2(2)
区别:have / has been to表示曾经______________,现在_____________;
have / has gone to表示已经______________,现在______________.
二、在文中划出下面的句子并分析
注意: taken是take的______________形式
点拨:change有名词/动词两种词性,名词词意是_________/__________等; 动词词意是_________
1take place --- 发生、举办,指非偶然性事件的―发生‖,即这种事件的发生一定有某种原因或事先的安排 区别:happen --- 发生、碰巧,一般用于偶然或突发性事件
注意:take the place of…--- 取代某人的`位置
练习:a. Jason ___________________________ Miss Li to teach us French next term.
b. The Olympic Games of 2008 ________________________ successfully in Beijing.
c. What ___________________________ to you yesterday?
’思考:so…that…意思是__________,引导_______状语从句 区别:so that…意思是_______,引导_______状语从句 练习:a.为了拍照,他爬得很高。____________________________________________________________________ b.他他爬得那么高,以至于能拍照。____________________________________________________________
3. There goes the bell. 译:_____________________________ 思考:这是个there提前引起的__________句 回忆:副词here, there 提前到句首要引起主谓倒装,但是当主语为人称代词时不倒装。
练习:a. Here comes the No.31 Bus. 译:________________________b. There they are. 译:___________________
c. Jim跑过来了。译:___________________________ d.他跑过来了。 译:____________________________ 拓展:看课本P105注解写出(3)句的同义句a.__________________________ b.____________________________
【归纳】
一、 根据首字母提示完成单词,使句子完整通顺。
1. The b______ is ringing. Let’s begin our class.
2. She has made great p______ in English with the help of her teacher.
3. Miss Lin decided to help Mary as she f______ sorry for her.
4. By the w______, where’s your library?
5. I have been to an English training school to i______ my English.
二、 根据句意及汉语提示完成单词或短语。
1. We have just ______ (回来) from London.
2. They were very tired. I ______ (同情) for them.
3. We haven’t seen our English teacher ______ (很长一段时间).
4. Where is Lin Mei? I have ______ (告诉……一些事) her.
5. He ______ (已经去) New York, in the USA.
三、 用所给词的适当形式填空。
1. —Why is the room so clean?
—Because I ______ just ______ (clean) it.
2. Wang Hai spent a whole night ______ (work) on the computer.
3. They have no house ______ (live) in.
4. My father ______ (be) to the People’s Park many times, so he knows it very well.
5. I heard Lin Hong ______ (sing) a song when I went past.
2 / 195
SectionB
【学习目标】
1.继续学习现在完成时的用法;
2.比较新旧社会青少年的生活状况,启发同学们珍惜新社会的幸福生活。
【预习案】
一、读1a,回答下面的问题
1. Has Maria taken part in some volunteer activities during the summer holidays? __________________________
2. What has she done? _____________________________________________________________________________
3. What does she think of it? ________________________________________________________________________
二、 读2a, 完成2b
三、 在文中找到并划出下面的短语
1.参加…_______________________ 20.过着艰苦的生活______________________________
2.志愿者活动________________________________ 21.详细地描述…__________________________
3.在暑假期间________________________________ 22.支付他们孩子的教育经费______________________
4.残疾儿童__________________________________ 23.度过他们的童年______________________________
5.为…打扫房间______________________________ 24.为了…__________25.support their families________
6.喂他们吃饭____________7.为他们做饭___________ 26.做童工_________________________
8.一段美好的经历_______________________________ 27.日日夜夜_______________________
9.从…学到很多_________________________________ 28.足够的吃的__________________________________
10.the different forms of the verbs___________________ 29.现在的青少年________________________________
11.做一个关于…的调查__________________________ 30.飞速地发展__________________________________
12.make conversations_____________ 31.为贫困家庭提供帮助__________________________
13.跳绳______________14.网上聊天_______________ 32.受到很好的教育______________________________
15.暑假补课_________________________ 33.随着中国的发展______________________________
34.leisure activity___________35.a balanced diet______ 16.做农活___________________________
36.play musical instruments_____________ 17.一篇有关青少年的文章________________________
37.some other training__________________18.世界各地__________________19.过去___________
【探究案】
一、在文中划出下面的句子并分析
1. You have taken part in some volunteer activities during the summer holidays, haven’t you?
译:___________________________________________________________________
思考:haven’t you? 构成了句子的_____________部分
练习:根据时间状语的变化写出谓语动词的不同形式并完成后面的反意疑问句
a. He ____________(take) part in some volunteer activities during the last summer holidays, ________________? b. He ____________(take) part in some volunteer activities during the next summer holidays, ______________?
c. He ___________(take) part in some volunteer activities during the summer holidays every year, ________________? d. He must ________(take) part in some volunteer activities during the summer holidays every year, ______________?
2. What a wonderful experience! 译:________________________ 同义句:How _______________________ 感叹句转换练习:(根据P5---1a的图下提示词用what和how写感叹句)
a. 多么狭窄的公路啊!What______________________________! / How___________________________________! b. 多么艰苦的生活条件啊!What___________________________! / How__________________________________! 注意:如果对行为动词感叹,只能用How引导! c. 看!他跑得是多么快啊!_________________________________!
3. Though I had no time to travel, I still felt very happy. 译:_______________________________________________ 思考:你能将上句改为用but的形式吗?______________________________________________________________ 看课本P105注解并总结:though和__________引导______________从句,语气较弱,不与__________连用; ___________________和___________________也用于引导______________从句,带有强调的意味,语气较强。
4. Is that so? 译:________________________ 区别:Is that all? 译:________________________
链接:a. Do you think it’ll rain soon? I think so. 译:_____________________________________________________ b. Do you believe China will become No.1 in the world one day? I believe so. 译:________________________ 拓展:我希望如此___________________ 我猜是这样的____________________
注意:I hop not. _____________________ I don’t think so.____________________
5. In order to help support their families, they had to be child laborers.
思考:你能将上句改为…so that…形式吗?____________________________________________________________ 总结:in order to + 动词原形,在句子中做目的状语;so that 后面引导的是目的状语从句
练习:为了赶上早班车,他们起得很早。a.____________________________________________________________ b._________________________________________________________________________________________
【归纳】
一、 根据汉语提示完成句子,每空一词。
1. His parents couldn’t afford his ______ (教育).
2. The government gives ______ (帮助;赞助) to poor families.
3. With the ______ (发展) of China, many more children live a happy life.
4. I think we can ______ much ______ (向……学习) the farmers.
5. To make us understand what has happened, he told us about the accident ______ ______ (详细地).
二、 用所给词语的适当形式填空。其中一项是多余的。
describe, feed, though, article, education, develop
1. Li Ming failed in the exam again ______ he tried really hard.
2. China is the largest ______ country in the world.
3. The police asked her ______ the two men.
4. Mike, you come from the countryside. Have you ever ______ sheep?
5. In the past, many children couldn’t get a good ______.
三、单项选择。
1. —Have you ever been ______? —Yes. I have been to Australia.
A. abroad B. alone C. here D. healthy
2. —The radio says it’s going to rain. —______ Bad luck! We can’t go for our picnic.
A. Is that so? B. Thank you. C. Don’t worry. D. Pardon?
3. ______ it rains heavily, ______ farmers are still working in the fields.
A. Though; but B. Though; still C. Though; / D. Although; but
4. Athletes from more than 200 countries ______ the 2008 Olympic Games in Beijing.
A. took part in B. attended C. joined D. held
5. China is still a ______ country at the present time.
A. developed B. more developed C. highly developed D. developing
SectionC
【学习目标】
1.继续学习现在完成时;;
2.对比新旧北京,了解中国发生的重大变化;
3.同学们要珍惜现在的美好生活。
【预习案】
一、先看图,再读1a,完成1b(写出每段的段意)
二、 在文中找到并划出下面的短语
1. infer the main idea________________________ 18.接受良好的教育_____________________________
2. the key words______________3. at present_________ 19.与…保持联系_________________________(P105)
4. compare your idea with Kangkang’s_______________ 20.远方的亲戚_________________________________
5.狭窄的公路___________________________________ 21.通过书信和电报的方式________________________
6.又小又黑的房子_______________________________ 22.改革开放____________________________________
7.艰苦的生活条件_______________________________ 23.变得更加高大明亮____________________________
8.简洁而缓慢地通讯_____________________________ 24.改善很多____________________________________
9.宽阔的环形公路_______________________________ 25.享受更加多样的业余活动______________________
10.高大而明亮的楼房____________________________ 26.不但…而且…_______________________
11.舒适的生活条件______________________________ 27.在互联网上______________28.另外还有_________
12.more kinds, quick and easy communications 29.变得更加简单而快捷__________________________
___________________________________________ 30.传真机_________________31.等等…____________
13.my report on Beijing___________________________ 32.取得飞速的进步______________________________
14.四十多年____________________________________ 33.成功地举办奥运会_____________________
15.(她)亲眼目睹北京的变化______________________ 34.记住过去_________________________
16.在20世纪60年代____________________________ 35.立足现在_________________________
17.有机会干…__________________________________ 36.展望未来_________________________
【探究案】
一、在文中划出下面的句子并分析
1. Usually, a big family were crowed in a small house.
译:________________________________________________
点拨:crowd --- 拥挤, 挤,聚集(动词);人群,群众;一群(名词) crowded --- 拥挤的(形容词)
练习:a. There is a crowd of people in the hall.
译:________________________________________________
b. He succeeded in crowding into the train.
译:______________________________________________
c. Look! A crowd of ants are crowded in the hole.
译:_________________________________________
注意:拥挤的交通不能直译为 crowded traffic, 而是__________ /___________traffic
2. Life was so hard that people had no time or money to enjoy leisure activities.
思考:你能将上句改为too…to形式吗?
Life was _______ ______ ______ people ______ ______ time _______ money to enjoy leisure activities.
提高:The bed is so small that Tom can’t sleep well on it.
_____________________________________________
3. China has developed rapidly since the reform and opening-up.
译:_________________________________________
九年级英语上册教案【篇2】
新课程标准感知
知识要点 本单元用虚拟句谈论一些假设的情况
本单元要点如下
1. 学会谈论一些假设的、虚幻的情况;
2. 达到如何使用虚拟句提出建议的目标;
3. 学会表示与现在的情况相反的虚拟语气的结构;
4. 学会用虚拟语气表述自己的还没有实现的愿望
一.重点词汇
million、pimple、energetic、confident、shirt、tie、medical、research lottery、million、
trouble、energetic、confident、in public、social
二.重点短语
1. won the lottery 赢得抽奖 2. in public 公共的、公众的
2. in the slightest 一点也;根本 4. plenty of 很多的、足够的
get along with 与…相处 6. let …down 使…失望、沮丧
7. come up with 提出、想出(问题) 8. medical research 医学研究
9. what if 如果…怎么办 10. be late for 迟到…
11. be nervous 紧张的 12. get nervous (变得)紧张的
13. take a long walk 散步 14. ask one’s permission 征求某人的许可
15. without permission 没得到许可 16. introduce oneself 自我介绍
17. rather than 而不是 18. a circle of good friends 朋友圈子
三.交际用语
1. If I were you , I’d wear a shirt and tie. 如果我是你,我就会穿衬衫打领带。
2. If I were you , I’d take an umbrella. 如果我是你,我就带把伞。
3. What would you do if you won a million dollars ? 如果你赚了一百万美元,你会做什么?
4. What if I don’t know anyone ? 如果我一个人也不认识怎么办?
5. You should eat lots of fruits and vegetable and drink lots of water.你应该吃大量水果、蔬菜,大量喝水。
6. What are you like ? I think I’m outgoing. 你的性格如何?我想我很外向。
四.语法聚焦
What would you do if you won a million dollars ?
I’d give it to medical research .
I can’t sleep the night before an exam .What should I do ?
If I were you , I’d take a long walk before going to bed .
第一课时
Section A
Step 1 Free Talk
Talk about good habits of the students. Say, “ Wd all have some good habits. Can you tell the other students what good habits you have.” For example, getting up early, reading, helping others, not wasting money, etc.
When they talk, write some on the blackboard. Get the students to think about if they don’t hav have these good habits what will happen.
Step2 Talking and writing
Say, “Please imagine, what would you do if you had a lot of money?” The students discuss with the partners. Then get them to write some other situations in the list and share the answers. Point out: The sentences here are imaginary situations. They may not come true, just imaginary. So we often use the past tense and “would ” to express this kind of situation.
Step 3 Listening and talking
1b. First talk about some information in the picture. Say, “ We are going to listen to a conversation about their ideas about how to spend a million dollars.”
Students listen to the tape and number the pictures.
Then help the students practice the similar dialogue simply in 1c.
Step 4 Listening
First ask “ What would you do if you went to a party? What would you wear? What would you bring? What would you feel if you don’t know anyone at the party?”
After talking about the questions, come up with the question in 2a “ Why is Larry nervous?” Then listen.
2b. Listen again. Check the four things Larry’s sister says to him. Then check the students’ answers.
Step 5 Pairwork
According to the listening Text above, get the students to practice the conversation by looking at the instruction in 2c.
Ask some pairs to act out their own dialogues.
第二课时
Step 1 Free talk
Say “Imagine, what would you do if you were very old?”
“What would you do if you were teachers?”
“ What would you do if you had a lot of money?”
Get the students to talk about the questions. Collect their answers and write some on the blackboard.
Step 2 Grammar Focus
Point out the sentences on the blackboard all belong to imaginary situations. Ask the students to find out the rules in the sentences. Then look at the sentences in Grammar Focus. Comprehend them. Talk about some information about imaginary situations.
Step 3 Reading and watching
Ask “ Do you have some trouble during your daily life?” The students talk about their trouble and ask the other students to give advice. Then 3a, ask the students match each problem with the correct advice. Check the answers. Then comprehend the sentences.
Step 4 Game
Ask the students to write their problems on a piece of paper. Ask one student to choose some paper with problems on and read the problems. After he / she reads one problem, the other students try to give advice by using “ You should…” or “ If I were you…”.
Exercises:
完成句子:
1. He doesn’t know ______________( 穿什么) at the party.
2. _____________ (如果我是你), I would buy a small present.
3. What would you do ______________ (如果你获得了第一名)?
4. You’d take a long walk ______________ (在吃过晚餐之后).
5. I ______________(变得紧张) before big exams.
第三课时
Section B
Step 1 Word competition
Say “ We usually use adjectives to describe a person. Do you know those words? Let’s have a competition.”
Get representatives of boys and girls to come to the front and write the words about description on the blackboard as many as they can.
Step 2 Giving definitions
Say “ Just now we had the word competition. Then let’s try to give definitions of these words in English.” Discuss with partners and give definitions.
Step 3 Writing and competition
Get the students to understand the instructions in 1a. Understand the meaning of every word. Then fill in the blanks with the words. Check the answers.
After students write the words, have a competition of making up sentences. Say, “ Please make up sentences by using these words. Let’s see who can make up more sentences , boys or girls?”. Then do it.
Step 4 Listening
2a. At first help the students understand the instruction. Look at the personality survey. Explain “ give a speech, without permission, introduce oneself to sb.” Then listen. Check the questions Celia asks.
Some points:
1. give a speech = make a speech, give a talk 演讲
2. without permission (未经允许) with permission (经过允许)
permission n. “允许” permit v. “允许”
permit sb to do sth 相当于allow sb to do sth 意思是“允许某人做某事”
例:The teacher didn’t permit us to swim in this river.
= We can’t swim in this river without the teacher’s permission.
3. introduce oneself to sb. 意思是“向某人自我介绍”
例:Let me introduce myself to you. I am Jim.
2b. Listen again. Circle Bill’s responses. Then check the answers.
Step 5 Practice
Get the students to practice the similar conversation in 2c by looking at the personality survey.
Exercises:
翻译句子:
1. 他害怕在公众场合讲话。
2. 这个女孩很善交际。她有许多朋友。
3. 莫扎特是个很有创造力的音乐家。
4. 男孩们总是精力旺盛。他们几乎从不感觉到累。
第四课时
Step 1 Free talk
Ask questions like “What would you do if the teacher asked you to give a speech in front of the whole school? What would you do if someone took away your things without permission? What would you do if someone asked you to be in a movie? What would you do if you wanted to be friends with a new student?”
Get the students to talk about them.
Step 2 Reading
Ask the students to read the passage in 3a and fill in the blanks in the results with “a”, “b” or “c” according to the survey in 2a. Then help the students comprehend the whole passage.
Some points:
1. pretty ① 相当,非常 相当于very, quite
② 漂亮 相当于beautiful
2. in the slightest 意思是“根本,一点也”
not….in the slightest 意思是“根本不,一点也不”,相当于not…. at all.
slight 是adj. 表示“轻微的,不重要的”
例:I have a slight cold. 我有点轻微的感冒。
3. company ① 陪伴 (不可数n.)
② 公司 (可数n.)
例:I feel at home in your company. 和你在一起令我轻松自在。
He is a driver in a bus company. 他是一家汽车公司的司机。
4. rather than, would rather…than 意思是“与其……倒不如”,“宁愿…...而不愿”
例:I want to stay at home rather than go to school.
I would rather stay at home than go to school.
这两个短语前后都连接两个相同的成分。
After explaining the points, ask the students to read the passage.
Step 3 Groupwork
Divide the students into several groups with four students in each. Design a personality survey according to the example in 3b. The survey must include at least two questions. Then discuss about the questions with the group members.
At last share the students’ answers and make a conclusion, such as “Student….. is very outgoing. Student … is very friendly” and so on.
Homework:
Recite the passage in 3a.
第五课时
Step 1 Warming up
Ask the students make examples about good or bad personality. Discuss about the personality the students like.
Step 2 Self check
For Ex 1, fill in each bland with the correct word given. Understand the Chinese meaning of every sentence.
For Ex 2, read the e-mail and comprehend it.
Then read the passage. Write a reply according to this email. Ask some students to read their replies.
Step3 Just for fun
Students read the funny cartoons at last.
第六课时
Step 1 Warming up
Talk about the questions “ Do you often surf the Internet? Do you have a net friend? What would you do if the net friend wanted to meet you?”
Step 2 Reading
Say “ In our daily life, we would meet lots of situations. And what would you do if something happened? Then let’s study the passage.”
Give a reading task to the task to the students. “ Find out all the accidents and problems in the reading text.” After the students finish the task, help them comprehend the passage.
Some points:
1. If I were you, I’d have a first-aid…..
此句使用了虚拟语气,对现在的事情进行假设,表示与现在事实相反的一种假设。此时,主句中谓语动词使用“should / would + v原形”的结构。If从句中谓语动词使用一般过去时态,如果该动词是be动词,则一律用were.
例:If I knew this, I would tell you.
2. burn-burned – burned 或burn – burnt – burnt 意思是“烧伤,烧坏”
例:The house is burning.
如果表示“被烧死”,则常用be killed by fire / in the fire, 也可用be burnt to death.
3. injure “伤害,损伤”,指事故中肉体上受到伤害,也指精神上的损伤,常用人作主语。
例:She was badly injured in an accident.
4. hurt “疼痛”,可用疼痛的具体部位作主语,也可用人作主语。
例:My head hurts.
She hurt herself yesterday.
Read the passage, and finish 3b.
九年级英语上册教案【篇3】
1. Where have you been, Jane? 你去过哪里,简?
2. She has gone to Cuba to be a volunteer.她去古巴当志愿者了。
3. There goes the bell. 铃响了。
4. Though I had no time to travel, I still felt very happy.虽然我没有时间去旅行,但是我仍然感到很开心。
5. Now our country has developed rapidly.现在我们国家发展迅速。
e.g. You have just come back from your hometown.
2. 现在完成时态的句式:
e.g. (1) I have been to Mount Huang with my parents.
(2) I haven’t seen him for a long time.
(3) Where have you been?
(4) ——Have you ever cleaned a room? ——Yes, I have. / No, I haven’t.
3. have/ has been与 have/has gone 的区别
have/has been to sp.表示曾经到过某地—— have/has gone to sp.表示已经去了某地
e.g. (1) I have been to Mount Huang with my parents. (2) She has gone to Cuba to be a volunteer.
九年级英语上册教案【篇4】
Unit 2.
plain to …… about …… 向 ……抱怨……
74.post sth. for sb. 替某人寄某物
ok/make dinner 做晚饭
76.do the laundry 做洗衣服的活
77.make the bed 整理床铺
78.iron the shirts 熨烫衬衫
79.sweep the floor 扫地
80.explore dangerous places 探测危险的地方
81.own a robot 拥有机器人
82.change one's life a lot 改变某人的生活许多
83.buy … from … 从…… 买……
84.sell … to … 把……卖给……
85.do housework 做家务活
86.do homework 做家庭作业
87.stay in bed 呆在床上
88.return home from work /school 下班回家/ 放学回家
89.be happy / pleased / satisfied with 对……满意
90.be ready for sth. 为……做好了准备
91.be ready to do sth. 为做某事做好了准备
92.get ready for sth. 为……做准备
93.get ready to do sth. 为做某事做准备
94.go wrong 出毛病, 走错路
95.catch a virus 染上病毒
96.cause a lot of problems 引起许多麻烦
97.wake sb. up 叫醒某人
98.wake up 醒来
99.knock sth. over 碰翻
100.knock on /at sth. 敲(门……)
101.do with(what) 处理 ,对付
102.deal with (how) 处理,对付
103.return sth. to sb. = give back sth. to sb .把……还给……
104.return to sp.=go / come back to sp. 回到某地
105.fall to the ground 掉到地上
106.eat sth. for sb. 替某人吃某物
107.make a mess 搞成一团糟
108.throw sth. into sp.along with sth. 把……和……一道扔进……里
109.use sth. to do sth. 用……做某事
110.keep my flat as clean as new 保持我的公寓和新的一样干净
111.pay for 支付
112.That sounds good. 那听起来很好。
113.get tired = be tired 疲惫
114.last for= go on for 持续 ……
115.sth. needs doing/ to be done 某事需要被做
116.expect to do sth. 期盼做某事
117.expect sb. to do sth. 期盼某人做某事
118.expect that 从句 期盼……
119.get sth. back = have sth. back 取回,拿回
120.You are welcome to do sth. 欢迎你做某事
121.reply to 回复,答复
122.look forward to doing sth. 盼望做某事
123.hear from sb. =get a letter from sb.
=receive a letter from sb. 收到某人来信
124.clear up sth. 清理 , 整理
九年级英语上册教案【篇5】
UNIT1:
词组,短语
1, it is nice of you to do sth
2, bring me the newspaper
3, have lots to eat
4, worry about (not)dong sth
5, be familiar with
6, the 12 animals signs of the Chinese horoscope
7, people in the west
8, learn more about western culture
9, be divided into
10, people born under the same star
11,at times
12,like to be the leader
13,give up easily
14,take care of others
15save money
16,buy sb sth/ buy sth for sb
17,worry too much
18,pay attention to details
19,argue with others
20,love peace
21,keep secrets
22,forgive sb for one’s faults
23,have a good sence of humour
24,travel to different places
25,make and plan things
26,wait without getting angry
27,agree with each other
28,care only about oneself
29,treat everyone equally
30,feel sure about one’s ability
31,spend time /money doing sth
32,explain things to sb
33,show off
34,make such a mess
35,give each of us two gifts
36,the whole birthday cake
37,organize this party for us
38,be patient enough to do sth
39,be on the phone
40,have success at school or work
41,around the middle of the month
42,call Mr zhang on 84166488
43,have a mixture of good luck and bad luck
44,spend money wisely
45,have problems with my bike
46,get lots of rest
47,get sick
48,the same as
49,be suitable for
50,come up with=think of
51,be able to=can
52,have fun in doing sth
53,recommend sb as the new chairperson
54,try to be funny
55,finish all the summer homework
56,get full/good marks
57,forget to do sth
58,be afaid of doing sth
59,make a speech in assembly
60,show sb how to use the libriary
61,try one’s best
62,do extra work
63,get more organized
64,use sth to do
九年级英语上册教案【篇6】
教学目标:
知识与技能
1.Words and phrases: stomachache, cold, headache, fever,
fall off, fell off.
2.Sentences: Sam had lots of chocolate biscuits yesterday.
So today he’s got a stomachache.
3.Grammar: Talking about illnesses.
教学重点:
Words and phrases: stomachache, cold, headache, fever,
fall off, fell off.
教学难点:
Sentences: Sam had lots of chocolate biscuits yesterday.
So today he’s got a stomachache.
Grammar: Talking about illnesses.
教学方法:
讲授、过去时
教学过程:
(一)导入:Step 1 Warm-up
T: Hi, boys and girls.
T: Let’s sing a song, ok?
Ss: Ok.
T: Ok! London Bridge is falling down…。 (Ss sing the song)
T: You are clever boys and girls. Now let’s have a Free Talk “What I did yesterday”, Ok?
Ss introduce what they did yesterday
(二)探究新知Step 2 Presentation and leading
T: Who can tell me what happen to Daming in last Unit.
Ss: Daming’s head was bumped.
T: Let’s play this story, ok?
Ss: Ok.
(Two students play in roles of “Daming” and “Sam”, others describe the story, the two students do the actions)
The teacher writes the word “today” on the blackboard. What happened to Daming, Sam, Amy and Lingling? Lead the students to use “to” and “and” to connect the two sentences.
Step 3 Text Teaching
T: Now, this class we are going to learn Module 10 Unit 2 Sam had lots of chocolate biscuits .First, listen to the tape and underline the new words.
(Teach the new words’ cards)
T: Now listen to the tape and repeat it. Are you clear?
(The teacher writes these sentences on the blackboard)
Sam had lots of chocolate biscuits yesterday.
So today he’s got a stomachache.
T: Now listen to the tape again and tell me what happened to Sam, Lingling, Amy and Lingling.
T: Look at these words: had, ate
(三)巩固新知Step 4 Task-Fulfilling
T: Let’s play a game, ok? Ss: Ok.
T: Let’s play “I do you say”。 I’ll ask four students to come to the front of the class, one student performs Daming eating chocolate biscuits and then having a stomachache, and others describe it, and so on.
Step 5 Text Learning
T: Look at Part 4, answer these questions:
What is wrong with Little Tommy?
What’s wrong with Little Lingling?
What’s wrong with Little Ben?
T: Listen to the tape and repeat it.
T: Let’s read the poem together and do the actions, ok?
Ss: Ok.
(四)作业布置Homework
(五)小结:过去时的用法
板书设计:
Unit 2 Sam had lots of chocolate
Sam had lots of chocolate biscuits yesterday.
So today he’s got a stomachache.
四年级英语教案范文二:过去式
教学目标:
知识目标
A、能听、 说 、读、写并正确使用单词
“happen, ride, thirsty, watermelon, carry, bump,
fell/fall off, went/go, bought/buy ”。
B、能理解并灵活掌握句型
We went for a bike ride/were hungry and thirsty/bought a watermelon/fell off/carried…. 。
能力目标
在知识目标的基础上,要求学生在实际生活中运用动词过去时态句型We went for a bike ride/were hungry and thirsty/bought a watermelon/fell off/carried….来谈论或描述过去发生的事情,同时在课文的教学中培养学生的阅读能力,从而提高他们的综合语言运用能力
情感目标
让学生通过运用语言来完成学习任务,感受成功,从而引发和培养学生学习英语的内在动机,最终使他们形成英语学习的积极态度。
教学重点:
能理解并灵活使用句型We went for a bike ride/were hungry and thirsty/bought a watermelon/fell off/carried…. ,掌握过去时态的表达方式。
教学难点:
过去时态的运用及利用教师设计的各种阅读训练活动,通过输入和输出的方式,使得学生感知并理解教学内容,并以此话题展开“说”与“写”的训练,培养学生的综合运用语言的技能。
教学过程:
一、Warm up
1.Greetings.
T:Hello,boys and girls.
Ss:Hello,Ms Wang.
T: How are you?
Ss: Fine ,thank you ! And you ?
T: I’m fine , too. Thank you !
2. Sing a song.
T: Let’s sing a song. 《We walked and walked》Ok?
Ss: Ok!
3. Free talk.
T: I went to the supermarket. And I bought some apples, bananas and a big watermelon.(Teacher shows pictures and new words.)Who can introduce : What did you do yesterday?( Teacher shows the questions.)
师生互相问候、听唱歌曲,营造活跃轻松的学习氛围。由于歌曲和所做动作在内容上有一定的联系,所以学生在边唱边跳中很自然地进入一种语言状态,同时也为以下的学习做了铺垫。
师生自由对话,创设宽松的学习氛围,这样既复习了旧知,又让学生感知新知,为学习新内容打下基础,从而使知识连成线,织成网,滚成球。
二、Presentation
活动1)
巧设情景,引入新课。
1.(师事先与一位学生S1共同创设情景:在老师与学生Free talk时,突然S1坐在座位不小心摔倒了,这时老师与他进行对话并通过表情动作)
T:“What happened to you ?
Ss: I fell off my chair.
T: Oh,it is an accident.(教学)
2.(同时,借助多媒体展示Sam 从自行车上摔倒的图片)
引出课题T: Today we’ll learn Module10 Accidents Unit 1“Sam fell off his bike.”
(Ss read the sentence.)
3.提出任务:教师告诉学生通过本节课的学习过后,同学们来谈论偶发事件,小组合作自编自演故事。
从创设情景引出课文的情景,从而引出课题,学生很自然地理解课题。
使学生带着任务有目的的学习,并激发学习兴趣。
活动2)
三、自主探索,学习课文。
1.首先出现Sam和Daming 两个人物的头饰,T告诉学生:Let’s listen and find the answer “what did Sam and Daming go yesterday?”
Listen and point,then choose the right answer.
A.went for a bike ride
B.went to school
引出went for a bike ride 的教学。(手势及动作)
T:What is the difference between these sentences?
A.Yesterday I went to a park.
B.I go to school by bike every day.
Ss:( 找出不同点)
(分小组进行操练)
2.Listen ,point and repeat,then answer“Why did Sam fell off his bike?”
1)Listen and repeat.
2) Discuss in groups then answer.
3)学生回答中引出新词的教学:carried, bumped, hungry, thirsty, bought, watermelon, fell off方法同“went”的教学。(运用肢体语言及图片展示进行教学,Drill line by line)
4)Drill the sentences row by row.
3.最后,再次听音跟读的情况下围绕“What happened to Daming?的问题引导学生小组分角色复述课文的主要内容。(强调先后顺序,并用“then….,and then…..进行复述。)
在学习故事的过程中,让学生说一说其中的人物情节安徽教师招考网()既帮助其理解故事,更主要的是能使学生体会英语故事的丰富多彩,这是阅读教学兴趣培养的补充环节。
培养学生积极交流新知的能力,培养学生自主发现、总结规律的能力
Read the dialogues according to the pictures . Then play a guessing game “Which picture is missing?
培养学生的独立认读能力并在游戏中进一步巩固新知。
活动3)
Play a memory game(利用多媒体呈现所学过的动词及其过去式,一分钟后,点击一部分词的原形或过去式不见了,让小组比赛抢答。
将游戏与练习有机结合,融为一体,让学生边做游戏边练习,寓教于乐,极大地激发了学生的学习兴趣。
活动4)
AB Ex3看图填动词的过去式,并小组分角色表演这意外事件。比比哪组表演得好。
在听说读的基础上,进一步落实写的目标。培养学生的书面表达能力。
四、Production:
Tell interesting stories.(practice in group)
Eg: Yesterday, Tom went for a bike ride with his friends. He___________. Then he________, and then he __________,and then he________.......(went,bought,carried,bumped,fell off,was,walked…)
So he was _______(happy,sad悲伤的,hungry,thirsty,excitied兴奋地….)
1. Practise in groups.
2. Tell and act it out.
即培养了合作交流的意识,且开拓思维,借此练习动词过去式的句型。
五、Homework
1、抄写课文P46 M10U1的单词两遍。
(1)分角色朗读对话。
(2)分角色表演对话。
四年级英语教案范文三:过去的动作
目标与重难点;
教学目标:
1、能够运用Did Dad cook lunch?这类语句询问他人过去的动作,并用Yes,he did./No, he didn’t.来回答。
2、学习并学会运用词汇phone。
3、学习一首歌谣,这项内容不作要求,让学生根据自己的情况选择学习与掌握。
二、教学重点:
能够运用Did Dad cook lunch?这类语句询问他人过去的动作,并用Yes,he did./No, he didn’t.来回答。
教学过程:
一、1、复习动词的过去式,教师把一些动词及其过去式写在黑板上,让学生连线。如cook, play,walk,watch,phone 和它们的过去式cooked, played,walked,watched,phoned ,其中只有phone-- phoned这个词学生没学,当他们把其他词对应起来之后,很容易地就掌握了phoned这个过去式。
2、练习,如引导学生依次说出下列内容:phone—phoned—phoned Grandma—Mum phoned Grandma—Yesterday,Mum phoned Grandma.
二、学习课文。
1教师用多媒体展示课文中的图片或让学生直接观察课文插图,通过仔细观察回答老师的问题:Did Dad cook lunch? 并且指导学生用Yes,he did.做回答。
2.听录音,学生讨论回答活动2中的问题。
3、再听录音,跟读课文。
4、在熟读课文的基础上让学生描述课文内容。
三、韵句学习:
1、学生自己读韵句,找出自己不会读的单词。
2、教师领读韵句内容。
3、听录音跟读。
4、学生边说韵句边表演出韵句内容。
四、课本,活动4.
Play the game: Last wekend.
六、 总结评价
1、这节课我的表现:A 优秀 B 良好 C不是很好,我要继续努力。
2、下列句子我会读。用“∨”标出会读的句子。
(1)Yesterday,Mr Smart cooked noodles for lunch.
(2)Tom helped him.
(3)Mum phoned Grandma.
(4)Sam and Amy watched TV.
(5)Did Dad cook lunch? Yes,he did./No, he didn’t
七、Homework:
认真听课文录音并跟读三遍。
九年级英语上册教案【篇7】
hear from sb.=receive/ get a letter from sb.
work well in doing sth.做某事方面很有功效
be short of 缺乏……
one of the greatest problems 最大问题之一
1.We got lost and couldn’t find each other. 我们走失了,互相找不到对方。
2.It seems that their living conditions were not very good. 似乎他们的生活条件不是很好。
3.It is possible that Kangkang’s father was the only child in his family.
康康的父亲有可能是他家中的独生子。
4.One answer is known as the one-child policy. 其中一项众所周知的措施是独生子女政策.
5.And even though we have made a lot of progress, we have big pollution problems in the
city. 虽然我们已经取得了很大的进步,但是仍存在严重的城市污染问题。
already “已经”(多用于肯定陈述句)。
如:He has already gone home. 他已经回家了。
yet “已经; 还”(用于否定句或疑问句)。
如:Have you found him yet? 你已经找到他了吗?
I haven’t finished my homework yet. 我还没完成作业。
※ already 也可用于疑问句,表“出乎意料或惊奇”
Have you finished your homework already? 难道你已经完成作业了?
ever “曾经”(多用于疑问句,问初次经历)。
如:I have ever been abroad. 我曾出过国。
never“从未;从来不”(多用于否定陈述句),常回答ever的句型。
如:I have never seen him before.
----Has he ever been abroad? 他曾出过国吗?
----No, never. 不,从来不。
just “刚刚”(多用于肯定句,位于谓语动词之前)。
如: I have just tried to call you. 我刚刚打电话给你。
before “之前”(一般位于句末;常与never呼应)。
如:He says he has never seen such beautiful scenery before.
1.---- I really hate to go shopping. 我真讨厌去购物。
---- So do I . 我也是。
So do I .为倒装句,表示前面提到的肯定情况也同样适合另外一个主体,表“某某也一样”,结构为“so + be /情态动词/ 助动词 + 主语”。
如:Jim is a student, so is Tom. 吉姆是一名学生,汤姆也是。
Jim can swim, so can Tom. 吉姆会游泳,汤姆也会。
Jim likes sports, so does Tom. 吉姆喜欢运动,汤姆也喜欢。
如表前面不怎样,后面“也不”怎样时,其结构为“ neither/ nor + be /情态动词/ 助动词 + 主语”。
如:Jim wasn’t Chinese, neither/ nor were they. 吉姆不中国人,他们也不是。
Jim can’t speak Japanese, neither can I . 吉姆不会说日语,我也不会。
Jim didn’t go there, neither did I . 吉姆没去那儿,我也没去。
如前后两句表达的是同一个主体,则不能倒装,表“的确如此”。
如:Jim is a good student. So he is. 吉姆是一名好学生,的确如此。
Jim swims well. So he does. 吉姆游泳很好,的确如此。
2.At that time, China was the country with the largest population in the world.
那时,中国是世界上人口最多的国家。
population为不可数名词,表示人口的多少只能用 “large”或 “small”修饰,提问人口用“what”.
如:The population of Shanghai is larger than that of Beijing. 上海的人口比北京多。
What’s the population of China?= How many people are there in China?
中国的人口有多少?
3. Great changes have taken place in China. 中国发生了巨大变化。
take place 指必然性的“发生”或有计划、安排之内的“举行”。
如:The meeting will take place next Friday. 会议将在下周五举行。
happen 指偶然的、没有预料的“发生“,其结果往往给人带来不幸或麻烦。
如:The accident happened yesterday. 事故发生在昨天。
※两者都不用于被动语态。
如:The population has increased a lot. 人口增长发很多。
4.increase 可作及物动词也可作不及物动词。其含义是“增长,增加,加强”等。
increase by… 指“增加了……”; increase to…指 “增加到……”
5. and about one fifth of the people in the world live in China.
而且世界上大约五分之一的人口生活在中国。
one fifth 是分数表达法。英文分数表达法:分子为基数词,分母为序数词,先读分子后读分母。当分子大于1时,分母的序数词则变为复数,直接在词尾加“s”。
如:one fourth四分之一three fourths 四分之三one second二分之一two thirds三分之二
6.It has worked well in controlling China’s population.
它在控制人口数量方面取得了显著的功效。
work well in doing sth. 表“在……方面很有功效”, 如:
如:Doing eye exercises works well in protecting our eyesight.
做眼保健操在保护视力方面很有功效。
7. Because of our large population, we are short of energy and water.
be short of… 表 “缺乏……”
如:She is always short of money at the end of every month. 每个月底她总是缺钱。
be short for… 表“是……的缩写”.
如:TV is short for television. TV是television的缩写形式.
8. Can all Chinese families offer their children a good education?
所有的中国家庭都能给他们的的孩子提供良好的教育吗?
offer 表“(主动)给予, 提供”
offer sb. sth. “提供某人某物”.
如:I offered him a glass of wine. 我敬了他一杯酒。
offer to do sth. “(主动)提出做某事”
如:She offered to cook for her mother. 她提出帮她妈妈煮饭。
I can’t go shopping in big stores unless I travel for a couple of hours.
我得花几个小时,才能到大的商场购物。
9. unless = if not 表“除非…; 如果不”,引导条件状语从句。
如:I won’t go unless I hear from you. = I won’t go if I don’t hear from you.
如果你不通知我,我就不去。
Unless Bill studies hard, he’ll fail in the exam. 如果比尔不努力, 他不会通过考试的.
10. a couple of… 表 “几个人或几件事”.
如:a couple of years ago 几年前; a couple of students 几个学生
如: a couple of watches 两只手表; five couples of cats 五对猫
11.pair 指两件不可分开使用的东西,它们可指两件互不相连的东西(鞋子、袜子等),也可指
两部分构成的一件东西(裤子、剪刀等)。
如:a pair of shoes 一双鞋子a pair of pants 一条裤子
( )1.-They have been to Australia.
-So _____ I.
A. do B. have been C. did D. have
分析:D 此句为so引导的完全倒装句。其含义为“A如此,B也如此。”其结构是so+be/助动词/情态动词+主语。本句为完成时态,其助动词是have。故选D。
( )2.The population of Shanghai is larger than _____ of Shenyang.
分析:A 此句要用相同成分即上海的人口和沈阳的人口做比较。因为population是不可数名词,所以用that代替。如果是复数名词则要用those来代替。
( )3.-_____ the population of the U.S.A. in ?
-It _____ about 296 million.
C. How many is; was D. How many was; is
分析:B 问人口的多少用what而不用how many。本题问的是的人口, 故为过去时态。
( )4._____ of the teachers are women in our school.
A. Two third B. Two threes C. Two thirds D. Second three
分析:C分数的表达法是基数词在前表示分子,序数词在后表示分母;当分子大于1时,表示分母的序数词要加s。
( )5.He’s read this book before, _____?
A. hasn’t he B. doesn’t he C .isn’t he D. wasn’t he
分析:A 本题考查反义疑问句反问部分的时态与人称的单复数要与陈述部分一致的用法。
( )6.The _____ population may be the greatest challenge of the world today.
A. increase B. increased C. increasing D. increases
分析:C 本题考查increase的现在分词作定语的情况,表示“正在增长的”。increased是它的过去分词也可作定语,但表示的是“已增长过的”。
( )7.The little girl has _____ finished reading the book you lent her.
A .already B. yet C. still D. once
分析:A already“已经”,常用覨t now.
分析:C 上句为否定情况,应用neither/nor+助动词+主语,表示“我也未参观过造纸厂”。
1. ---No one likes “Little Emperors.” ---N___________ do my parents.
2. The cars in the cities are i____________ rapidly these days, so traffic jam comes into being.
3. People couldn’t live long because of poor medical t________________.
4. In China, some people in less developed areas p__________ boys to girls.DA被动语态。根据题中changes是复数,答句用完成时态。故选B。
( )9.Students today have a lot of pressure(压力) _____ they have to learn too much knowledge at school.
A. in order to B .unless C. because D .because of
分析:C in order to和because of后面不能接从句,unless不符合题意。故选C,用because。
( )10.-I have never visited a paper factory.
A. So have I. B. So I have. C. Neither have I. D.I haven’t now.
分析:C 上句为否定情况,应用neither/nor+助动词+主语,表示“我也未参观过造纸厂”。
1. ---No one likes “Little Emperors.” ---N___________ do my parents.
2. The cars in the cities are i____________ rapidly these days, so traffic jam comes into being.
3. People couldn’t live long because of poor medical t________________.
4. In China, some people in less developed areas p__________ boys to girls.
5. His mother told him that the sun r__________ in the east and sets in the west.
1.We must ___________ ___________ (采取措施) to control the population.
2. Doing eye exercises ____________ __________ (起明显作用) in protecting our eyesight.
3. In 1960s, we were ________ _________ (缺乏) food and money .
4. He wouldn’t leave the TV set, __________ ___________ (既使) he was going to have an important exam the next day.
5.Her daughter __________ __________ (迷路) in the shopping center yesterday.
1.中国人口有多少? 中国有大约13亿人口。
_______ the _________ _______ China ? China ______ a population of ______1.3 billion.
2. 为什么中国要实施独生子女政策? 虽然跟以前比,中国人口增长放慢了,但人口问题依然严峻。
---Why does China _________ __________ with its __________ policy ?
---___________ its population is __________ _________ slowly than before, its population problem _________ ___________ quite ___________.
3. 这所学校里老师的数量是300人,其中四分之一是女教师。
_________ ___________ of the teachers in the school __________ 300, _________ ___________ of them ___________ women teachers.
4. 上周石油的价格增长了百分之二。 的确如些。
The price of oil ___________ ___________ 2% last week.
__________ _________ _____________.
5. 你生活在哪种家庭,是大家庭,还是小家庭?
_________ _________ of family are you ________, ________ family or _______ family ?
( ) 1. Two thirds of the surface of the earth ____ covered with water.
( ) 2. The number of workers in this factory _____ increasing.
( ) 3. ---It seems to me that you are very hard-working, Maria.
---I have to. I have a lot of _____ from my family and society.
A. time B. efforts C. pressure
( ) 4. ---______ have you done with the waste ?
---I have thrown it away.
( ) 5. ---Which country has a ____ population, England or Germany ?
( ) 6. About one fifth of the people in the world _____ in China.
A. live B. is living C. has lived
( ) 7. ---Excuse me, is Joan in ?
---Sorry, she isn’t here. She ___ to the airport to see her parents off half an hour ago.
A. went B. has gone C. has been
( ) 8. ---Who will go to the airport to meet Jenny ?
---I will. I _____ her several times. I can find her easily.
A. met B. have met C. will meet
( ) 9. We are tired. We have studies for ____ hours.
A. a couple B. couple C. a couple of
( ) 10. The more excellent our public transportation is, _____ our life will be.
A. the happier B. the more happy C. the more happily
( ) 11. ---What did Jeff say about the lost girl ?
---He said that he had seen her _______.
A. three days agoB. three days before C. for three days
( ) 12. ---Dad, my teacher said I had made a lot of progress recently.
---I’m glad to hear that. But I think you still _______.
A. have a long way to go B. have a rest C. live in the present
( ) 13. ---I went swimming last Sunday.
---_________. I like it very much.
A. So I do B. So I did C. So did I
( ) 14. ---We haven’t been to the Great Wall. ---_________.
A. So has she B. Nor she has C. Neither has she
( ) 15. ---Did you know _______?
---They had a quarrel about the answer to the question.
A. what did they happen B. what happened to them C. what they happened
1. Neither 2. increasing 3. treatment 4.prefer 5. rises
1. take measures 2. works well 3. short of 4. even though 5. got lost
1 What’s the population of, has, about / around
2. carry on, one-child, Though, growing more, still seems , serious
3. The number, is, a quarter, are
5. What kind/ sort / type, in, extended, nuclear
1----5 ABCBA 6----10 AABCA 11----15 BACCB
九年级英语上册教案【篇8】
9A Unit 1 Star Signs
1. It is nice of you to bring me the newspaper. (It’s nice of sb. to do sth. 某人做某事真是太好了,形容词表示人的品质特征时,介词用of)
2. It says I’ll have lots to eat and drink today. (报纸、杂志、牌子、广告等上写着用 says)
3. You shouldn’t worry about not having breakfast. (担心没有早饭吃) (worry about (not) doing sth. 担心(不)做某事,动名词的否定形式是在动名词前面加not)
4. A year is divided into (被分成)12 different star signs.
5. The time of your birthday decides your star sign.
6. People born under the same star sign (出生在同一星座下的人)share similar characteristics.
(be similar to = be the same as 和……相同,与…….相似)
7. take an active part in 积极参加 be impatient with sb. 对某人没有耐心
be patient with sb. 对某人有耐心 give up easily 轻易放弃
be curious about… 对……感到好奇 be kind / friendly / nice to sb. 对某人友好
be confident of sth. 对……有信心/把握 pay attention to details 注重细节
buy your friends nice gifts = buy nice gifts for your friends 给朋友买漂亮的礼物
have lots of energy = energetic 精力充沛 keep secrets 保守秘密
enjoy life 热爱生活 have a good sense of humour 有幽默感
be successful in doing sth. 成功地做某事 dream about everything 梦想一切
8. You love peace(热爱和平) and do not like to argue with others.(和别人争吵)
( argue with sb. about sth. 因某事和某人争吵)
9. It is silly of you not to forgive others for their faults.
(原谅别人的过失) (forgive sb. for sth. 原谅某人某事)
(动词不定式的否定放在不定式前面 not to do sth.)
10. You are patient enough(enough 修饰形容词放在形容词后面,patient 是形容词,前面要用be动词)to wait without getting angry. (介词后面用动词ing 形式)
11. You hate to be like anyone else( else修饰特殊疑问词、不定代词,放在它们后面) and try everything just to be different.
12. A fair person treats everyone equally.(平等地对待每个人,一视同仁)
13. A confident person feels sure about his own abilities.
( be / feel sure /certain of / about sth. 对感到自信/ 有把握)
14. make friends with him 和他交朋友 tell jokes 讲笑话
take care of = look after 照顾,照料 share food with others和别人分享食物
15. 反义词: active---inactive, modest---proud, patient---impatient, fair---unfair,
correct---incorrect, polite---impolite, selfish---generous,
16. It is thoughtful of Andy to play his CDs for us. (Andy为我们播放CD,他考虑得真周到)
17. It is typical of Simon to make such a mess. (把事情搞得乱七八糟是Simon的典型特征。)(make a mess 把……搞得乱七八糟)
18. each of us 我们每个人 at all times 一直,始终
travel around the world 周游世界 travel to different places 去不同的地方旅行
pass the football to Peter = pass Peter the football 把足球传给Peter
plan to go out 计划外出 pack one’s bag整理行李
19. Sandy has been on the phone for hours. (Sandy已经打了好几个小时的电话了。)
20. This month(这个月,不用介词) you will have a lot to celebrate.
21. You will have success at school or work(学业有成,事业有成) around the middle of the month.(大约在本月中旬)
22. You will be given some money.
23. For more details, please call Master Zhang on 5556 0678.
(call+人+on + 号码, 表示按….. 号码给……打电话)
24. a mixture of good luck and bad luck (好运和厄运的混合体)
25. go to a party 去参加聚会 have problems with my health 健康有问题
be suitable for the post 适合这个职位 run for the post 竞争这个职位
26. I don’t think he would be able to(=can) organize things well.
27. He is imaginative enough to come up with new ideas. 他富有充分的想象力来产生一些新的观点。(imaginative是形容词,前面要用be 动词,enough放在形容词之后)
(come up with =think of 想出)
28. Who else would be suitable (for the post)? 还有谁合适(这个职位)呢?
29. recommend David for the post / job 推荐David 担任这个职位/做这项工作(for +职位)
recommend David as the new chairperson of the Students’ Union
推荐David 当学生会的新任主席(as+人,既指职位也指人)
recommend a good dictionary to me (recommend sth. to sb. 向某人推荐某物)
recommend us to read this book (recommend sb. to do sth. 推荐某人做某事)
30. He is a Gemini. = His star sign is Gemini. 他是双子座。
31. The only thing is that David has much more hair than my uncle.
32. We think he will be an excellent chairperson because he has many good personal qualities.
33. He thinks he can do anything if he tries his best.
34. He is never afraid of making a speech(发言) in assembly(在晨会上).
(be afraid of doing sth. 害怕做某事) (他在晨会上发言从未害怕过/ 拘束过)
35. He will / would not mind doing extra work for the Students’ Union.
(不介意为学生会做额外的工作)(mind doing sth. 介意做某事)
36. He always gets good marks in tests. ( 在测试中成绩一直名列前茅)
37. He even got full marks(得满分) once in an English test.
38. He never forgets to do the things he needs to do. (从不忘记去做他需要做的事)
39. He has joined the Computer Club(参加电脑俱乐部) this year because he wants to learn to use the computer to help himself get more organized.(帮助自己工作起来更有效率)
40. We think that David has all the qualities to be a good chairperson.(具备了一个优秀学生会 主席应该具备的各项素质)
41. We hope that you agree with us.
42. ---It was kind of you to recommend me as the new chairperson.
= Thank you for recommending me as the new chairperson. (谢谢你们推荐我当新任主席)
---It’s our pleasure. = Not at all. = You are welcome. 不用谢。
43. You are the most suitable person.
44. Mr Wu spends a lot of time explaining things to us.
(spend ….doing sth.花时间做某事) (explain sth. to sb. 向某人解释某事)
45. Daniel is very clever, but he never shows off.(买弄,炫耀)
九年级英语上册教案【篇9】
I. 重点词组
1. get lost 迷路
2. each other 彼此
3.at least 至少
4take place发生
5because of 因为
6.be strict with sb. 对某人严格要求
7.carry out 实行
8.be short of 缺乏
9.take measures to do sth.采取措施做某事
10.be known as… 作为……而著名
well in doing…在……方面起作用
12.a couple of 一些
13keep up with赶上,跟上
II.重点句型
1. Have you found him yet? 你已经找到他了吗?
2. ——I really hate to go shopping. 我的确讨厌购物。——So do I.我也如此。
3. But it seems that their living conditions were not very good.但是似乎他们的生活条件不太好。
4. But great changes have already taken place in China recently.但是近来中国已发生了巨大的变化。
5. Because of the one-child policy, now most families have only one child.
由于我国独生子女政策的实行,现在大部分家庭只有一个孩子。
6. What’s the population of the U.S.A.?美国的人口是多少?
7. ——What’s more, the population in developing countries is growing faster. ——So it is.
而且,发展中国家的人口在更快地发展。 的确如此。
8. Our government has taken many measures to control the population.
我们的政府已采取了许多控制人口的措施。
III.语法:
常用于现在完成时的时间状语:already, just , yet, ever, never, recently.
e.g. 1. I have just called you.
2. ——Have you ever been to France? ——No, I’ve never been to any European countries.
3. ——Have you seen him yet? ——Yes, I have seen him already.
九年级英语上册教案【篇10】
Module3 unit2 language
Welcome
1. in a broad sense从广义上讲
2. transmit information传播信息
3. various forms of language语言的各种形式
4. stand for a beaming smile代表灿烂的微笑
5. all over the world/ throughout the world全世界
6. fly in circles 绕圈飞行
7. inform sb of/ about sth.通知某人某事
keep sb informed of sth使某人被通知
8. including sth/ sth included包括某事
9. share sth with sb与某人分享某物
10. make a special Internet language构成一种特殊的因特网语言
11. have some effective methods for studying the English language
有一些学习英语的特殊方法
Reading
1. throughout history贯穿历史;throughout the world/ all over the world
2. be made up of/consist of由…组成
3. a language with some confusing rules 一种带有令人迷惑规则的语言
4. bring sth with sb to sp将某物待在身边带到某地
5. at the end of the 9th Century 在九世纪晚期
6. a language called Celtic一种叫做凯尔特的语言
7. be different from与……不同
8. It’s certain that… …是确定的
9. the official language of England英国官方语
10. sb find it hard to do sth觉得做某事很难
11. This is because…/ That is why…表语从句句型
12. have similar meaning in …有类似的意思
13. contribute to / result in/ lead to/cause the development of……导致……的发展
14. sb take control of控制
15. sb lose control of失去控制
16. be replaced by/ with;设备sb take the place of sb 被…代替
17. despite the fact/ in spite of the fact尽管事实如此
18. have an impact on(the English language)对…巨大冲击
19. at this point在此期间
20. raise animals 饲养动物
21. the upper/lower class上(下)层阶级
22. common people普通人(地位相对低的)
23. by the latter half of the 24th century到24世纪下半叶
24. be adopted by被…采用
25. one’s mother tongue/ one’s native language母语
26. undergo huge changes(underwent, undergone)经历巨大变化/ undergo treatment接受治疗
27. continue doing/ continue to do sth继续做某事
28. a sequence of events一系列事件
29. relate… to…与…相关
30. official occasions官方正式场合
31. modern English/life/science and technology现代英语/生活/科技
32. make a promise; keep /break one’s promise做许诺;遵守诺言/食言
33. promise to do sth许诺做某事
34. a promising boy一个有前途的男孩
35. disagree with what =everything that =all that sb say
1.The English language is made up of/consists of the rules and vocabulary each group of people brought to Britain with them.
英语是由每个进入不列颠的人群所说语言中的规则和词汇构成的。
2.They brought with them their languages, which also mixed with Anglo-Saxon.
他们带来了自己的语言,与盎格鲁萨克森语混合起来
3.The language they created is what we now call Old English.
他们创造的语言就是我们现在所说的古英语。
4.Middle English is the name given to the English used from around the 12th to the 16th century.中古英语这个名词是指大约12世纪至16世纪期间所使用的英语
5.However, the Norman conquest did not have the same result that the Germanic invasion had had about 600 years earlier.
然而,诺曼征服并没有给英语带来大约6前日耳曼入侵所带来的相同后果。
6.The question of English will continue changing in the future is easy to answer.
英语在未来是否会继续变化这个问题其实很容易回答
7.Where a person comes from will affect their style of speech.
一个人来自哪里会影响他们说话的风格
8.There are many different dialects of English depending on where people live.
根据人们居住的地方(的不同)有许多不同英语方言。
9. We sometimes find it hard to decide which words or phrases to use
我们有时发现很难决定用何词和短语。
10.This is where I disagree.
This is what I disagree to.这就是我不赞同的地方。
Word power & Grammar & Task
1. spoken English/written English口语、书面语
2. a large amount of / a great deal of+不可数n
3. a large number of/ a great(good) many+可数n复
4. a large quantity of/plenty of+可数/不可数n
5. sort out=arrange安排
6. discard=throw away丢弃
7. I regret to inform you我遗憾地通知你
8. in addition=plus除此之外
9. have a word with=speak to与某人谈话
10. have words with sb与某人吵架
11. take sth into consideration考虑某事
12. five permanent members of the UN Security Council五个联合国安理会常任理事国
13. take action/measures to do sth采取行动做某事
14. set high standards for设一个标准
15. below standard在标准以下
16. up to the required standard超过被要求的标准
17. make a decision做决定
18. at one time曾经(at times 有时候)
19. at a time一次
20. keep … pure使…纯化
21. due to/because of/thanks to/ as a result of/owing to由于
22. ban sb from doing sth阻止某人做某事
23. easily accessed television programs容易接受的电视节目have access to
24. get along/on with sb与某人相处
25. There is no need to do sth没有必要做某事
26. waste time doing sth浪费时间做某事
27. It’s a waste of time to do/doing sth
28. shorten the distance缩短距离
29. embarrass sb into doing sth做某事使某人尴尬
30. refuse to accept an idea拒绝接受一个主意
31. from across the world从全世界
32. adopt one’s suggestion/a new teaching method
采纳某人的建议/一种新的教学方法
project
1. A differ greatly from B in size and shape
A与B 在尺寸及形状方面大大不同
2. the very first Chinese characters真正第一批简体中文
3. change over time随着时间改变
4. as a whole作为整体
5. on the whole(常用于句首)
6. combine two or more elements together把两种及更多种元素结合起来
7. the symbol for a man代表人类
8. be the opposite of sth是…的相反
9. Opposite our school are two shops.(倒装句)
10. Opposite our school is a shop.
11. be highly complex非常复杂
12. reflect one’s thought反应某人的思想
13. simplified Chinese characters简体中文
14. be widely used in mainland China在中国大陆广泛使用
15. The way a written language developed can tell us just as much about a culture as the history of a spoken language.书面语发展方式表示出来的文化就像口语的历史表示出来的文化一样。
16. The Chinese language differs from many Western languages in that it uses characters which have meanings and can stand alone as words.
汉语和许多西方语言不同,区别在于汉语使用本身就有意义,可以独立成字的汉字。
17. Not all characters are used to describe objects.=
All characters are not used to describe objects.=并非所有汉字都用来描述事物的。
九年级英语上册教案【篇11】
2. pour… into… 把……排放到……
5. do harm to … / be harmful to… 对……有害
1. Look, there are several chemical factories pouring waste water into the streams.
看, 有几家化工厂正往河里排放废水.
2. Everything has changed.一切已发生了变化.
3. How long have you been like this? 你像这样多长时间了?
4. I’m always in a bad mood because I can’t stand the environment here.
我的情绪总是很差因为我受不了这里的环境.
5. However, not all people know that noise is also a kind of pollution and is harmful to humans’ health.
然而,并非所有的人都知道噪音也是一种污染, 而且有害于人类健康.
1. Granny said, “I’m feeling even worse.”
Granny said that she was feeling even worse.
2. “ Do you still want to live here, Granny?” the journalist asked.
The journalist asked Granny if she still wanted to live there.
3. “ How is the environment around this place?” the journalist asked.
The journalist asked how the environment around that place was.
九年级英语上册教案【篇12】
一、学习目标:
知识目标:能正确使用Mdule 12中的单词和短语;
能力目标:能表述某一课程的情况;正确掌握主谓一致。
情感目标:通过了解其他国家暑期培训班、夏令营等相关信息,拓展视野。
二、重点、难点:
重点:
1. 应用本模块交际用语,如:Welce t…; Please give a ” I std up and englishcurse-suer.c.
试题答案
一、1. A 2. B 3. C
4. A 解析:the rest在此处指“其余的钱”,ne为不可数名词,因此the rest所指为单数意义,谓语动词要用单数。此外,“give sth. t sb.”的`被动形式为“sth. be given t sb.”,故选A。
5. B 6. D 7. B 8. C
9. D 解析:该题考查主谓一致。由nt nl…but als连接两个并列主语,其谓语动词的单复数形式同与其最靠近的主语保持一致,故谓语动词应用单数形式。又据句意“他们都还没有回来”,可知用has gne而不用has been。
10. A 解析:该题考查主谓一致。neither…nr是一组连词,可连接两个并列主语,其谓语动词应同最靠近它的主语I保持一致,因此选A。
11. A 解析:该题考查主谓一致。这个句子的主语是a nuber f deer,是一个复数概念,因此谓语动词应用复数形式。(deer的单复数同形)
12. B
13. D 解析:“分数或百分数+f+名词”构成的短语作主语时,其谓语动词的单复数形式要由f后的名词而定。One third f the是指“三分之一的学生”,f后的the是指学生,为可数名词的复数,故谓语动词要用复数。
14. B
15. C 解析:此句意为“当我来访时,他们全家人正在吃晚饭”,fail是指家里的每一个人,故谓语动词要用复数。
二、1~5 DABCD 6~10 AAABD
三、(A) CDADB (B) ABDBC
四、1. sunglasses 2. curse 3. bed 4. rest 5. prgress 6. experienced
7. Mer 8. relatinships 9. applicatin 10. activities
五、1. have taen place 2 give a 5
九年级英语上册教案【篇13】
Unit 4 What would you do?
Part 1: Teaching design (第一部分:教学设计)
Structures: Second conditional, Should for advice
Target language:
What would you do if you won a million dollars?
I’d give it to medical research.
I can’t sleep the night before an exam. What should I do?
If I were you, I’d take a long walk before going to bed.
Vocabulary: million, charity, pimple, confident, shirt, tie, medical research
Learning strategies: Matching, Listening for key words
SECTION A
Goals
●To learn to use Second conditional and Should for advice
●To listen and talk about imagined life
Procedures
Warming up by learning about Second conditional and Should for advice
The second conditional (also called conditional type 2) is a structure used for talking about unreal situations in the present or in the future. This page will explain how the second conditional is formed, and when to use it.
The structure of a second conditional sentence
Like a first conditional, a second conditional sentence consists of two clauses, an “if” clause and a main clause:
if clause main clause
If I had a million dollars, I would buy a big house.
If the “if” clause comes first, a comma is usually used. If the “if” clause comes second, there is no need for a comma:
main clause if clause
I would buy a big house if I had a million dollars.
We use different verb forms in each part of a second conditional:
if clause if + subject + simple past verb*
main clause subject + would + verb
1a Talking about imaginary situations
What would you do if you had a lot of money?
If I had a lot of money, I would give it to charity.
If I had a lot of money, I would buy snacks.
If I had a lot of money, I would give it to Hope Project.
If I had a lot of money, I would buy books for the poor.
1b Listening and numbering
Now you are going to listen and number the pictures 1 to 3 in the order you hear them.
Tapescript
Girl1: Hey, did you see this newspaper article? An old man had a million dollars. And he gave it to charity.
Boy1: Wow, what a nice man!
Girl1: What would you do if you had a million dollars?
Boy1: If I had a million dollars, I’d give the money to the zoo. I want to help the pandas.
Girl1: That’s a gook idea! I know what I’d do. I’d buy a big house for my family.
Girl2: Really? I’d put the money in the bank. Then I’d just watch it grow!
Boy2: Hmmmm… I think I’d give the money to medical research. I’d want to help other people.
Now listen again and write down the sentences with Second conditional and Should for advice
1c Doing pairwork
Let’s pretend that we are the people in the picture on page 26. Talk with your partner about what you would do if you had a million dollars.
Look. This old man had a million dollars, and he gave it to charity.
Wow! What would you do if you won a million dollars?
I’d give it to medical research.
I’d take a chance to achieve my dream of flying to the moon.
If I won a million dollars, I’d stop working and become a professional runner.
I’d go to an old people’s home to help them.
I’d volunteer at the hospital twice every week.
2a Listening and circling
Listen to the tape and circle the reasons in the box on page 27 why Larry is nervous.
Tapescript
Girl1: Where are you going, Larry?
Boy1: To Tom’s party.
Girl1: Lucky you! I’d love to go to that party!
Boy1: Yeah, well, I’m a little nervous. I don’t know what to wear.
Girl1: If I were you, I’d wear a shirt and tie.
Boy1: And I don’t have a present. What if everyone brings a present?
Girl1: If I were you, I’d take a small present-a pen or
something. Keep it in your pocket and if everyone has a present,
you can give him yours. If not, you can keep it.
Boy1: OK. But what if I don’t know anyone?
Girl1: If you don’t know anyone, you can talk to Tom. He’ll introduce you to people.
Boy1: I guess I can do that.
Girl1: Look! You’re sure to have fun. But if you’re still nervous, you can leave.
Now listen again and write down all the expressions onto your phrase book.
go to that party, a little nervous, wear a shirt and tie, have a present, bring a present, take a small present, keep…in your pocket, know anyone, talk to…, introduce… to …, have fun
2b Listening and checking
Listen to the tape again and check on page 27 the four things Larry’s sister says to him.
2c Doing pairwork
Xu Linfeng, you are Larry. Men Yating, you are Larry’s sister. Xu is going to talk about his worries and Men is going to give him advice.
X: I don’t know what to wear. M: If I were you, I’d wear a shirt and tie.
X: I don’t have a present. What if everyone else brings a present? M: If I were you, I’d take a small present-a pen or something.
X: What if I don’t know anyone? M: If you don’t know anyone, you can talk to Tom. He’ll introduce you to people.
… …
3a Reading and matching
Go to page 28. Read the problems in the boxes and match them with the correct advice.
And now write down all the expressions into your phrase book.
be really shy, enjoy parties, get nervous before big parties, get pimples, look terrible, the night before…, take a big exam, do well, help with…, eat lots of fruits, drink lots of water, take a long walk, go to bed, look friendly, feel shy
3b Thinking and role playing
Next you are going to think of different advice for the problems in activity 3a. Role play conversations with your partner.
A: I am really shy. I don’t enjoy parties. B: If I were you, I’d go and shout in the street. I’d set up parties and invite all my classmates to come and sing and dance.
A: I get nervous before big parties and I get pimples. B: Pimples look good to me. They are not terrible at all. If I were you, the night before the big exam I’d lie in bed counting the cows, the sheep, the cattle and the horses. Then I’d have a nice sleep. If you count as many cows as possible you’d do well in the exam.
A: I can’t lose my weight. B: If I were you, I’d eat lots of fruits, drink lots of water and take a long walk before going to bed every evening.
4. Doing group work
You are put into pairs and find out each other’s problems at school and at home. Then give each other advice.
I really want to go to the mall with my parents, but I don’t have the time. Finish your homework at school and stop going to Sunday classes. You’ll find time that way.
I failed the driver’s exam and cannot get my driver’s license. Go practicing driving more often and go over the textbook three more times. You won’t fail next time.
My father does not want me to get my ears pierced. If I were you, I’d go to my mother for support. Or you can ask your mother to have her ears pierced first.
I have to go to school on foot. I want to take the bus. Going to school on foot is good for your health. Go on going to school, to any places nearby on foot. It save money, too.
I like to choose my own clothes, but my mother doesn’t allow me to do that. Wear your school uniforms while you are still a student. Wait till you are a big man and you’d have the right to choose your own clothes.
… …
Closing down by taking a test on Second conditional
Match up the parts of the sentence
1. If I lost my job,
a) we'd both benefit.
b) I'd have a lot of problems getting another one.
c) you'd be more aware of what people really felt.
d) we wouldn't be so behind technologically.
2. If I were in your position,
a) I'd resign rather than wait to be sacked.
b) I'd have a lot of problems getting another one.
c) you'd be more aware of what people really felt.
d) we wouldn't be so behind technologically.
3. If I spoke Japanese as well as you do,
a) I'd resign rather than wait to be sacked.
b) I'd try to find a job with one of the Japanese banks.
c) we'd both benefit.
d) we wouldn't be so behind technologically.
4. If we spent more on Research and Development,
a) I'd resign rather than wait to be sacked.
b) I'd have a lot of problems getting another one.
c) I'd try to find a job with one of the Japanese banks.
d) we wouldn't be so behind technologically.
5. If you spoke less and listened more,
a) I'd resign rather than wait to be sacked.
b) I'd have a lot of problems getting another one.
c) I'd try to find a job with one of the Japanese banks.
d) you'd be more aware of what people really felt.
6. If you spent more time on your own problems and a bit less on mine,
a) I'd resign rather than wait to be sacked.
b) I'd have a lot of problems getting another one.
c) we'd both benefit.
d) I'd try to find a job with one of the Japanese banks.
7. If we controlled our expenses a bit better,
a) I'd resign rather than wait to be sacked.
b) I'd have a lot of problems getting another one.
c) we'd save a lot of money.
d) I'd try to find a job with one of the Japanese banks.
8. If you invested some time into learning how the Internet works,
a) you'd find that it could really help you in your job.
b) I'd have a lot of problems getting another one.
c) we wouldn't be so behind technologically.
d) I'd try to find a job with one of the Japanese banks.
9. If we opened an office in Tokyo,
a) we wouldn't be so behind technologically.
b) you'd be more aware of what people really felt.
c) I'd be interested in working there.
d) we'd both benefit.
10. If you didn't take the job,
a) you'd regret it later.
b) you'd be more aware of what people really felt.
c) we wouldn't be so behind technologically.
d) I'd try to find a job with one of the Japanese banks.
SECTION B
Goals
●To find out about people’s personalities
●To learn to communicate by Second conditional and Should for advice
Procedures
Warming up by learning about personality
What is personality? What is your personality?
In psychology, personality describes the character of emotion, thought, and behavior patterns unique to a person. There are several theoretical perspectives on personality in psychology, which involve different ideas about the relationship between personality and other psychological constructs, as well as different theories about the way personality develops.
1a Describing and filling
Turn to page 29 and fill in the blanks with words given.
1b Which words in activity 1a describe you? Tell your partner.
What are you like? I think I am creative and outgoing.
Words used to describe people
Adventurous, superstitious, dependant (on), unfriendly, aggressive, active, old-fashioned, anxious, adaptable, decent, moral, annoyed, irritated, arrogant, very irritating, enlightened, well-informed, upset, excited, open, open-minded, sincere, honest, crazy, flipped-out, well-balanced, stable, shy, timid, talented, gifted, excited, enthusiastic, crazy, mad, persevering, persistent; dogged, helpful, well-known/famous, crazy, loopy, mad, zany, popular, modest, humble, self-effacing, demented, crazy, possessive, spellbinding, fascinating, silly, ignorant, stupid, spiteful, evil, angry, mean, spiteful, well-behaved, good, chaotic, disorganized, charming, cool, thankful, grateful, dumb, self-centred, ambitious, honest, jealous, selfish, simple, plain, simply, arrogant, smug, vain, unique, matchless, lonely, lonesome, vain, very mean, detestable, disgusting, elegant, classy, touchy, sensitive (to), sensitive, feeling, energetic; assertive, committed, dedicated, narrow-minded, successful
serious, first-class, fair, fantastic, fascinating, lazy, cowardly, fainthearted, refined, unchanging, solid, fit, feeling good, hard-working, industrious, progress-minded, cheeky, kind, friendly, happy, cheerful, merry, thoughtful, considerate, hospitable, generous, educated, cultured; well informed, patient, dangerous, full-of-feeling, sentimental, brilliant, stingy, cheap, tight, rude, low, ignorant, pleasant, brilliant, genius, just; fair; impartial, valued, dear, appreciated, clever, skillful, skillful, clever (at), closed, reserved, talkative, chatty, talkative, sociable, healthy, conscientious, greedy, reliable, trustworthy, pathetic (towards); unconcerned (about), indifferent (to), happy, lucky, rude, generous, well-dressed, good-humoured, well informed (on), good-natured, stubborn, hard-headed, stubborn, domestic, home-loving, cheerful, bright, clear-headed, uninhibited, unworried, wonderful, magnificent, heartless, helpful, cooperative, helpful, deceitful, tricky, naughty, proud, snobby, stuck-up, polite, hungry, realistic
2a Listening and checking
Cella is asking Bill questions from a personality survey. Check the questions Cella asks.
Tapescript
Girl1: I just did a personality survey in Teen Time magazine. It tells you how confident you are.
Boy1: Oh? How did you do, Celia?
Girl1: I don’t know yet. But it’s a really interesting test. You should try it, Bill.
Boy1: OK.
Girl1: How about question 1? What would you do if the teacher asked you to give a speech in front of the whole school?
Boy1: I’d say I had a cold and couldn’t speak. I would be afraid to make a speech in front of the whole school.
Girl1: How about this movie question? What would you do if someone asked you to be in a movie?
Boy1: Oh, I’d say no. I’d be too nervous. What’s the next question?
Girl1: Let’s see…
2b Listening and circling
You shall listen again to the recording and circle Bill’s responses. Copy the phrases from the listening script.
do a personality survey, in Teen Time magazine, a really interesting test, give a speech, in front of the whole school, have a cold, be afraid to make a speech, in front of the whole school, in a movie
2c Doing pairwork
In pairs ask and answer the questions in the personality survey on page 29.
3a Reading and filling
Look at the survey in 2a and read the personality survey result below on page 30. Fill in the balnks with a, b or c.
3b Looking and writing
Next you are to write your own personality survey based on the that in 2a.
4 Doing groupwork
Ask students in your group the questions from your survey. Discuss the results.
Closing down by taking a personality survey
Read each statement carefully, and choose one answer from “Strongly Agree”, “Agree”, “Disagree”, “ Strongly Disagree” as a description of you.
Questions Strongly Agree Agree Disagree Strongly Disagree
Waste my time?
Often feel blue?
Seldom feel blue?
Have little to say?
Do not like art?
Believe in the importance of art?
Dislike myself?
Have a good word for everyone?
Feel comfortable with myself?
Feel comfortable around people?
Am not interested in abstract ideas?
Have a sharp tongue?
Are always prepared?
Keep in the background?
Pay attention to details?
Rarely get irritated?
Respect others?
Make friends easily?
Have a vivid imagination?
Find it difficult to get down to work?
Am not easily bothered by things?
Know how to captivate people?
Avoid philosophical discussions?
Accept people as they are?
Get chores done right away?
skilled in handling social situations?
Cut others to pieces?
Carry out my plans?
Am very pleased with myself?
Would describe my experiences as somewhat dull?
Do not enjoy going to art museums?
Suspect hidden motives in others?
Do just enough work to get by?
often down in the dumps?
Tend to vote for liberal political candidates?
Tend to vote for conservative political candidates?
Make people feel at ease?
Make plans and stick to them?
Have frequent mood swings?
Don't like to draw attention to myself?
Carry the conversation to a higher level?
Get back at others?
Don't see things through?
Panic easily?
Don't talk a lot?
Enjoy hearing new ideas?
Insult people?
Shirk my duties.
Believe that others have good intentions?
SELF CHECK
1.Filling the blanks
On page 31 is a box with sentences in black. Read them and fill in the blanks with a correct word given. Make changes to the form if necessary.
2.Reading an e-mail
Read the e-mail from Fran and copy all the expressions.
Subject: Can you help? From: Fran
Dear Knowledgeable,
My best friend, Mei, has a problem. There is a really important English speech contest for our whole city next month. Our classmates want her to represent the class in the school contest. Everyone is sure she will win. It’s probably true. Mei is very clever, and can speak English really well. In fact, she always comes top in the school exams. The problem is that she’s very shy. She doesn’t want to let her friends down, but she’s terrified of speaking in front of other people. She’s my friend, so she can tell me that she’s shy. But she can’t tell everyone that. I don’t think they would believe her. I can’t think of any good advice to give her, but you always come up with good solutions to people’s problems. What do you think I should tell Mei? What do you think I should tell the rest of the students? Fran
Just for fun
To end this period let’s do something fun-to find the animals.
Reading: What would you do if …?
Before you read, go to page 148 to learn the words for this reading passage first.
While you read, put the sentences into thought groups and underline all the useful phrases to be copied later after class.
Martin Robinson is a famous doctor/ who has a lot of experience/ dealing with teenagers. His new book/ What Would You Do/ If…? came out/ last month. It gives advice/ on what to do/ in lots of different situations. Here are two pages/ from the book.
ACCIDENTS
Question 1: What would you do/ if you cut yourself/ by accident?
Doctor: You should cover the cut/ with a clean cloth /and press it/ hard. If it’s a deep cut, you should see a doctor.
Question 2: If my grandmother fell downstairs, and wasn’t moving, I’d hurry/ to call the hospital/ first. Is that/ correct?
Doctor: Yes, speed is very important. Get the medical help/ first, then make her comfortable/ and stay/ with her.
Question 3: What would you do/ if you burned yourself/ by accident?
Doctor: Well, first find out/ how bad/ it is. Then/ put the burned area/ under cold running water.
Question 4: What would you do/ if you injured your knee /while running?
Doctor: If I felt some pain, I’d stop exercising. And/ if it hurt/ for more than a few days, I’d see a doctor.
PROBLEMS
Problem 1: A friend offers you cigarettes/ at a party.
Advice: Of course/ you should refuse!If I were you, I’d also talk to your friend/ about the dangers of smoking.
Problem 2: Children often think/ medicine is candy/ and eat it.
Advice: You must always hide medicine/ from children, and/ you should tell children/ to ask their parents/ before they eat “candy”/ they find.
Problem 3: An “internet friend” has asked/ if you could meet.
Advice: You should tell your parents/ about it, agree to meet/ in a public place, and you shouldn’t go alone.
Problem 4: You get pimples/ when you are nervous.
Advice: You should drink lots of water/ and ask your doctor for advice.
Part 2: Teaching Resources (第二部分:教学资源)
A Personality survey
In School
1. I like teachers who set routines and have organized ways of conducting classes.
2. I like classes to be “hands on,” I like to play games, compete, and solve problems.
3. I like my teachers, especially those who are friendly.
4. I learn best by working by myself.
5. I prefer teachers who stay on one topic at a time.
6. I like classes that have contests, changes of pace, and variety.
7. My favorite subjects are about people, such as language, drama, and literature.
8. I am easily bored if the subject holds no interest to me.
9. I like subjects that are useful and traditional, such as history and government.
10. My favorite subjects are music, art, and crafts.
11. I am social and work best in a group setting.
12. Sometimes, it is hard for me to decide what's important, because so many things are interesting to me.
With Friends
13. I prefer friends who are careful with their money and who make plans ahead of time.
14. Planning ahead bores me because I never know what I want to do until the moment arrives.
15. I am sensitive to rejection and need to know that a person cares about me.
16. I may seem distant and without emotions.
17. I like my friends to be loyal, dependable, and on time.
18. I like to excite my friends with new and different things.
19. I appreciate real, human feedback and like to receive notes and gifts.
20. I am uneasy about showing my emotions.
With Family
21. I like stability and security and enjoy traditions and celebrations.
22. I need a lot of space and freedom.
23. I like to be happy and loving.
24. I am probably seen as a loner because I like a lot of private time to think.
25. I like to spend holidays with family members and plan on such gatherings for months and months.
26. It is hard for me to follow rules and I feel we all should just enjoy one another.
27. I am very sensitive to rejection from my family and to family conflicts.
28. Sometimes, I find activities boring and have difficulty following family rules that don't make sense to me.
九年级英语上册教案【篇14】
Unit 4 what would you do? 教案示例(1)
I. Analysis of the Teaching Material
1. Status and Function
In this unit students learn to talk about imaginary situations. Such topic enables students to activate their imagination and raises learning interest of students.
All the students are active in such activities.
(1) The first period introduces the key vocabulary words and the target language in this unit. The topic, what would you do if you had a lot of money, makes the introduction easier.
(2) In the second period, students will learn to give advice to someone who is in an embarrasing situation by listening and pairwork activities with the target language.
(3)All the activities in the third period are designed to give students a rein forced practice in the use of the target language.
(4)In the fourth period, the first part is a vocabulary expansion activity. The other activities provide students with much integrating practice using the old and new target language.
(5) The fifth period provides students with much reading and writing practice. So it’s helpful to improve students’ reading and writing skills.
(6)The Self check in the sixth period shows students what they have learned. The making sentences and writing an e-mail activities are used to train students’ ability of reading and writing.
2. Teaching Aims and Demands
(1)Knowledge Objects
To make students grasp how to talk about imaginary situations.
To make students grasp how to give advice using the target language.
(2) Ability Objects
To train students’ listening, speaking, reading and writing skills.
To train students’ communicative competence.
(3) Moral Objects
Imaginary situations are unreal. Do remember: it’s really cool to realize your dream through great efforts.
Two heads are better than one. Be ready to help others.
In the United States, teenagers get their pocket money by helping parents with housework. It is a little different from that in China.
3. Teaching Key Points
To learn the key vocabulary words and the target language.
To make students use the target language to give advice.
4. Teaching Difficult Point
To train students’ listening, speaking, reading and writing skills by many different kinds of activities.
5. Studying Ways
Teach students how to communicate with others.
Teach students how to give advice when someone is in trouble.
Ⅱ. Language Function
Talk about imaginary situations.
Ⅲ. Target Language
1. What would you do if you won a million dollars?
I’d give it to medical research.
2.I can’t sleep the night before an exam.
What should I do?
If I were you, I’d take a long walk before going to bed.
Ⅳ.Structures
1. Second conditional
2. Should for advice
Ⅴ. Vocabulary
lottery, million, pimple, energetic, confident, shirt, tie, medical research
Ⅵ. Recycling
charity, present, fruit, vegetable, snack, shy, creative, outgoing, nervous, relax,
late, tired
Ⅶ. Learning Strategies
1. Matching
9. Listening for key words
Ⅷ. Teaching Time
Seven periods
The First Period
Ⅰ. Teaching Aims and Demands
1.Knowledge Object
(1) Key Vocabulary
lottery, million, medical, research
(2) Target Language
Look. This girl won a million dollars in the lottery.
Wow! What would you do if you won a million dollars?
I’d give it to medical research.
(3)Structure
I would/I’d do
2. Ability Objects
(1) Train students’ listening skill.
(2) Train students’ communicative competence.
3. Moral Object
If you won a million dollars, you’d buy a big house, buy a car and so forth. However do remember it’s really being cool to realize your dream through great efforts.
Ⅱ.Teaching Key Points
1. Target language
2. The structure: I would/I’d do
Ⅲ. Teaching Difficult Point
The structure: I would/I’d do
Ⅳ. Teaching Methods
1. Scene teaching Method
2. Teaching by induction
3. Pairwork
Ⅴ. Teaching Aid
A tape recorder
Ⅳ. Teaching Procedures
Step Ⅰ Revision
Review the structure “should be allowed to” by asking students to make sentences about school rules.
Step Ⅱ 1a
This activity focuses on vocabulary and structures introduced in the unit.
Read the instructions to the class.
Call students’ attention to the words in the box. Ask a student to read them to the class.
Say, What would you do if you had a lot of money? Add more ideas to the list.
Then share your answers with other students.
Get students to complete the task. First individually, then in groups.
As they work, walk around the room checking progress and offering any help they may need.
Collect answers from students on the blackboard.
Answers will vary but should include a mixture of ideas for helping themselves and others.
Step Ⅲ 1b
This activity gives students practice understanding the target language in spoken conversation.
Read the instructions to the class.
Read the question in the speech bubble.
Explain the word lottery to students.
Say, You will hear teenagers talking about what they would do if they won the lottery.
Point to the pictures. Ask students to describe them one by one.
For example, for Picture One, a student might say, “If I won the lottery, I’d buy a big house.”
Point out the sample answer. Say, The first picture you will hear about has the number one on it.
Play the recording for the first time.
Students only listen.
Play the recording again. This time students listen and number the pictures in the order they hear them.
Check the answers.
Answers
2,1,4,3
Tapescript
Girl 1: Hey, did you see this newspaper article? A girl won a million dollars in the lottery. She was only 14.
Boy 1: Wow, how luck!
Girl 1: What would you do if you won the lottery?
Boy 1:If I won the lottery, I’d give the money to the 200. I want to help the pandas.
Girl 1:That’s a good idea! I know what I’d do. If I won the lottery, I’d buy a big house for my family.
Girl 2: Really? I’d put the money in the bank. Then I’d just watch it grow!
Boy 2: Hmmmm… I think I’d give the money to medical research. I’d want to help other people.
Step Ⅳ 1c
This activity provides oral practice using the target language.
Read the instructions to the class.
Call students’ attention to the conversation in the box. Explain the vocabulary words million and medical research. Invite a pair of students to read it to the class.
SA :Look! This girl won a million dollars in the lottery.
SB: Wow ! What would you do if you won a million dollars?
SA: I’d give it to medical research.
Write it on the blackboard.
Say, Pretend you are the people in the picture. Talk with your partner about what you would do if you won a million dollars.
Get students to work in pairs. As they work in pairs together, walk around the room offering language support as needed.
After students have had a chance to practice several exchanges, ask pairs to come to the front of the classroom and act out their conversations.
Step Ⅴ Summary
In this class, we’ve learned some vocabulary words and the target language what would you do if you won the lottery? I’d give it to medical research.
Step Ⅵ Homework
If you had a large amount of money, e, g. ¥100,000 what would you buy? Please write down each item and its cost to see when you will spend the full amount. And bring your lists to class tomorrow.
Step Ⅶ Blackboard Design
Unit 4 What would you do?
Section A
The First Period
Target language:
A: Look. This girl won a million dollars in the lottery.
B: Wow! What would you do if you won a million dollars?
A: I’d give it to medical research.
Unit 4 what would you do 教案示例(2)
Ⅰ. Teaching Aims and Demands
1. Knowledge Objects
(1) Key Vocabulary tie
(2) Target Language
What would you do if you won a million dollars?
I’d give it to charities.
If I were you, I’d wear a shirt and tie.
If I were you, I’d take an umbrella.
2. Ability Objects
(1)Train students’ listening skill.
(2) Train students’ communicative competence.
3. Moral Object
Two heads are better than one. Give some direction to those who are in trouble.
Ⅱ. Teaching Key Points
1.Listening Practice
2.Target language
Ⅲ. Teaching Difficult Point
Train students’ ability to use the target language.
Ⅳ. Teaching Methods
1.Listening to cassettes
2.Pairwork
3.Teaching by induction
Ⅴ. Teaching Aids
1.A tape recorder
2.A picture of a person in a lion’s cage
3.A projector
Ⅵ. Teaching Procedures
Step Ⅰ Revision
Check homework. Students talk about how to spend a large amount of money.
Invite a student to come to the front of The class and ask, if you had 100,000 yuan, what would you buy? Students take turns answering his/her question.
Step Ⅱ 2a
This activity provides practice understanding the target language in spoken conversation.
Focus attention on the picture. Ask students to describe it. Help students say that the boy is going to somewhere, but he doesn’t know what to wear. The girl is helping him to pick out clothes.
Point to the list of reasons. Invite a student to read them to the class.
Say, You are to listen to a conversation between Larry and the girl and circle the reasons. Play the recording the first time. Students only listen. Play the recording a second time. This time students listen and circle the reasons.
Check the answers.
Answers
Circle items:2,3,5
Tapescript
Girl 1:Where are you going, Larry?
Boy 1:To Tom’s party.
Girl 1:Lucky you! I’d love to go to that party !
Boy 1: Yeah, well, I’m a little nervous. I don’t know what to wear.
Girl 1: If I were you, I’d wear a shirt and tie.
Boy 1: What if everybody else is wearing jeans and T-shirts?
Girl 1: Oh, you shouldn’t worry about what other people are wearing.
Boy 1: And I don’t have a present. What if everyone brings a present?
Girl 1: If I were you, I’d take a small present-a pen or something.
Keep it in your pocket and if everyone has a present, you can give him yours. If not, you can keep it.
Boy 1:OK. But what if I don’t know anyone?
Girl 1: If you don’t know anyone, you can talk to Tom. He’ll introduce you to people.
Boy 1 : I guess I can do that.
Girl 1: Look! You’re sure to have fun.
But if you’re still nervous, you can leave.
Step Ⅲ 2b
This activity provides listening practice using the target language.
Read the instructions to the class.
Point to the list of sentences. Invite a student to read them to the class.
Say, You will listen to the same conversation again. This time you are to check the four things Larry’s sister says to him.
Play the recording again. Students listen and check the things.
Check the answers.
Answers
Checked items: 1,2,4,5
Step Ⅳ 2c
This activity provides oral practice using the target language.
Point to the list of Larry’s worries in the box. Invite a student to read them to the class.
Ask students to look back at the list of checked sentences.
Read the instructions to the class. Say,
Please make conversations using information from Activities 2b and 2c.
Ask a pair of students to demonstrate a conversation to the class.
SA: I don’t know what to wear.
SB: If I were you, I’d wear a shirt and tie.
Get students to work in pairs. As the pairs work together, walk around the room listening in on various pairs and giving language and pronunciation support as needed.
After all the students have a chance to play both parts, stop the activity. Ask different students to perform their conversations.
Optional activity
Ask students to write down a problem they have on a piece of paper. Have students exchange papers with one another and read the one they receive. Then ask students to write two pieces of advice they would give the other student. Ask a student to read his/her advice to the class. The rest guess the problem.
Step Ⅴ Grammar Focus
Ask different students to read the question and answer and the statements to the
class.
S1:What would you do if you won a million dollars?
S2:I’d give it to charities.
S3:If I were you, I’d wear a shirt and tie.
S4:If I were you, I’d take an umbrella.
Write them on the blackboard.
Show a picture of someone in a lion’s cage on the screen by a projector. Ask students
questions pointing to the picture.
T: Have you ever been in a lion’s cage?
Ss: No.
T: That’s right. None of us has ever been in a lion’s cage. What would you do if you were in a lion’s cage? (Write the question on the blackboard.)
S1:I’d call for help. (Write the sentence on the blackboard.)
T: What about you?
S1:I’d get out fast. (Write the sentence on the blackboard. )
Get several more examples from other students.
Say, When we talk about things that haven’t happened, we often use the word would (underline the word would in the question). Apostrophe’d is the abbreviation of the word would ( underline the abbreviation ‘d in the answers).
Then underline the word were in the two statements. Say, When you tell someone what you would do, you use the expression if I were you. Get all the students to read the target language on the blackboard.
Pronunciation note
When saying the words would you in phrases such as what would you do…,
English speakers often run the words together and pronounce these words as if they were spelled wudjuh.
Step Ⅵ Summary
Say, In this class, we’ve learned the target language I’d give it to charities and If I were you, I’d wear a shirt and tie. And we’ve also done much listening practice using the target language.
Step Ⅶ Homework
Say, If your teacher criticized you, but in fact it isn’t your fault, what would you do? Get students to make a list.
StepⅧ Blackboard Design
Unit 4 What would you do?
Section A
The Second Period
Target language:
A: What would you do if you won a million dollars?
B: I’d give it to charities.
A: If I were you, I’d wear a shirt and tie.
B: If I were you, I’d take an umbrella.
A: What would you do if you were in a lion’s cage?
B: I’d call for help.
C. I’d get out fast.
Unit 4 what would you do 教案示例(3)
Ⅰ. Teaching Aims and Demands
1.Knowledge Objects
(1) Key Vocabulary
pimple, trouble
(2) Target Language
I can’t sleep the night before an exam.
Then I’m too tired to do well. What should I do?
If I were you, I’d take a long walk before going to bed.
I really want a dog, but my parents won’t let me have one.
Well, dogs can be a lot of trouble. Maybe you should get a small pet, like a goldfish.
That’s a good idea.
2. Ability Objects
(1) Train students’ reading skills.
(2) Train students’ integrating skills.
3. Moral Object
Everyone may have some trouble. Don’t worry.
Ⅱ. Teaching Key Point
1. Reading
2. Target language
Ⅲ. Teaching Difficult Point
Give advice using the target language.
Ⅳ. Teaching Methods
1. Reading Practice
2. Pairwork
Ⅴ. Teaching Aid
The blackboard
Ⅵ. Teaching Procedures
Step Ⅰ Revision
Check homework. Get students to talk about what they would do if a teacher criticized them. For example, a student might say I’d explain to the teacher and so forth.
Step Ⅱ 3a
This activity provides reading practice using the target language. Point to the problems on the left. Ask different students to read them to the class.
Point out the pieces of advice on the right. Get different students to read them to the class.
Point out the sample answer. Invite a pair of students to read the problem and the piece of advice to the class.
SA: I’m really shy and I just don’t enjoy parties. I don’t know what to say or do.
Ss: If I were you, I’d talk to someone who looks friendly. Then you won’t feel so shy.
Say, Please match each problem on the left with the correct advice on the right.
Get students to complete the activity on their own. As they work individually, move around the room answering any questions students raise and offering help as needed.
Check the answers.
Answers
1. c 2. a 3. b
Step Ⅲ 3b
This activity provides oral practice using the target language.
Read the instructions to the class. Invite a pair of students to read the sample conversation.
SA:I can’t sleep the night before an exam. Then I’m too tired to do well.
What should I do?
SB: If I were you, I’d take a long walk before going to bed. That should help you relax.
Say, Please think of different advice for the problems in Activity 3a.
Collect suggestions from students. For example, for the third problem, a student might say, If I were you, I’d watch TV to relax my mind.
Ask students to make conversations with partners using new suggestions to each problem. As they work in pairs, walk around the room offering language support as needed.
After each student has a chance to play both parts, stop the activity. Get several pairs of students to say their conversations.
Step Ⅳ Part 4
This activity provides writing, listening and speaking practice using the target
language.
Read the instructions to the class. Get a pair of students to say the sample conversation to the class.
SA:I really want a dog, but my parents won’t let me have one.
SB:Well, dogs can be a lot of trouble.
Maybe you should get a small pet, like a goldfish.
SA:That’s a good idea.
Write the conversation on the blackboard.
Point out the sample answers in the chart.
Say, What problems do you have at home? At school? Make a list in the chart. Then ask your classmates for advice and write their advice in the chart too.
Get students to complete the activity in groups of four. As the groups work together, move around the room to make sure students discuss the topic in English and know how to fill in the chart.
Check the answers by asking different pairs of students to say their conversations to the class.
Answers will vary.
Optional activity
Ask, What would you do if there were no classes tomorrow? Ask students to write as many answers as they can. Then get students to work in pairs. One ask the other the question and see how many new answers the other is able to think of.
Step Ⅴ Summary
Say, In this class, we’ve done a lot of reading, speaking and writing practice using the target language.
Step Ⅵ Homework
(1) Review the target language by reading the conversations in Activity 3a.
(2)Finish off the exercises on pages 11~12 of the workbook.
Step Ⅶ Blackboard Design
Unit 4 What would you do?
Section A
The Third Period
Target language:
A:I can’t sleep the night before an exam. Then I’m too tired to do well.
What should I do?
B: If I were you, I’d take a long walk before going to bed. That should help you relax
A:I really want a dog, but my parents won’t let me have one.
B: Well, dogs can be a lot of trouble.
Maybe you should get a small pet, like a goldfish.
A: That’s a good idea.
九年级英语上册教案【篇15】
一、重点短语
1. 处于困境 in trouble
2. 比如 for example3. 和……比较 compare... with...4. 吵闹;喧哗 make a noise5. 隔壁;相邻 next to6. 用……填充…… fill...with7. 期待 look forward to8. 不仅……而且 as well as 9. 注意 pay attention to10. 发现;查明 find out11. 得知 learn about 12. 所有年龄段的 of all ages13. 全世界 in the whole world
二、重点句型1. It’s against ... 这是违反……
2. That’s no good. 那样不好。3. No wonder ... 难怪……
三、重点语法if 从句 1:if 从句 + 祈使句
1. 结构:“if 从句 + 祈使句”意为“如果……,就 / 要……”。
2. 用法:① “if从句+祈使句”结构中,if引导的从句可以放在主句之前,也可以放在主句之后。② if 从句在前时,主从句之间必须用逗号隔开。③ 主句是祈使句,if 从句要用一般现在时。例如:If you want to leave, drive slowly. 如果你想走,慢点开车。Stay at home if it rains. = If it rains, stay athome. 如果下雨,你就待在家。
表示禁止的结构1. “No + 名词 / 动名词!”句型常用于公共场合的提示语,意为“禁止……,不准……”。例如:No smoking! 禁止吸烟!No burning!禁止烟火!2. Don’t + 动词原形.例如:Don’t jump. 不准蹦跳。
人教版五年级英语上册课件十五篇
老师会对课本中的主要教学内容整理到教案课件中,所以老师写教案可不能随便对待。教案是评估学生学习效果的有效依据,好的教案课件是怎么写成的?我们听了一场关于“人教版五年级英语上册课件”的演讲让我们思考了很多,经过阅读本页你的认识会更加全面!
人教版五年级英语上册课件 篇1
一.教学内容 A. Let’sspell B. Let’s wrap it up
二.课时目标
1. 通过大量的听读操练,掌握双元音/əʊ/和/au/在单词中的发音,能读准“Let’s spell”部分的例词,并完成本部分的听力任务。
2. 简单了解单数可数名词变成复数的规则。
3. 纠正学生错误的发音,引导学生自主总结发音规律。
4. 逐步培养学生学习英语语音知识的兴趣,提高学生的听力能力。
5. 创设良好的英语学习氛围,激发学生学习英语的热情。
三.教学重难点
重点:
1. 通过大量的听读操练,掌握双元音/əʊ/和/au/在单词中的发音,能读准“Let’s spell”部分的例词,并完成本部分的听力任务。
2. 简单了解单数可数名词变成复数的规则。
难点:
1. 引导学生自主总结发音规律,激发学习英语语音知识的兴趣。
2. 双元音/əʊ/和/au/的发音对比。
四.教学准备
录音机、录音带、词卡。
五.教学过程
Step.1.Warm-up
1. Free talk
T: Good morning,everyone.
Ss: Good morning,teacher.
T: How are youtoday?
Ss: Fine, thankyou. And you?
T: I’m fine, too.
2. 先让学生在四人小组内介绍自己家人最喜欢的食物,如“My father’sfavourite food is fish and his favourite drink is tea. What’s my mother’sfavourite food and drink? Noodles and orange.”,然后教师请三位小组代表向全班同学介绍。
Step.2.Preview
玩游戏:剪刀、石头、布(Rock, Scissors and Cloth)
规则:学生小组合作,玩“剪刀、石头、布”游戏,要求输的一方说出一种食物的英文名称,说不出的人被淘汰,最后剩下的一位同学是获胜者。
Step.3.Presentation
A. Let’s spell
1. Read, listenand chant
(1) 教师在黑板上用简笔画画出一只奶牛,说:“Look, this is a cow.”,然后在奶牛旁边画出一些花,说:“There are some flowers. Wow! They’re so beautiful.”,最后在旁边画一个坐着的小男孩,说:“The boy loves to see the cow and the flowers. He sitsdown and enjoys them.”
(2) 教师画一间房子,墙面上有一扇开着的窗户,房子外面有一棵树,树上没有树叶,树下面堆积着黄色的树叶,树干上趴着一只蜗牛,天上飘着雪花,然后教师说:“Look at the blackboard. Some leaves are onthe ground. The snow is falling down. It’s cold.Close the window, please. Oh, the snail is slow. When can it go home?”。
(3) 教师把本部分的两组例词写在黑板上。
cow flower wow down
slow snow yellow window
(4) 教师带领全班学生读几遍,引导学生发现,第一组单词中的字母组合ow都发/au/,第二组单词中的字母组合ow都发/əʊ/。
(5) 播放本部分的教学录音,全班跟着录音读,提醒学生在跟读时要注意模仿录音中的发音,尽量做到读准元音字母的发音。
2. Listen, numberand say
(1) 学生自己读一读本部分的四组单词。
(2) 播放本部分的教学录音,学生根据录音内容圈出答案。
(3) 再次播放教学录音,师生一起核对答案。
(4) 第三次播放录音,全班学生跟着录音读。
3. Listen, writeand say
(1) 教师先让学生观察图片,然后播放教学录音,全班学生根据录音内容填空。
(2) 再次播放教学录音,师生一起核对答案。
(3) 让学生选择自己喜欢的一句话,并把其在四线三格中抄写两遍。
Step.nsolidation
1. B. Let’s wrap it up
(1) 教师用多媒体课件出示一只香蕉的图片,说:“This is one banana.”,再出示两只香蕉的图片,说:“They’re twobananas.”。
(2) 教师用多媒体课件出示一个三文治的图片,说:“This is one sandwich.”,再出示两个三文治的图片,说:“They’re two sandwiches.”。
(3) 教师将上面四个句子写在黑板上。
This is onebanana. They’re two bananas.
This is one sandwich. They’re two sandwiches.
(4) 教师讲解:把可数名词单数变成复数是,一般来说是直接在单词后记加“-s”,如果单词以-s, -sh, -ch, -x结尾,则在单词后面加“-es”。(可数名词单数变复数的规则不止这两项,此处如果把所有规则都呈现出来的话,学生不容易记住,学习兴趣也会大打折扣)
(5) 学生填写表格,师生一起核对答案。
2. 课堂练习——把下列句子重新排序,组成意思完整的对话:
( ) We havetofu, fish and rice.
( ) Yourschool meals are yummy.
( ) Look atour school menu.
( ) What doyou have for lunch on Mondays?
( ) Thankyou.
3. Check the answer: 3 4 2 1 5
Step.5.Summary
1. 师生一起总结本节课学习的词汇和句型。
2. 鼓励学生在日常英语学习中注意单词的发音,要发准音、多模仿。
Step.6.Homework
1. 听录音,跟读Let’s spell部分内容。
2. 预习下节课的内容。
六.板书设计
Unit three What would you like?
This is one banana. They’retwo bananas.
This is one sandwich. They’retwo sandwiches.
七.教学反思
人教版五年级英语上册课件 篇2
一、教材简况
本套英语教材由陕西旅游出版社出版,是教育部审定的义务教育教科书。根据教育部颁布的《全日制义务教育普通高级中学英语课程标准(实验稿)》规定的小学毕业应达到二级水平的要求精心编写的。本教材供五年级使用。
本套教材吸取了最先进的外语教学理念和经验,从学生的学习兴趣、生活经验和认知水平出发,通过体验、实践、参与、合作与交流等学习方式,发展学生的综合语言运用能力,具有较强的科学性。教材围绕最常用、最基本的英语词汇、句型和会话等编写,好教易学,具有较强的活动性和趣味性。
本教材根据小学生的年龄、心理特点和生活实践编写,同时注重激发和培养学生的学习语言的兴趣和信心。有了兴趣和信心,学生们就有了积极进取的学习态度。在本套教材中,提供了大量的生活情景,目的就是同学们可以在听听,做做,说说,玩玩,演演中学习单词,说句子,然后再将所学知识积极地运用到生活中去。通过本教材的学习,一定能为将来的学习打下良好的基础。
本套教材中,我们设计了很多很实用的会话、有趣的游戏活动和故事、好听的歌曲和歌谣,并配上了精美的图画。还有调皮的小精灵们会为大家的英语学习带来更多欢乐。这些都会有利于培养学生的学习兴趣。 二、学生状况
1.少数学生对英语有兴趣,口语运用自如、熟练。 2.大部分学生对英语学习有很大的自信心。
3.由于社会因素和家庭条件的影响,学生学习英语的环境不够理想。 三、教学重点
1.教材共有8单元,每单元中都有要求学生熟记的单词和句型操练,力求在教学中熟练掌握。
2.听、说练习贯穿了整个教材,激发了孩子们在玩中听、说英语,是教材与教者共同始终追求的目标。 四、教学难度
1.对单词和短语的熟记和完全掌握。 2.每个单元中出现的重点句型会说会用。
3.在学习过程中了解中西方文化的差异,大胆运用英语相互交流,进行简单对话。
4.激发学生的学习兴趣,加强学生听、说、读、写等基本技能。
1 / 28
教学总目标及任务
第一单元
How Are You Feeling Now? 学习“四会”单词:feel happy, feel sad, feel tried, feel angry, go out to play, make a snowman.并用所学单词和句型描述自己或他人的感受。
第二单元Spring is Coming! 学习“四会”单词:spring, summer, autumn, winter, season, plant trees, ride a bike.重点句型:What do you do in spring? I often .... Sometimes we ....
第三单元 Spring Begins from March.学习“四会”单词:January, February, June, July, August, September, October, November, December, 并用这些单词描述每个月份。
第四单元 He Lives in a Village.学习“四会”单词:bird, snake, potato, tomato, river, lake, village, 并用这些单词描述乡村的特色。
第五单元What’s the Weather Like Today? 学习“四会”单词:weather report, sunny, windy, cloudy, rainy, snowy, moon, star.并用所学单词描述天气。
第六单元 My Holiday.学习“四会”单词:travel, enjoy the visit, place of interest, the Palace Museum, the Great Wall, the West Lake.用所学单词描述在假期中旅行的各地的名胜古迹。
第七单元 I Have a Headache.学习“四会”单词:have a cold, have a cough, have a fever, have a headache, hace a toothache, have a stomachache, see a docotr.用所学短语描述自己的身体状况。
第八单元 Have a Good Habit! 学习“四会”单词:litter on the floor, talk loudly in cla, speak with mouth full, make a noise, keep quiet, wait in line.并用所学单词描述自己平时习惯。
2 / 28 Unit1 How Are You Feeling Now?
第一课时
教学目标:学习“四会”单词:feel happy, feel sad, feel tried, feel angry, go out to play, make a snowman.用所学单词和句型描述自己或他人的感受。 教学重点:能听懂、会写、会读、会说feel happy, feel sad, feel tried, feel angry, go out to play, make a snowman。
教学难点:通过学习,能够用英语指出自己的感受。 教法:高效课堂教学模式 学法:自主探究
合作交流 教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 教学环节: ? 学习目标
(一)出示学习目标:学习“四会”单词:feel happy, feel sad, feel tried, feel angry, go out to play, make a snowman.用所学单词和句型描述自己或他人的感受。
(二)学习 How are you feeling now? I’m ...句型并学会如何表达。 ? 自主学习
(一) 温故知新
同桌讨论并写出学过的表示感受的形容词。 (二)阅读方法
对照课本第二页,边看边练习拼写描述感受的单词。 (三)互助释疑
同桌间一边做出各种表情,一边读出单词,交流不会读的单词。 (四)探究出招
同桌间练习书写,可以互相检查拼写。 展示交流
(一)小组展示
小组内练习用英语描述感受 (二)班级展示
指名小组上讲台做游戏,用英语描述自己或者他人的感受。
第二课时
教学目标:
1、学习主系表结构的句型:
主+系+表,即:人称+am/is/are+形容词
2、句型学习 How are you feeling now? I’m ... 教学重点:熟练掌握句型,并进行简单的对话。
教学难点:学会句型替换,灵活运用主系表结构的句型进行对话。
3 / 28 ?
教法:高效课堂教学模式
学法:自主探究
合作交流 教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 教学环节: ? 学习目标 ? (一)学习本课句型,并进行替换练习。
(二)进行重读练习。 ? 自主学习 ? (一)温故知新
Look and write (二)阅读方法
自主读句子,理解句子意思。 (三)互助释疑
同桌间交流句子意思。
(四)探究出招
模仿例句造句,小组内交流,纠正错误。 展示交流 班级展示
指名学生上台读句子,全班交流。
第三课时
教学目标:
一.学习重点句型 It makes me/her/him/them/us ...二.Are you tried/Is he sad?
教学重点:能熟练掌握句型:It makes me/her/him/them/us ...
Are you tried/Is he sad? 教学难点:对所学句型的灵活应用 教法:高效课堂教学模式 学法:自主探究
合作交流 教具准备:小黑板
录音机 教学环节: ? 学习目标
一.学习重点句型 It makes me/her/him/them/us ...二.Are you tried/Is he sad? ? 自主学习 ? (一)温故知新
完成Let’s learn more 学习。 (二)阅读方法
4 / 28 ? 对照课本第4页,练习主系表结构的句型,并读懂对话。 (三)互助释疑
同桌间读对话,理解对话内容并掌握句型,This makes ...(四)探究出招
小组合作用It makes me/her/him/them/us ...造句。 展示交流
(一)小组展示
小组内练习本课重点句型。 (二)班级展示
自主阅读 Read a story 的对话并在讲台上展示对话。
第四课时
教学目标:
能在教师的引导下学习和掌握read the words 语言部分总结归纳字母ar, er 的发音。 教学重点:
学习和掌握read the words 语言部分总结归纳字母ar, er 的发音。 教学难点:能在教师的引导下学习和掌握read the words 语言部分总结归纳字母ar, er 的读音规则。 教学方法:高效课堂模式。
学习方法:自主学习,合作探究 教学准备:
1.教师准备: (1) 录音磁带。 (2)单词卡片。
2、学生准备
单词卡片 教学环节: ? 学习目标
能在教师的引导下学习和掌握read the words 语言部分总结归纳字母ar, ? er 的发音。 自主学习
(一)温故知新 Part B Let’s play (二) 阅读方法
同桌相互读单词,并找出ar 和er 在单词中的发音。 (三)互助释疑
小组内交流单词的发音。
5 / 28 ? ? 展示交流
班级展示
1.请同学上台表演Let’s play 。
2.开火车读 Read the words 当中的单词。
Unit2 Spring is coming!
第一课时
教学目标:
学习四季的单词:spring,summer,autumn,winter,season以及动词短语plant trees,ride a bike,并用简单句型描述四季。 教学重点:
能听懂、会写、会读、会说:spring,summer, autumn, winter, season 以及动词短语plant trees,ride a bike, 教学难点:通过学习,能够简单句型描述四季。 教法:高效课堂教学模式 学法:自主探究
合作交流
教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节: ? 学习目标
一) 出示学习目标:学习“四会”单词:spring,summer,autumn,winter,season以及动词短语plant trees,ride a bike ,二)并用简单句型描述四季。 ? 自主学习
一)温故知新
复习以前学过的描述天气单词以及句型 二)阅读方法
自学单词,做到会读,会拼,会写,不会的画出来。 三)互助释疑
同桌间或小组内轮流读单词,探讨单词的读音和写法。 四)探究出招
同桌间练习书写,可以互相检查拼写。 ? 展示交流 一)小组展示
小组内练习用以前学过的描述天气的单词和句型描述四季。 二)班级展示
小组上讲台做表演,通过表演练习介绍单词,并用描述四季天气。
6 / 28
第二课时
教学目标: 学习句型:What do you do in spring?I often ...\Sometime we ...并灵活应用句型。熟悉对话内容。
教学重点:能用问答句型Who is he/she? He/she is my … 进行简单对话。 教学难点:灵活应用所学句型,表演对话。 教法:高效课堂教学模式 学法:自主探究
合作交流
教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节: ? 学习目标
一)What do you do in spring?I often ...\Sometime we ...二)学习 Part A Let’s talk 部分的对话,并且熟练掌握。 ? 自主学习 一)温故知新
Part C Listen and number.
听写上节课所学单词。 二)阅读方法
What do you do in spring?I often ...\Sometime we ...句型做对话。 三)互助释疑
同桌间相互交流,一问一答,练习所造句型。 四)探究出招
自主学习对话,了解对话内容。 ? 展示交流
班级展示
指名两人一问一答练习句型,用所学句型介绍自己或他人经常干的事情。
第三课时
教学目标:1.学习用简单的句型描述四季,体会一般现在时。
2.Part B Let’s learn more 的四个季节的描述,并完成Read again and answer the questions.
教学重点:学习用简单的句型描述四季,体会一般现在时。
教学难点:Part B Let’s learn more 的四个季节的描述,并完成Read again and answer the questions.教法:高效课堂教学模式 学法:自主探究
合作交流 教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节: ? 学习目标
7 / 28 1.学习用简单的句型描述四季,体会一般现在时。
2.Part B Let’s learn more 的四个季节的描述,并完成Read again and answer the questions. ? 自主学习 一)温故知新
Part C Look and answer.
利用上节课所学句型同桌相互问答。 二)阅读方法
Part B Let’s learn more 的四个季节的描述,并完成Read again and answer the questions. 三)互助释疑
同桌间相互交流,读懂四段话,并把不会的用横线画出。 四)探究出招
自主学习对话,了解对话内容。
第四课时
教学目标:
能在教师的引导下学习和掌握read the words 语言部分总结归纳字母ir, or 以及ur的发音。 教学重点:
学习和掌握read the words 语言部分总结归纳字母ir, or 以及ur 的发音。
教学难点:能在教师的引导下学习和掌握read the words 语言部分总结归纳字母ir, or 以及ur 的读音规则。 教学方法:高效课堂模式。
学习方法:自主学习,合作探究 教学准备:
1.教师准备: (1) 录音磁带。 (2)单词卡片。
2、学生准备
单词卡片 教学环节: ? 学习目标
能在教师的引导下学习和掌握read the words 语言部分总结归纳字母ir, ? or 以及ur的发音。 自主学习
(一)温故知新
8 / 28 Part B Let’s play (三) 阅读方法
同桌相互读单词,并找出ir, or 以及ur在单词中的发音。 (三)互助释疑
小组内交流单词的发音。
Unit3 Spring begin from march!
第一课时
教学目标:
学习月份的单词:January, February, June, July, August, September, October, November, December, 并用这些单词描述每个月份。 教学重点:
能听懂、会写、会读、会说:January, February, June, July, August, September, October, November, December。 教学难点:通过学习,能够用简单句型描述每个月份。 教法:高效课堂教学模式 学法:自主探究
合作交流
教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节:
? ? 学习目标
出示学习目标:学习“四会”单词:January, February, June, July, August, September, October, November, December 二)并用简单句型描述每个月份。 ? 自主学习
一)温故知新
复习以前学过的描述季节的单词以及句型。 二)阅读方法
自学单词,做到会读,会拼,会写,不会的画出来。 三)互助释疑
同桌间或小组内轮流读单词,探讨单词的读音和写法。 四)探究出招
同桌间练习书写,可以互相检查拼写。 ? 展示交流
一)Part A Read and answer How many months are there in a year?
How many months are in a season? Which months are in spring?
二)Part A Circle your birthday and the birthdays of your family.
9 / 28
第二课时
教学目标:(一) 用序数词表示每个月份的日期。 (二)学习句型:
1.Which is your favorite season/month ? My favorite season/month is ...2. Autumn begins from semtember here. 3. The treen become red. 4. Children’s day is on ...并灵活应用句型。熟悉对话内容。 教学重点:
(一) 用序数词表示每个月份的日期。 (二) 能用以下句型
1.Which is your favorite season/month ? My favorite season/month is ...2. Autumn begins from semtember here. 3. The treen become red.
4. Children’s day is on ...进行简单对话。
教学难点:灵活应用所学句型,表演对话。 教法:高效课堂教学模式 学法:自主探究
合作交流
教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节: ? 学习目标
(一) 用序数词表示每个月份的日期。 (二) 能用以下句型
1.Which is your favorite season/month ? My favorite season/month is ...2. Autumn begins from semtember here. 3. The treen become red. 4. Children’s day is on ...并灵活应用句型。 ? 自主学习 一)温故知新
1.1到100的基数词
2.用Which is your favorite season/month ? My favorite season/month is ...句型,同桌相互问答。 二)阅读方法
练习句型: Children’s day is on ...三)互助释疑
同桌间相互交流,一问一答,练习所造句型。
10 / 28 四)探究出招
自主学习对话,了解对话内容。 ? 展示交流
班级展示
指名两人一问一答练习句型,用所学句型介绍自己或他人喜欢的月份,并用简单的句型描述月份。
第三课时
教学目标:掌握下列句型
1.Each season has three months.1.Spring begains from match.2.Summer is form June to August.3.New Year is in the first month of the year.教学重点:灵活应用以上句型,并能熟练掌握Part B Let‘s learn more 当中的这段话。
教学难点:灵活应用以上句型,并能熟练掌握Part B Let‘s learn more 当中的这段话。
教法:高效课堂教学模式 学法:自主探究
合作交流
教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节:
? 学习目标 掌握下列句型
1.Each season has three months.2.Spring begains from match.3.Summer is form June to August.4.New Year is in the first month of the year.? 自主学习 一)温故知新
Part C Listen and tick.Part C Think and answer
What is this season?
Whicn is your favorite season?
What is this month?
Whicn is your favorite month?
When is the Children’s Day? When is New year’s Day? 二)阅读方法
完成 Part B Let’s learn more 的句子。
11 / 28 三)互助释疑
同桌间相互交流,读懂这段话,并把不会的用横线画出。 四)探究出招
自主学习对话,了解对话内容。 ? 展示交流
班级展示
上讲台,用简单的句型描述月份。
第四课时
教学目标:1.学唱Part B Let’chant 中的歌曲 《Merry May》
2.完成Part C Read and answer 教学重点:完成Part C Read and answer
教学难点:灵活运用本单元的句型,写一篇我最喜欢的月份的作文。 教法:高效课堂教学模式 学法:自主探究
合作交流
教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节: ? 学习目标
掌握下列句型
1.学唱Part B Let’chant 中的歌曲 《Merry May》 2.完成Part C Read and answer ? 自主学习 一)温故知新
1.Part C Think and write.2.复习所学的序数词.二)阅读方法
完成 Part C Read and answer 的句子。
三)互助释疑
同桌间相互交流,读懂这段话,并把不会的用横线画出。 四)探究出招
自主学习短文,了解短文内容。 ? 展示交流
班级展示,同桌之间大声朗读并翻译。
Unit4 He lives in a village
第一课时
教学目标:
学习四会单词:bird, snake, potato, tomato, river, lake, village, 并用这些单词描述乡村的特色。 教学重点:
12 / 28 能听懂、会写、会读、会说:bird, snake, potato, tomato, river, lake, village。
教学难点:通过学习,用这些单词描述乡村的特色。 教法:高效课堂教学模式 学法:自主探究
合作交流
教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节: ? 学习目标
一)出示学习目标:学习“四会”单词:bird, snake, potato, tomato, river, lake, village。
二)并用这些单词描述乡村的特色。 自主学习
一)温故知新
复习以前学过的动物类的单词。
二)阅读方法
自学单词,做到会读,会拼,会写,不会的画出来。 三)互助释疑
同桌间或小组内轮流读单词,探讨单词的读音和写法。 四)探究出招
同桌间练习书写,可以互相检查拼写。
第二课时
教学目标:学习重点句型:
1.Where do you live? I live in ...
2.Do you live in city? Yes, I do.No, I don’t.
3.Is your village big? Yes, it is.No, It isn’t.
并灵活应用句型。熟悉对话内容。 教学重点:掌握重点句型:
1.Where do you live? I live in ...
2.Do you live in city? Yes, I do.No, I don’t.
3.Is your village big? Yes, it is.No, It isn’t. 进行简单对话。
教学难点:灵活应用所学句型,表演对话。 教法:高效课堂教学模式 学法:自主探究
合作交流
教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节: ? 学习目标
学习重点句型:
13 / 28 1.Where do you live? I live in ...2.Do you live in city? Yes, I do.No, I don’t. 3.Is your village big? Yes, it is.No, It isn’t. 并灵活应用句型。熟悉对话内容。 ? 自主学习 一)温故知新
复习上节课所学单词。
用简单的句型描述自己的家乡。 二)阅读方法
掌握句型,能用简单的句型描述自己家乡的特色。 三)互助释疑
同桌间相互交流,阅读对话。 四)探究出招
自主学习对话,了解对话内容。
第三课时
教学目标:掌握下列句型, 领会划横线单词含义。
1.A river runs by.
2.They grow tomotoes.
3.Ther live happily together year after year.
教学重点:灵活应用以上句型,并能熟练掌握Part B Let‘s learn more 当中的两段话。
教学难点:灵活应用以上句型,并能熟练掌握Part B Let‘s learn more 当中的两段话。
教法:高效课堂教学模式 学法:自主探究
合作交流
教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节: ? 学习目标
掌握下列句型, 领会划横线单词含义。 1.A river runs by. 2.They grow tomotoes.
3.Ther live happily together year after year. ? 自主学习 一)温故知新
Part C Ask and answer, then report.
Where do you live? Is it big/small/beautiful? Is there a river/lake?
14 / 28 What’s in the city/village? Do you love it? How can I get there? 二)阅读方法
完成 Part B Let’s learn more 的句子。
三)互助释疑
同桌间相互交流,读懂这段话,并把不会的用横线画出。 四)探究出招
自主学习对话,了解对话内容。 ? 展示交流
班级展示 上讲台,用简单的句型描述自己或他人的家乡。
第四课时
教学目标: 1.Look at the pictures and order the story.2.独立完成Part C Read and number 和 read and complete.教学重点:1.Look at the pictures and order the story.2.独立完成Part C Read and number 和 read and complete.教学难点:读懂故事情节,熟悉陌生单词,独立完成Part C 的两个练习。 教法:高效课堂教学模式 学法:自主探究
合作交流
教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节: ? 学习目标
1.Look at the pictures and order the story.2.独立完成Part C Read and number 和 read and complete.? 自主学习 一)温故知新
Part C Read and number.二)阅读方法
根据图片,读懂故事。 三)互助释疑
同桌间相互交流,读懂故事,并把不会的用横线画出。 四)探究出招
自主学习对话,了解对话内容。 ? 展示交流
班级展示
上讲台,用简单的句型描述自己或他人的家乡。
Unit5 What is the weather like today?
15 / 28
第一课时
教学目标:
学习描述天气的形容词: report,sunny,windy,cloudy,rainy,snowy,以及名词weather ,moon,star.教学重点:
能听懂、会写、会读、会说描述天气的形容词:report,sunny,windy,cloudy,rainy,snowy,以及名词weather ,moon,star.教学难点:通过学习,能够用简单句型描述天气状况。 教法:高效课堂教学模式 学法:自主探究
合作交流
教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节: ? 学习目标
出示学习目标:学习“四会”单词:report,sunny,windy,cloudy,rainy,snowy,weather ,moon,star.一) ,二)并用简单句型描述天气。 ? 自主学习
一)温故知新
复习以前学过的描述天气单词以及句型 二)阅读方法 自学单词,做到会读,会拼,会写,不会的画出来。 三)互助释疑
同桌间或小组内轮流读单词,探讨单词的读音和写法。 四)探究出招
同桌间练习书写,可以互相检查拼写。 ? 展示交流 一)小组展示
小组内练习用以前学过的描述天气的单词和句型描述天气。 二)班级展示
小组上讲台做表演,通过表演练习介绍单词。
第二课时
教学目标: 学习问天气的句型What`s the weather like today? It`s...并灵活应用句型。熟悉对话内容。
教学重点:能用问天气的句型What`s the weather like today? It`s...进行简单对话。
教学难点:灵活应用所学句型,表演对话。 教法:高效课堂教学模式 学法:自主探究
合作交流
16 / 28 教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节: ? 学习目标
一)What`s the weather like today? It`s...二)学习 Part A Let’s talk 部分的对话,并且熟练掌握。 ? 自主学习 一)温故知新
Part A Look and circle.
听写上节课所学单词。 二)阅读方法
What`s the weather like today? It`s...句型做对话。 三)互助释疑
同桌间相互交流,一问一答,练习所造句型。 四)探究出招
自主学习对话,了解对话内容。 ? 展示交流
班级展示
指名两人一问一答练习句型,用所学句型相互问答。
第三课时
教学目标:
1,学习问天气的句型How is the weather in ...today? It`s...并灵活应用句型。熟悉对话内容。
2,一般将来式的运用。
教学重点:能用问天气的句型What`s the weather like today? It`s.../ How is the weather in ...today? It`s...进行简单对话。 教学难点:
1,灵活应用所学句型,表演对话。 2,一般将来式的运用。 教法:高效课堂教学模式 学法:自主探究
合作交流
教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节: ? 学习目标
一)What`s the weather like today? It`s.../How is the weather in ...today? It`s...二)学习 Part B Let’s learn 部分的对话,并且熟练掌握。 ? 自主学习 一)温故知新
17 / 28 Part A Look and circle. What`s the weather like today? It`s... 二)阅读方法
What`s the weather like today? It`s.../How is the weather in ...today? It`s...句型做对话。 体会一般将来时。 三)互助释疑
同桌间相互交流,一问一答,练习所造句型。 四)探究出招
自主学习对话,了解对话内容。 ? 展示交流
班级展示
1,指名两人一问一答练习句型,用所学句型相互问答。 2,相互交流一般将来时的构成以及用法。
3,PartC listen and tick.和 PartC match and say.
第四课时
教学目标:
1, 能在教师的引导下学习和掌握read the words 语言部分总结归纳字母ch和sh的发音。
2, PartC Read and answer.教学重点:
学习和掌握read the words 语言部分总结归纳字母ch和sh的发音。 教学难点:能在教师的引导下学习和掌握read the words 语言部分总结归纳字母ch和sh在单词中的发音。 教学方法:高效课堂模式。
学习方法:自主学习,合作探究 教学准备:
1.教师准备: (1) 录音磁带。 (2)单词卡片。
2、学生准备
单词卡片 教学环节: ? 学习目标
能在教师的引导下学习和掌握read the words 语言部分总结归纳字母ir, ? or 以及ur的发音。 自主学习
(一)温故知新
18 / 28 Part B Let’s sing.一起跟唱歌曲。
(四) 阅读方法
同桌相互读单词,并找出ch和sh在单词中的发音。 (三)互助释疑
小组内交流单词的发音。 ? 展示交流(10分钟)
班级展示
开火车读 Read the words 当中的单词。
Unit6 My Holiday
第一课时
教学目标:
1,学习”四会”单词: travel, enjoy the visit, place of intrerest, the Palace Museum, the Great Wall, the West Lake.2,了解一般将来时。
教学重点:
能听懂、会写、会读、会说:
travel, enjoy the visit, place of intrerest, the Palace Museum, the Great Wall, the West Lake.教学难点:了解一般将来时。 教法:高效课堂教学模式
学法:自主探究
合作交流
教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节: ? 学习目标
出示学习目标:学习“四会”单词:
travel, enjoy the visit, place of intrerest, the Palace Museum, the Great Wall, the West Lake.? 自主学习
一) 温故知新
师生问答:ParkA:Think and answer 1,What are you doing to do this evening? 2,What is your father going to do tomorrow morning? 3,What is your grandma go to do next Sunday? 4,What is your friend going to do next week? 二)阅读方法
自学单词,做到会读,会拼,会写,不会的画出来。 三)互助释疑
同桌间或小组内轮流读单词,探讨单词的读音和写法。
19 / 28 四)探究出招
同桌间练习书写,可以互相检查拼写。 ? 展示交流
一) 小组展示:相互读写单词 二)班级展示
小组上讲台做表演,通过表演练习介绍单词。
第二课时
教学目标:1,学习一般将来时的用法以及构成。
2,学习句型:Where will you go on the holiday? I will go to...教学重点:1,学习一般将来时的用法以及构成。
2,学习句型:Where will you go on the holiday? I will go to...教学难点:般将来时的用法以及构成的掌握。 教法:高效课堂教学模式 学法:自主探究
合作交流
教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节: ? 学习目标
一)Where will you go on the holiday? I will go to...二)学习 Part A Let’s talk 部分的对话,并且熟练掌握。 ? 自主学习 一)温故知新
1,相互问答:Part A Think and answer.
2,听写上节课所学单词。 二)阅读方法
Where will you go on the holiday? I will go to...句型做对话。 三)互助释疑
同桌间相互交流,一问一答,练习所造句型。 四)探究出招
自主学习对话,了解对话内容。 ? 展示交流 班级展示
指名两人一问一答练习句型,用所学句型相互问答。
第三课时
教学目标:1,学习一般将来时的用法以及构成。
2, 学习句型: 1) 2) 3) What will you do on the holiday? I will +动词原形...How will you go? I will +动词原形...Will your parents go with you? Yes, they will.\No, they won`t.
20 / 28 教学重点:1,学习一般将来时的用法以及构成。
2,学习句型:
1),What will you do on the holiday? I will +动词原形...2),How will you go? I will +动词原形...3),Will your parents go with you? Yes, they will.\No, they won’t.教学难点:一般将来时态的一般疑问句。 教法:高效课堂教学模式 学法:自主探究
合作交流
教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节: ? 学习目标
1,学习一般将来时的用法以及构成。
2,学习句型:
1),What will you do on the holiday? I will +动词原形...2),How will you go? I will +动词原形...3),Will your parents go with you? Yes, they will.\No, they won’t.? 自主学习 一)温故知新
相互问答:Part C Listne and Write.二)阅读方法
1),What will you do on the holiday? I will +动词原形...2),How will you go? I will +动词原形...3),Will your parents go with you? Yes, they will.\No, they won’t.三)互助释疑
同桌间相互交流,一问一答,练习所造句型。 四)探究出招
自主学习对话,Part B Let’s learn more, 了解对话内容。 ? 展示交流(8分钟)
班级展示
指名两人一问一答练习句型,用所学句型相互问答。 第四课时
教学目标:1,独立学习对话并在小组内完成对话Part B Look and talk。
2.小组内完成Part B Read and Report.3.学唱歌曲《Su Will Go》
教学重点:1,独立学习对话并在小组内完成对话Part B Look and talk。 2.小组内完成Part B Read and Report.3.学唱歌曲《Su Will Go》
教学难点:般将来时的用法以及构成的掌握。
21 / 28 教法:高效课堂教学模式
学法:自主探究
合作交流
教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节: ? 学习目标
1,独立学习对话并在小组内完成对话Part B Look and talk。 2.小组内完成Part B Read and Report.3.学唱歌曲《Su Will Go》 ? 自主学习 一)温故知新
Part B Look and Talk.二)阅读方法
通过对话进一步掌握一般将来时态的用法和构成。 三)互助释疑
Part B Let’s sing 认读歌词,了解歌词大意。 四)探究出招
PartB: Read and report.? 展示交流 ? 小组内交流,全班展示:Part B: Read and report.
Unit7 I Have Headache
第一课时
教学目标:
学习动词短语:Have a cold, Have a cough, Have a fever, Have a headache, Have a toothache, Have a stomachache, see a doctor, 并用这些短语描述病情症状。 教学重点:
能听懂、会写、会读、会说:Have a cold, Have a cough, Have a fever, Have a headache, Have a toothache, Have a stomachache, see a doctor。 教学难点:通过学习,用这些单词描述病情症状。 教法:高效课堂教学模式
学法:自主探究
合作交流
教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节: ? 学习目标
一)出示学习目标:学习“四会”短语:Have a cold, Have a cough, Have a fever, Have a headache, Have a toothache, Have a stomachache, see a doctor。
二)并用这些短语病情症状。
22 / 28 ? 自主学习
一)温故知新
复习以前学过的动词短语。 二)阅读方法
自学短语,做到会读,会拼,会写,不会的画出来。 三)互助释疑
同桌间或小组内轮流读单词,探讨单词的读音和写法。 四)探究出招
同桌间练习书写,可以互相检查拼写。 ? 展示交流
一) Part A Think and tick
Do you often go to see a doctor?
When do you go to see a doctor? 二)Part A Think and answer.
Do you want to be a doctor?
Why or why not?
第二课时
教学目标:1, I feel very bad today.
2,What’s wrong with you? I have a ...教学重点:1, I feel very bad today.
2,What’s wrong with you? I have a ...教学难点:灵活应用句型做对话。 教法:高效课堂教学模式 学法:自主探究
合作交流
教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节: ? 学习目标
1, I feel very bad today.2,What’s wrong with you? I have a ...? 自主学习 ? 一)温故知新 1 .默写单词 二)阅读方法
What’s wrong with you? I have a ...句型做对话。 三)互助释疑
读对话 Part A Let’s talk,划出陌生单词以及句子,相互交流。 四)探究出招
学唱歌曲,Part B Let’s chant
23 / 28 ? 展示交流
小组展示 Part C Ask and answer.指名两人一问一答练习句型,用所学句型相互问答。
第三课时
教学目标:1 学习句型:
Conlin doesn’t feel well this morning. I am sorry to hear that.You’d better take him to see a doctor.2.学习打电话用语。 教学重点:学习句型:
Conlin doesn’t feel well this morning. I am sorry to hear that.You’d better take him to see a doctor.教学难点:学习打电话用语。 教法:高效课堂教学模式 学法:自主探究
合作交流
教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节: ? 学习目标
学习打电话用语。
? 自主学习 一)温故知新
Part B Paly a game.二)阅读方法
学会打电话用语。 三)互助释疑
同桌间相互交流Part B Let’s learn more, 划出不懂的单词和句子。 四)探究出招
自主学习对话,Part B Let’s learn more, 了解对话内容。 ? 展示交流 班级展示
指名两人一问一答练习打电话用语。
第四课时
教学目标:
1.能在教师的引导下学习和掌握read the words 语言部分总结归纳字母th的发音。
2.Part B Try to read and more.教学重点:
24 / 28 能在教师的引导下学习和掌握read the words 语言部分总结归纳字母th的发音。
教学难点:Part B Try to read and more.
教学方法:高效课堂模式。
学习方法:自主学习,合作探究 教学准备:
1.教师准备: (1) 录音磁带。 (2)单词卡片。
2、学生准备
单词卡片 教学环节: ? 学习目标
能在教师的引导下学习和掌握read the words 语言部分总结归纳字母th的发音。 自主学习
(一)温故知新
Part B Let’s chant .一起说唱歌曲。 (五) 阅读方法 ?
同桌相互读单词,并找出th在单词中的发音。 (三)互助释疑
小组内交流单词的发音。 ? 展示交流
班级展示
开火车读 Read the words 当中的单词。
Unit 8
Have a good habit
第一课时
教学目标:
学习“四会”单词:litter on the floor, talk loudly in cla, speak with mouth full, make a noise, keep quiet, wait in line.并用所学单词描述自己或他人平时习惯。 教学重点:
能听懂、会写、会读、会说:litter on the floor, talk loudly in cla, speak with mouth full, make a noise, keep quiet, wait in line.教学难点:通过学习,用这些单词描述平时习惯行为。 教法:高效课堂教学模式 学法:自主探究
合作交流
25 / 28 教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节: ? 学习目标
能听懂、会写、会读、会说:litter on the floor, talk loudly in cla, speak with mouth full, make a noise, keep quiet, wait in line.并用这些短语描述平时习惯行为。
? 自主学习
一)温故知新
Part A Think and tick or cro.二)阅读方法
自学短语,做到会读,会拼,会写,不会的画出来。 三)互助释疑
同桌间或小组内轮流读单词,探讨单词的读音和写法。 四)探究出招
同桌间练习书写,可以互相检查拼写。 ? 展示交流
一) Part A Talk in pairs and group the pictures.
第二课时
教学目标:学习句型 1,Don’t littler on the floor.
2, You shouldn’t tell lies.
3, We’d better keep quiet.4, We should take care of trees.教学重点:1,Don’t littler on the floor.2, You shouldn’t tell lies.3, We’d better keep quiet.4, We should take care of trees.教学难点:灵活应用祈使句和情态动词should表达应该做某事和不应该做某事。 教法:高效课堂教学模式 学法:自主探究
合作交流
教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节: ? 学习目标
1,Don’t littler on the floor.2, You shouldn’t tell lies.3, We’d better keep quiet.4, We should take care of trees.? 自主学习 一)温故知新
26 / 28 1 .默写单词
二)阅读方法
用Don’t ...,You’d better ..., We should.. 和 We shouldn’t 句型做对话。 三)互助释疑
读对话 Part A Let’s talk,划出陌生单词以及句子,相互交流。 四)探究出招
学唱歌曲,Part B Let’s sing ? 展示交流
小组展示 Part C Discu in groups and give some advice.指名两人一问一答练习句型,用所学句型做对话。 第三课时
教学目标:1 学习句型:It’s bad for your eyes.2.进一步学习句型 : Don’t ...,You’d better ..., We should.. 和 We shouldn’t 教学重点:
1 学习句型:It’s bad for your eyes.2.进一步学习句型 : Don’t ...,You’d better ..., We should.. 和 We shouldn’t 教学难点:灵活应用本单元所学句型进行对话。
教法:高效课堂教学模式 学法:自主探究
合作交流
教具准备:小黑板
单词卡片 录音机 教学环节: ? 学习目标
进一步学习句型 : Don’t ...,You’d better ..., We should.. 和 We shouldn’t ? 自主学习 一)温故知新
Part B Let’s paly 二)阅读方法
应用本单元所学句型进行对话
Don’t ...,You’d better ..., We should.. 和 We shouldn’t 三)互助释疑
同桌间相互交流Part B Let’s learn more, 划出不懂的单词和句子。 四)探究出招
自主学习对话,Part B Let’s learn more, 了解对话内容。 ? 展示交流
27 / 28 班级展示
扮演角色进行对话。
第四课时
教学目标:1.Part B Read and think.
2.Part C Look and write your advice.教学重点:
1.Part B Read and think.
2.Part C Look and write your advice.教学难点:进一步学习句型 : Don’t ...,You’d better ..., We should.. 和 We shouldn’t 教学方法:高效课堂模式。 学习方法:自主学习,合作探究 教学准备:
1.教师准备: 录音磁带。
2、学生准备
配套练习册 教学环节: ? 学习目标
1.Part B Read and think.
2.Part C Look and write your advice.? 自主学习
(一)温故知新
Part B Let’s sing .一起说唱歌曲。 (六) 阅读方法
进一步学习句型 : Don’t ...,You’d better ..., We should.. 和 We shouldn’t (三)互助释疑
Part B Read and think.小组内相互讨论不会的单词和句子。 ? 展示交流
班级展示
分角色读对话
28 / 28
人教版五年级英语上册课件 篇3
Step5: Extension.( Talk about our travel.)
T: We all had a happy weekend. We went to lots of places and did many things. But I think in our holiday, we were happy too. Now look at this photo. This is me. Who can ask me some questions?
S1: Where did you go?
T: I went to Tianjin. Other questions?
S2: What did you do?
T: I visited my friend. You must have happy holiday too. Now 4 Ss a group. Ask and answer.
学生小组讨论。
选取小记者,随机提问班里的同学。
最后教师总结:You went to lots of places. Now let’s enjoy our class’s travel(教师课前收集学生旅游照,自制学生旅游视频)。 The world is a wonderful book and those who do not travel can see only a page of it.
Step6: Homework.
Describe your travel to your friends.
板书设计:
Unit1 Where did you go?
Daming: What did you do at the weekend?
Amy: We visited lots of places.
Daming: Where did you go?
Amy: We went to the British Museum, Big Ben and the London Eye.
人教版五年级英语上册课件 篇4
人教版语文五年级上册复习知识1
一、生字
洛杉(shān)矶 废墟(xū) 重砸(zá)
颤(chàn)抖 混(hùn)乱 血(xuè)迹
噪(zào)声 脊(jǐ)背 攥(zuàn)着钱
数(shǔ)落 塞(sāi)进 陷(xiàn)入
誊(ténɡ)写 歧(qí)途 谨(jǐn)慎
腼腆(tiǎn) 几(jī)乎 怔(zhènɡ)住
按图索骥(jì) 坠(zhuì)入 打蔫(niān)儿
艰涩(sè) 拖沓(tà)
二、多音字
混(hùn hún) 颤(chàn zhàn)
数(shǔ shù) 龟(guī jūn)
兴(xīng xìng) 觉(jué jiào)
发(fā fà) 埋(mán mái)
三、近义词
安顿 —— 安排 疾步——快步
昔日——往日 阻挡——阻拦
混乱——杂乱 悲痛——悲哀
失魂落魄——魂不守舍
瘦弱——瘦小
疲惫——疲倦 耽误——耽搁
数落——批评 忙碌——繁忙
兴奋——羞怯
敬仰——敬慕誊写——抄写
谨慎——小心赞扬——赞叹
残忍——残暴 磨炼——锻炼
喋喋不休——唠唠叨叨 埋怨——抱怨
毫无疑义——毫无疑问
四、反义词
坚定动摇 幸福痛苦漆黑明亮 伤害保护挖掘掩埋 漂亮丑陋瘦弱强壮 数落表扬忙碌悠闲歧途正路 鼓励批评兴奋沮丧 沉重轻松精彩糟糕 湿润干燥慈祥严厉 幸运倒霉腼腆大方 赞赏贬斥紧张松弛 谨慎粗心残忍仁慈 收缩膨胀冷漠热情忐忑不安镇定自若雪上加霜锦上添花喋喋不休不声不响
五、词语积累
【描写震后场景的词语】
满目疮痍废墟一片
惨不忍睹触目惊心
【表现母爱的词语】
孟母三迁 舐犊之情
含辛茹苦 任劳任怨
寸草春晖
【“一”字开头的词语】
一如既往 一表人才
一笔勾销 一刀两断
一唱一和 一箭双雕
【描写心理的词语】
忐忑不安 提心吊胆
心惊肉跳 心乱如麻
心急如焚
六、词语搭配
(绝望)地离开 (失落)地离开
(紧紧)地拥抱 (深情)地拥抱
(瘦弱)的脊背 (弯曲)的脊背
(龟裂)的手指 (修长)的手指
(呆呆)地扫视 (缓缓)地扫视
(慈祥)的母亲 (温柔)的母亲
(凶狠)的父亲 (严厉)的父亲
(认认真真)地誊写
(清清楚楚)地誊写
(滚烫)的手 (冰凉)的手
(忐忑不安)的心房
(隐隐作痛)的心房
(喋喋不休)地指教
(滔滔不绝)地指教
(深深)地谴责 (无声)地谴责
七、积累句型
第17课地震中的父与子
关联词:他猛地想起自己常对儿子说的一句话:“(不论)发生什么,我(总)会跟你在一起!”(条件关系)
第18课慈母情深
关联词:我本已不想说出?°要钱?±两个字,(可是)竟说出来了!(转折关系)
第19课“精彩极了”和“糟糕透了”
反问句:难道这世界上糟糕的诗还不够多吗?
第20课学会看病
1.比喻句:时间艰涩地流动着,像沙漏坠入我忐忑不安的心房。
2.关联词:(1)(既然)我是母亲,(就)应该及早教会他看病。
(因果关系)(2)(虽然)我知道看病是件费时间的事,(但)我的心还是疼痛地收缩成一团。(转折关系)
3.反问句:这样虽说可能留不下记忆的痕迹,但来日方长,又何必在意这病中的分分秒秒呢?
人教版语文五年级上册复习知识2一、生字
窃(qiè)读 腋(yè)下 贪婪(lán) 惧(jù)怕
饥肠辘辘(lùlù) 支撑(chēng) 踮(diǎn)起脚尖
依依(yīyī)不舍 水浒(hǔ)传 彭(péng)公案 侠(xá)士
伴侣(lǚ) 娱(yú)乐 毫不犹豫(yù) 一趟(tàng)
背诵(sòng) 比喻(yù) 门扉(fēi) 呐(nà)喊
上瘾(yǐn) 囫(hú)囵(lún) 莎(shā) 磁(cí)
锻(duàn) 鉴(jiàn) 呕(oǔ) 沥(lì)
二、多音字
转(zhuǎn zhuàn) 咽(yān yàn) 单(dānchán shàn)
传(chuán zhuàn) 绿(lǜ lù) 背(bēi bèi )
供(gōng gòng) 角(jiǎo jué) 模(mú mó)
乐(lè yuè)
三、近义词
担忧——担心 贪婪——贪心 惧怕——害怕 适宜——适合
喜欢——喜爱 困难——艰难 起码——至少 鼓励——激励
毫不犹豫——毫不迟疑 熟悉——熟识 品味——品尝
欣赏——观察 愉悦——喜悦 遭遇——遭受 悲惨——凄惨
领悟——领会
四、反义词
担忧——放心贪婪——知足 隐藏——公开 暂时——长久
喜欢——讨厌 困难——容易 起码——至多 鼓励——打击
毫不犹豫——犹豫不决 熟悉——陌生 欣赏——讨厌
愉悦——不快 悲惨——幸福 寂寞——热闹 模仿——独创
五、词语积累
绿林好汉 滚瓜烂熟 中西贯通 古今贯通 文理贯通
毫不犹豫 流光溢彩 呐喊助威 津津有味 天长日久
如醉如痴 浮想联翩 泪落如珠 囫囵吞枣 不求甚解
悲欢离合 牵肠挂肚 如饥似渴 不言而喻 花纹驳杂
黯然神伤 千篇一律 沉甸甸 天高气爽 云淡日丽
香飘四野 别出心裁 与众不同 大显身手 眼泪花花
真情实感 心安理得 念念不忘 呕心沥血
【与读书有关的词语】
学富五车 博古通今 满腹经纶 手不释卷 一目十行
【表示爱读书的词语】
如饥似渴 隔篱听讲 织帘诵书 挑灯苦读 圆木警枕
【带“书”字的词语】
知书达理 无巧不成书 书香门第
六、词语搭配
(花花绿绿)的书 (形形色色)的书 (急切)地寻找 (慌忙)地寻找
(贪婪)地读着 (快乐)地读着 (充足)的理由 (强大)的理由
(美丽)的图画 (毫不犹豫)地回答 (简单)的图画
(慌乱紧张)地回答 (沉甸甸)的果实 (香喷喷)的果实
(呕心沥血)的创造 (历尽艰辛)的创造
七、积累句型
第1课窃读记
1.比喻句:急忙打开书,一页,两页,我像一匹饿狼,贪婪地读着。
2.反问句:就像在屋檐下躲雨,你总不好意思赶我走吧。
第2课小苗与大树的对话
设问句:怎么办呢?我就放学以后不回家,偷偷藏在一个地方看闲书。
第3课走遍天下书为侣
比喻句:你喜爱的书就像一个朋友,就像你的家。
第4课我的“长生果”
比喻句:学校图书馆那丰富的图书又像磁石一样吸引着我。
人教版语文五年级上册复习知识3一、生字
鱼钩(gōu) 侧翼(yì) 纵(zònɡ)然啪啪(pā) 鱼鳃(sāi)
皎(jiǎo)洁嘴唇(chún)沮(jǔ)丧 诱(yòu)惑告诫(jiè)
践(jiàn)行鲈(lú)鱼 翕(xī)动 抉(jué)择粉黛(dài)
国宴(yàn) 缝纫(rèn)络绎(yì)不绝一亩(mǔ)尝(chánɡ)试
吩(fēn)咐(fù)茅(máo)舍榨(zhà)油石榴(liú)蔓(màn)延
葱茏(lónɡ)瞅(chǒu)见 雏(chú)形框(kuànɡ)架
嚓嚓(cā) 蜡(là)笔 嘀嗒(dā) 细腻(nì) 眼睑(jiǎn)
眼眸(móu) 咂(zā)舌 倾泻(xiè)
二、多音字
着(zháozhuó) 量(liángliàng)
挑(tiǎotiāo) 教(jiàojiāo)
几(jījǐ) 种(zhǒngzhòng)
答(dādá) 卷(juǎnjuàn)
扒(bāpá)
三、近义词
剧烈——激烈 沮丧 ——颓丧 抉择—— 选择
乞求——恳求 和蔼—— 温和 教导——教诲
垂头丧气——没精打采 络绎不绝——连续不断
大喜过望——喜出望外 居然——竟然
吩咐——嘱咐 爱慕—— 倾慕 开拓—— 开辟
舒适——舒服 细腻 ——细致
信赖——信任 淘气——顽皮
四、反义词
剧烈——轻微 筋疲力尽 ——精力充沛 沮丧 ——得意
熟练——生疏 和蔼 ——粗暴 推迟—— 提前
垂头丧气——得意扬扬 消失 ——出现 便宜—— 昂贵
爱慕——嫌弃 轻松 ——紧张 信赖——怀疑
淘气——乖巧 亲近——疏远
五、词语积累
【描写心情的词语】
迫不及待 心急如焚 忐忑不安
沾沾自喜 心花怒放
【形容不怕困难的词语】
锲而不舍 排除万难 百折不挠
知难而进 勇往直前 愚公移山
【形容人很多的词语】
络绎不绝 人山人海 水泄不通
门庭若市 比肩接踵 座无虚席
【描写食物的词语】
肥而不腻 香脆可口 咸甜适中
五味俱全 鲜美多汁
【描写鸟的词语】
莺歌燕舞 鸟语花香 羽毛未丰
倦鸟知还 呼朋引伴 成群结队
六、词语搭配
(皎洁)的月光 (柔和)的月光(月光如水)的夜晚(剧烈)地抖动 (轻微)地抖动 (高高)的塔顶 (尖尖)的塔顶 (星罗棋布)的村庄
(风景秀丽)的村庄(与众不同)的展览会(独一无二)的展览会
(鲜红嫩绿)的果实(香甜可口)的果实 (蓬松)的球(圆润)的球
(美好)的境界 (迷人)的境界
七、积累句型
第14课通往广场的路不止一条
关联词:(如果)你发现这条路不能到达目的地的话,(就)可以走另一条路试试。(假设关系)
比喻句:(1)我大喜过望,脚下仿佛踩着一朵幸福的云。
(2)从此,一条时装的河流,源源不断地从我的时装店里流了出来。
第16课珍珠鸟
比喻句:阳光从窗外射入,透过这里,吊兰那些无数指甲状的小叶,一半成了黑影,一半被照透,如同碧玉,斑斑驳驳,生意葱茏。
人教版语文五年级上册复习知识4一、生字
鲸(jīng)鱼 猪(zhū)肉 硬腭(è) 哺(bǔ)乳
过滤(lǜ) 肚(dù)子 肺(fèi)部 矮(ǎi)小
判(pàn)断 胎(tāi)生 胸鳍(qí) 驯(xùn)良
榛(zhēn)子 榉(jǔ)树 橡栗(lì) 矫(jiǎo)健
帽缨(yīng) 舵(duò)手 青苔(tái) 苔藓(xiǎn)
狭(xiá)窄 勉(miǎn)强 盗(dào)窃 嫌(xián)疑
夹(jiā)丝 安然无恙(yàng) 藕(ǒu)断丝连
粘(zhān)贴 噪(zào)音 废(fèi)水 勿(wù)动
尘埃(āi) 湿漉漉(lù) 日晕(yùn)
二、多音字
肚(dù dǔ) 应(yīng yìng) 强(qiáng qiǎng jiàng )
藏(cángzàng)横(hénɡ hènɡ) 扎(zā zhá zhā)
划(huá huà)调(diàotiáo) 处(chǔ chù)晕(yūnyùn)
三、近义词
凶猛——凶恶 锋利——锐利 特征——特点 宽敞——宽广
驯良——驯顺 机警——机灵 锐利——锋利 响亮——洪亮
陈列——陈设 坚硬——坚固 急促——短促 特殊——特别
讨厌——厌恶 柔和——温和
依附——依靠(依赖) 稳定——稳固
四、反义词
凶猛——温和 宽敞——狭窄 退化——进化 倾斜——笔直
敏捷——迟缓 强烈——柔和 干净——肮脏 躲藏——暴露
急促——缓慢 特殊——普通 清楚——模糊 凉爽——闷热
吸收——释放 削弱——加强 稳定——动荡 柔和——强烈
五、词语积累
面容清秀 闪闪发光 蛰伏不动 连蹦带跑
端端正正 光光溜溜 干干净净 安然无恙
藕断丝连 冬暖夏凉 无影无踪 庞然大物
气象万千 古往今来 晚霞朝晖 闲云迷雾
彩虹日晕 风调雨顺
【含动物名称的词语】
饿虎扑食 狗急跳墙 狼狈为奸投鼠忌器 动如脱兔
【带有两个动物名称的词语】
虎头蛇尾 龙争虎斗狐假虎威 鸡犬不宁兔死狐悲 龙飞凤舞
【含反义词的词语】
藕断丝连 大同小异 九死一生大喜大悲 口是心非山高水低
【描写自然现象的词语】
乌云密布 风雨交加 艳阳高照
暴风骤雨 烟消云散 云开雾散
六、词语搭配
(凶猛)地扑(锋利)的牙齿 (迅速)地扑(尖锐)的牙齿
(乖巧)的松鼠 (可爱)的松鼠 (温暖)的日光 (强烈)的日光
(清秀)的面容 (姣好)的面容 (坚硬)的玻璃 (干净)的玻璃
(炎热)的夏天 (干燥)的夏天 (严寒)的冬季 (飘雪)的冬季
(细小)的灰尘 (气象万千)的景色
(细微)的灰尘 (宏伟壮观)的景色
七、积累句型
第10课松鼠
关联词:
1.它们(虽然)有时也捕捉鸟雀,(却)不是肉食动物,常吃的是杏仁、榛子、榉实和橡粟。
(转折关系)2.(只要)有人触动一下松鼠所在的大树,它们(就)从树上的窝里跑出来躲到树枝底下,或者逃到别的树上去。
(条件关系)第11课新型玻璃
比喻句:噪音像一个来无影去无踪的“隐身人”,不像烟尘和废水那样可以集中起来处理。
第12课假如没有灰尘
关联词:灰尘是人人讨厌的东西,它有碍环境卫生,危害人类健康。(因此),古往今来,人们总是“时时勤拂拭,勿使染尘埃”。
人教版语文五年级上册复习知识5一、生字
落(luò)阳 榆(yú)树 花魂(hún)
湖畔(pàn) 帐(zhàng)篷 一缕(lǚ)幽香
幽(yōu)静 埋葬(zàng) 愁(chóu)眉苦脸
腮(sāi)红 甚(shèn)好 丝绸(chóu)
呜呜(wū) 称谓(wèi) 梳(shū)理
衰(shuāi)老 手绢(juàn) 华侨(qiáo)
箩(luó)筐 杭(háng)州 潺潺(chán)
婀(ē)娜(nuó)波光粼粼(lín) 干涸(hé)
点缀(zhuì) 螃(páng)蟹(xiè)
二、多音字
间(jiàn jiān) 还(huán hái) 更(ɡēnɡ ɡènɡ)
重(chónɡ zhònɡ) 分( fēn fèn) 抹(mā mǒ mò)
折(zhéshé zhē ) 盛(chéng shèng) 担(dān dàn)
和(hé hè huó)
三、近义词
分外——格外 训斥——斥责 稀罕——稀奇 眷恋——留恋
害怕——惧怕 仔细——细致 姿态——姿势 欣赏——观赏
担心——担忧 悦耳——动听 点缀——装点 自然——天然
浮现——显现
四、反义词
郑重——随便 凉飕飕——暖烘烘 爱惜——糟蹋
冰凉——火热 成熟——幼稚 完整——残缺 盛开——凋谢
提前——推迟 潮湿——干燥 清澈——浑浊 凉爽——炎热
柔软——坚硬
五、词语积累
漂泊他乡 葬身异国 能书善画 颇负盛名 顶天立地
低头折节 泪眼朦胧 灌溉田园 日出而作 日入而息
守望相助 风雪欺压 凉飕飕 层层叠叠 思绪万千
多灾多难 颠沛流离 脱口而出 郑重其事 刀枪火海
历尽坎坷 重重叠叠 勇敢慷慨 睡眼惺忪 忠厚善良
天高气爽 峰岱岗峦 无与伦比 走火入魔 心旷神怡
千变万化 百看不厌 星罗棋布
【描写梅花的词语】
冰肌玉骨 暗香疏影 傲霜斗雪 冰清玉洁 凌寒独放
【描写桂花的词语】
清香馥郁 沁人心脾 芳香醉人 丹桂飘香
【描写景色的词语】
草长莺飞 烟波浩渺 落英缤纷 繁花似锦 一泻千里
层峦叠嶂
六、词语搭配
(高贵)的梅花 (冷艳)的梅花 (轻轻)地抹净
(慢慢)地抹净 (晶莹)的泪珠 (冰凉)的泪珠
(新鲜)的桂花(美丽)的桂花 (纷纷)地落下
(悄悄)地落下 (清澈)的小溪(欢快)的小溪
(优美)的舞姿 (婀娜)的舞姿
七、积累句型
第6课梅花魂
反问句:孩子要管教好,这清白的梅花,是玷污得的吗?
第7课桂花雨
拟人句:桂花树的样子笨笨的,不像梅树那样有姿态。
第8课小桥流水人家
拟人句:夏天,凉爽的清风从南窗里吹进来,太舒服了!更美的是,我由东窗可以望到那条小溪和小桥,还有那几株依依多情的杨柳。
人教版五年级英语上册课件 篇5
教学内容:Read。
教学目标:读熟并理解read。教学重、难点:读熟并理解read。
教学方法:表演导入法。
教具准备:磁带,录音机,卡片,挂图
教学过程:
复习检查:
导入新课:
可采用表演导入法,教师事先找两名同学做准备,一人充当Tom,另一人充当解说员,教师充当Mom。表演开始,由解说员说解说词(图下的文字),然后Tom和Mom对话,并逐段表演揉面,抹面,撒料,烘烤等动作直到最后拿出来吃。比萨饼可用硬纸剪一下图片代替,再剪一些红绿碎纸片充当馅料。另外也可以用听音导入法导入,具体做法是教师先叙述"Mom is making a pizza. Tom comes in. He wants to make apizza."然后放录音,先从头到尾放一到两遍,再逐句放音,让学生重复并译成中文。
操练:
把阅读按6幅图分成6段,教师出示6幅挂图或简笔画,并在每份图下写上关键词,然后逐步放录音,先让学生逐句重复,然后让他们连起来说,再给一些时间让他们自己说,再让全班集体复述几遍,然后几名学生站起来复述,6幅图全部操练完毕后,再从头到尾连起来复述。全部复述完后,可找一些同学到讲台前试着复述。下课前布置同学回去做准备,下一节课上进行表演。
效果测试。
做练习册中的练习五、听力一至三及阅读练习。
人教版五年级英语上册课件 篇6
下面是范文网小编整理的人教版五年级上册英语单元教学反思范文五篇(小学英语五年级上册第一单元教案教学反思),欢迎参阅。
小学英语重在真实自然,贴近学生的生活。教材中选用的单词和句式,一般都是社会中最常见,最基础的,但由于种.种原因,有些学生还是不能很好的掌握他们的语音、音调。一起来看看人教版五年级上册英语单元教学反思范文五篇,希望能帮助到大家!
英语单元教学反思1
新课改倡导全人教育,强调课程要促进每个学生身心健康的发展,培养学生良好的品质和终身学习的本事,新课改提倡交流与合作、自主创新学习,课程改革的成败关键在于教师,教师是课程改革的实施者。
下头简单地回顾一下这一年以来所做的一些英语教学工作。
一、面向全体学生,为学生全面发展和终身发展奠定基础。
1、创设各种情景,鼓励学生大胆地说英语,对他们在学习过程中犯的错误采取宽容的态度。
根据教材中的情境,真实再现于课堂并创造新的怀境,如教“What’s you name? How old are you?”时,情境有“小歌手大赛报到处”、“迷路的小孩子与警察”、“结识新朋友”、“医生与生病的孩子”、“自我介绍”等等一些语境,使学生进取参与,到讲台上锻炼英语表达本事和胆量。如师生早晚问好、道谢、道别等,学生已经习惯用Hello、Good morning、 thank you、You are wele、 See you、 Good bye……与我交流。这样就无形中发展学生运用英语交际本事,培养他们创新灵活运用英语的习惯。
2、在教学过程中注重学生的听、说、读、写综合本事,鼓励他们大胆的说并运用到实际中去。
每课的对话让学生先听后读,然后表演,每小组不宜超过四人。表演前应让各小级操练准备,鼓励其拓展创新对话资料。表演过程中,除要求学生语音语调正确外,还应让学生注意到交流手段如表情、手势、姿态等。例如在练习Is this jacket yours?这个句型时,我手里拿着一件夹克衫,一边走进教室一边问:Whose jacket is it? Is this jacket yours?这时学生很好奇,都想明白这件夹克衫是谁的。于是,我跟学生们操练熟了,就让学生自我去找它的主人,学生拿着这件夹克衫去问别人:Is this jacket yours? 教师还能够利用插图来创设情景,培养学生的创新精神,让学生根据图画的资料编一段对话。学生会运用所学过的知识,编成各种对话
3、创造条件让学生能够发现他们自我的一些问题,并自主解决问题。
二、创造宽松、和谐的气氛
在教学过程中,注重与学生沟通,让学生消除对英语学习的恐惧感,仅有对英语感兴趣,才能坚持英语学习的动力并取得好成绩。刻板的学习,不仅仅会影响英语学习的效果,适得其反让他们厌恶学习英语。所以创造宽松、和谐的学习氛围有利于英语学习。
1、尊重每个学生,进取鼓励他们大胆的尝试。
要培养学生的创造个性,仅停留在创设教学情境上是不够的。教师首先要具有创新的精神,注重创设宽松、和谐的教学氛围,尊重学生个体,注重抓住一切时机激发学生创新的欲望,注意对学生的学习行为和学习结果、反应等做出客观、公正、热情、诚恳的评价……
2、鼓励学生大声的朗读课文并背诵,使自我听的见自我的声音,渐渐做到流利,顺畅。促进学生互相学习,互相帮忙,体验成就感。
3、对于底子薄的或性格内向的同学,降低他们的学习标准,当他们取得一点小小的提高,都要鼓励他们,让他们感到有成就感。
差生上课时注意往往不够集中,我就将教材化难为易,化多为少,精讲多练,课堂上尽量创造愉快的氛围。差生由于羞怯心理往往怕开口,我尽量将难易适度的问题去问他们;叫他们到黑板上写有把握的句子;朗读事先已读过多遍的课文,当差生回答正确时。我总是面常笑容地说:“very good”,他们往往因得到这两个激动,这样差生开口的习惯慢慢的养成。一学期下来,差生的参与意识大大地加强,消除了畏惧心理,
4、建立良好的师生关系,经常和学生一齐反思学习过程中的不足,并加以改正。
教和学是一对矛盾,作为矛盾双方的教师和学生如何和谐融洽师生关系,对完成教学至关紧要。如果他们对某个教师有好感,他们就对教师的这门课感兴趣并分外重视,肯下大气力学这门课。如果他们不喜欢某一位教师,由于逆反心理,他们也就不愿学或不学这位教师的课。所以,教师要深入学生,和学生打成一片,了解学生的兴趣,爱好,喜怒哀乐情绪的变化,时时处关心学生,爱护学生,尊重学生,帮忙学生。这样,师生才能关系和谐,感情融洽,兴趣盎然地进行学习。
三。记忆方法
学习语言就是要开口多说,多记, 多背,只要功夫到家了,学习英语的困难就迎刃而解了。英语琐碎的知识点太多,每一天都有新的知识点增加,这就需要学生多记,多背。这往往是学生最头疼的一件事。此刻才初一,主要是以单词为主,如果连单词都记不住,更何况句型听力。所以谈谈自我记忆单词,句型的方法,仅供参考。
1、根据发音脱口而出单词,多朗读,重复多次,背会的东西容易忘,应隔三插五的再巩固。
2、背诵一个小对话,背会了用自我的话把它复述出来,这样增加学习英语的自信心。
3。 把记不住的单词写在小纸片上,随时都能够拿出来看看,长期坚持,必须有成效。
四、对学生进行有效的评价。
评价能够使学生认识自我,树立自信,有助于反思及调整自我的学习。对学生回答问题过程中的表现及改善的成绩,给予口头评价、书面评价并鼓励他们大胆的去说。学生考完试后,让学生自我反思,分析自我的成绩和不足,明确今后努力的方向,争取下次不再犯同样的问题。让学生相互之间相互评价,找出优缺点,互相促进学习。
一年的教学工作中,使我深刻的认识到教师这个职业,不仅仅要有过硬的专业知识,并且要有爱心 耐心,更主要的是管理学生的本事。并不是每个人都能胜任教师这个神圣而又伟大的职业。人们都说教师是人类历史的工程师,我很庆幸自我成为教师行业的一员。但此刻深有体会,当一位教师难,成为一位称职的教师更难,成为一为称职而又秀的教师更是难上加难。自我要进取进取,不断的提高自身素质,多听有经验教师的课,取其精华,并将其运用到自我的教学当中,不断反思自我教学中的不足,更新观念,愿与新课程共同成长
英语单元教学反思2
小学英语重在真实自然,贴近学生的生活。教材中选用的单词和句式,一般都是社会中最常见,最基础的,但由于种.种原因,有些学生还是不能很好的掌握他们的语音、音调。尤其是一些较难读的单词。
学生刚开始接触英语时,就凭一时的兴趣学习。他们对课堂上动手、游戏的部分十分感兴趣,而对英语基本技能(单词及语音的模仿、记忆等)一开始还有板有眼的,时光长了,加上有些单词比较难读,他们就感觉索然无味,于是就不专心听讲。这样,他们既使在课堂上记住了一些语音知识,下了课就忘得一干二净。随着学习资料的不断增多,这部分学生学习上的问题更加突出。之后,既使他们认识到学习英语的重要性,但学习吃力,就自信心大减。最终甚至有不再要上英语课的想法。
有些学生由于内向,孤僻的性格。他们不愿开口,不善交往;而开口少,与他人接触少,往往模仿潜力也差,这就使及他们更不愿参与各种英语练习活动,内向的性格使他们回避与别人交往,碰到问题常常不向同学或教师请教,在课堂上害怕表现不佳,有损自我在教师和同学心目中的形象,降低自我价值。所以,他们缺乏自我表现的习惯和勇气。就连不得不参加的 “one by one”都是极低的声音,试图不引起别人的注意。具有这种性格倾向的学生,不仅仅仅学习上的困难无法解决,并且语言知识也不能到达最大限度的再现。进行“pair work”时,他们总是不投入,缺乏跟同学的合作精神。
目前,大部分学生每周仅有三节课能接触到英语,加之班额较大,既使在英语课堂上也仅有少数优秀的、用心的学生想参与语言实践活动,一堂课上单词、对话或课文等教学资料一项接一项,对于学习潜力不强的学生来说犹如看电影似的过了一遍,根本掌握不了。
同时,课后没有很好的语言环境,学生语音掌握更加困难。由于不明白英语的基本音标,有些学生应对已遗忘的单音节词不知所措,对他们来说,英语单词实在难记,这使英语课成了死记硬背的代名词。如果教师试图透过超多的练习来巩固学生所学的语言点,就会使教学“机械化”。使得一些学生对英语学习逐渐失去兴趣。
小学生英语学习有困难的原因既有内因,又有外因。由于原因的错综复杂,一味简单地进行知识到课,搞反复操练,只会使学生对英语学习产生更强烈的厌学情绪。仅有摸清原因,对症下药,才能解决困难。
针对农村小学英语教学的现状,我认为应注意以下对策:
第一:从一开始就适时的渗透一些规则的、基本的音标知识。对其中有规律可循的音和词加以归纳学习,这样在课后,让学生在遗忘时能够有一个记忆的线索,同时在课堂上,教师能够让学生根据这一知识自我去学拼简单的单词,并且对正确的学生给予鼓励和表扬。几次成功的尝试会使得他们更有兴趣去学习,在预习和复习时能用心参与进去,并乐在其中。
第二:因为中西方的发音本身就存在必须的差异,而小学生辨别潜力有限,使得学生对一些音不能很好的区分,这就可利用教材配套的录音磁带进行反复跟读练习,针对一些相近的音加以区分。如:ai ei、u: u、 e 、 等。教师也能够设计一些针对性的练习。如:听音连字母、听音圈单词等,让学生对典型的单词中的音标,做到耳熟能读,为今后的英语学习打下一个基础。
第三:作为农村小学英语教学,才刚刚起步,困难较多。没有一个象学习普通话那样的好氛围,可是,我们教师能够自创,教师能够多设计一些对话和活动,让学生进行表演,在动手的同时多动动口,使简单的句子落到实处,能够脱口而出。并且,能够要求学生在英语课上要用英语交谈,在平时师生之间,学生之间尽量多用英语,不管语法是否对,你能讲就是值得表扬。
第四:能够让学生注意收听一些用英语播音的节目,如中央九台的节目,既能听音,也能看画面加深理解。并不要求学生能够听懂它所讲的资料,着重在于让学生熟悉和了解英语的发音模式和方法,为纯正语音的学习作一个辅助。
总之,只要教师能针对学生的语音缺陷,用开发智力和挖掘非智力因素相结合,尊重学生,鼓励学生,和学生一齐多练多说,我相信这一现象必须会有所改善。
英语单元教学反思3
英语对于此刻的学生来说,是一门比较难学的学科。许多学生都说英语真困难,不愿意学习它。从而导致他们学习的不太梦想。最近,有件事情使我感触太深了。认识到了学生不是学不好,而是存在着有他们不愿意学习的因素。
由于要录实堂课,所以我就把课本中的一节读写课制作成了课件。这样想的目的主要是避免课堂上的麻烦,节省时光。但实际上的效果却是我没有想到的。由于学生第一次接触课件,所以他们感觉十分的新鲜。上演练课的时候,学生学的异常的认真。他们进取的、认真的读课文,听我解讲课文中的重点知识。也在进取的动脑回答思考我所给他们出的问题。整堂课给我的感觉是学生没有一个在偷懒,都在认真的学习,哪怕是对英语一点兴趣都没有的学生。自然而然这一节课的效果是出乎我所意料的。过后, 我就在办公室里反思为什么这节课上的这么好?学生为什么对我已经学过的资料表现出这么大的反应?我的最大的感触就是,使用了新鲜的东西,学生感兴趣的方式方法来引导他们学习。这就意味着,上课要不断的给学生新鲜感,要培养他们对学习英语的兴趣。不是说“兴趣是最好的教师吗?”我就是在这一堂课中给学生不一样的学习方法,也能够说是他们比较感兴趣的,抓住他们的注意力。最大限度的发挥他们本身的潜力,由他们原先的被动学习变为此刻的主动的学习。正因为他们对本节课充满着兴趣,所以就有很大的乐趣去学习,从而就很顺利地完成了本堂课的教学任务的。
所以,在今后的教学中,要不断的更改教学方式,要从根本培养起学生学习的兴趣。仅有兴趣才是最好的教师。好的先生不是教书,不是教学生,而是教学生学。
英语单元教学反思4
时光过得真快,转眼间,我已在学校担任英语教学10年多了,回顾已经过去的一些日子,真是感慨万分。我激动,也深知自我所担负的重任。
英语是人与人之间用来交流的,在课上我经常鼓励学生勇于开口,大胆说英语,用英语交流,调动学生的进取性,要求学生不怕犯错误,敢于开口,用英语与教师和同学交流。其实有好多学生在内心也都有用英语与教师同学交流的欲望,但他们迫于“压力”,怕说错或说不好会被教师批评、同学嘲笑,于是选择了坚持沉默。所以在课上我进取引导学生排除这种心理障碍,上课的时候态度比较温和,只要学生用英语说话,哪怕是一点点,就给予表扬,以调动他们的进取性;态度真诚,努力挖掘学生做的好的方面,尽量不表露出失望、生气和不耐烦等诸多情绪,从而不影响学生的情绪。对于每次学生说话中的比较明显的错误,诸如:发音不正确的词、严重的语法错误等,对他们进行及时指出并帮忙其改正,并且进行不断地鼓励,因为学生有了进取性,有了学英语的乐趣,他们就会对自我充满信心,于是开始主动地说了。
可是课上过于简便的学习气氛,致使部分学生上课不遵守纪律,从而影响其他同学的学习。所以,在接下来的教学过程中我应当总结过去半个多学期教学工作中存在的不足之处,不断改善自我教学和管理方法,不断学习,不断实践,不断反思,不断成长提高。
英语单元教学反思5
今年学校组织了听评课活动,全校各教师不仅仅仅带给了一堂优秀的以课改形式表现的新课,各教师在平时教学中也在逐渐渗透新课改教学理念。
我作为一名小学英语执教者,在本次听评课活动中,感受颇深。
1、小学英语课堂教学应提倡教学生活化,形式多样化。
爱因斯坦说过:"兴趣是最好的教师。"在教与学的关系上,古人强调:"教必搞笑,以趣促学"。而新《英语课程标准》又强调小学英语教学最主要的是激发小学生学习英语的兴趣。我针对小学生的年龄、生理和心理特征,结合拍手操,歌谣,声音的高低,手在身体各部分的位置等等生活化的教学形式,并力求多而不乱。采用多样化的教学形式激发学生学习英语的兴趣,但活动形式不能只图表面上的热闹,而要有必须的语言知识和技能作支撑。所以,我认为我们教师应透过有效的语言活动帮忙学生掌握所学的知识和技能。语言源于生活,脱离实际生活的语言是不"真实"的。一个语言枯燥的课堂是不能激发学生的学习兴趣的,仅有将语言融入生活,它才会绽放魅力,才能提高学生的学习兴趣。我想我们教师应不断提高自身的业务水平,充分发挥教学法技能,巧妙地将授课资料与实际生活相联系,让学生在生活中学习语言和运用语言,并构成良好的品质。
2、小学英语课堂教学活动要善于打开学生的思路。
我认为应抓住小学生的好奇心理,活化我们的英语教材,透过扩展教材资料或活动步骤,充分激发他们勤于思考、敢于创新的兴趣,鼓励他们多角度、多方向、新颖独特的提出问题、解决问题;提倡一题多议,敢破常规,使教学向纵深发展。如在学生基本上学会如何询问他人来自于的国家时,教师可让学生自我自由组合,自由表演,他们所以利用以前所学说出了很多课文中没有的句子。这样做的目的是设置对话障碍,加大口语交际的难度和真实性,进一步培养学生会多渠道解决问题的潜力,训练学生的创新思维和口语交际的灵活性。虽然教学中我发现对教材的扩展超出了学生解决问题的潜力范围,但却所以激起了他们思维的火花,引发他们在课外、在今后的学习中努力寻求解决的办法,培养了他们思维的流畅性和独创性。)
3、小学英语课堂教学要保证有丰富的语言输入量。
课改提出的新理念:"不能教教材,而要用教材"。即要创造性地理解、使用教材,又要用心开展课程资源,灵活运用多种教学策略。所以,我认为更不能就教材教,而要勇于把英语课堂的触角伸向更广阔的天地,也就是学生的生活和大自然,要和学生一道开发和生成开放、富有活力的英语课堂。而信息技术的应用,不受时空的限制,为教学带给了超多的信息,保证了丰富的语言输入量。根据这一特点,本节课我主动的人为设置、透过多媒体课件,增大课堂容量,为教学带给超多生动、形象的素材。这样不仅仅仅有效地扩大了学生视野和与语言操练的面,并且提高了学生的理解和存储效率,从而增强了教学效果。
4、小学英语课堂评价要抓住孩子的心。
现代教学论和评价论认为,有效的课堂教学其实是在一系列或明或隐、或大或小的评价活动基础上展开的。那么,在课堂教学评价中,采用具有用心好处的激励性评价是促进学生发展、提高课堂教学质量的有效措施和保障机制。而在英语教学中简单的"Good""Wonderful" 的评价手段已不能满足和吸引学生了。我想英语教学有自我自身的学科特色,利用这一特点,我在教学中结合教学资料、教学活动,实施富有特色的激励性评价。
人教版五年级英语上册课件 篇7
教学目标
1.会认“相、璧”等16个生字,会写“召、臣”等12个生字,掌握“进攻、召集”等词语。
2.快速默读课文,理清文章的脉络。理解三个小故事的前因后果。
3. 通过人物的言行体会人物个性特点。复述故事,弄清三个小故事之间的联系。
教学重点
快速默读课文,理清文章的脉络。理解三个小故事的前因后果。
教学难点
通过人物的言行体会人物个性特点。复述故事,弄清三个小故事之间的联系。
第一课时
教学目标
1.会认“相、璧”等16个生字,会写“召、臣”等12个生字,掌握“进攻、召集”等词语。
2.快速默读课文,理清文章的脉络。理解三个小故事的前因后果。
3.学习第一个小故事“完璧归赵”。
教具准备
课件
教学设计
一、激趣导入,板书课题。
1.同学们,我们是一个班集体,我们应该团结一致。可如果同学们之间不团结会出现什么状况呢?
生自由讨论
师:看来,我们都知道团结的重要性了。古人更知道这个,今天我们就学习一篇文章。
(板书:将相和)
2.简介背景、揭示课题。
(1)战国时期的赵国,有两个非常有名的人物:廉颇和蔺相如。“将相和”这个故事就发生在这两个人之间。 (出示课件3)
(2)看到课题,你想知道什么? (看到课题,我想知道“将”“相”分别指谁?“将”“相”之间是怎样由和到不和又到和好的。)
二、快速默读课文,自学生字词。
1.生字:(要求读准字音,掌握字形,理解字义,会组词。出示幻灯,组词:)
2.借助工具书理解下列词语。
(无价之宝 失信 抵御 理直气壮 完璧归赵 同心协力 负荆请罪)
三、浏览课文,整体把握。 (出示课件5)
1.在书上画出“将”“相”分别指谁。说说“和”是什么意思。(“将”指大将军廉颇,“相”指上卿蔺相如,“和”是和好、团结的意思。)
2.本文主要讲了一个什么故事?(出示课件5)
(本文主要讲了廉颇和蔺相如由和到不和又到和好的故事。)
四、理清脉络,概括段意。(出示课件6)
1.本文讲了几个小故事?找出每个故事的起止,并用一个合适的小标题概括每个小故事的内容。
2.讨论交流: 本文讲了三个小故事。
第一个故事(1—10)完璧归赵。
第二个故事(11—15)渑池之会。
第三个故事(16-18)负荆请罪。
3.学习第一个小故事。 (1)指名朗读第一个小故事,理清层次,找出故事的起因、经过、结果。 学生各抒己见,教师归纳整理。(出示课件7)
(起因:秦王企图骗取赵国的和氏璧。
经过:蔺相如机智勇敢斗秦王。
结果:蔺相如完璧归赵,被封为上大夫。)
(2)画出描写蔺相如言行的句子,根据人物的言行,分析蔺相如的性格特点。 讨论、交流、整理:(出示课件8)
①语言:“我愿意带着和氏璧到秦国去。如果秦王真的拿十五座城来换,我就把璧交给他;如果……就没有动兵的理由。”(机智) 行动:当满朝文武为难时,蔺相如挺身而出。(表现出蔺相如的勇敢。)
②语言:“这块璧有点小毛病,让我指给您看。”(机智)
行动:当蔺相如觉察到秦王没有诚意换璧时,就上前一步,故意指出璧上有毛病,把和氏璧要回手中。(机智)
③语言:“我看你并不想交付十五座城。现在璧在我手里,您要是强逼我,我的脑袋和璧就一块撞碎在这柱子上!”(不畏强暴、机智勇敢。)
行动:捧着璧,往后退了几步,靠着柱子站定,举起和氏璧就要向柱子上撞。(不畏强暴、机智勇敢。)
小结: 秦王企图骗取赵国的和氏璧,蔺相如带着和氏璧前往秦国,利用秦王说的以城换璧的话,随机应变,揭穿了秦王的骗局,巧妙地要回和氏璧,机智勇敢地和秦王斗争,做到了完璧归赵,被封为上大夫。
4.指导学生有感情地朗读第一个故事。
五、总结、预习。 (出示课件10)
1.学习第一个故事的方法:
(1)找出事情的起因、经过、结果,掌握故事的主要内容。
(2)画出描写人物言行的句子,分析人物的性格特点。
(板书:完璧归赵)
2.课堂练习:
简要复述“完璧归赵”的故事。
3.扩展:蔺相如不畏强暴、机智勇敢,做到了完璧归赵,为赵国立下大功,被赵王封为上大夫,他在渑池会上又是怎样为赵国再立大功、被封为上卿的呢?课下请同学们预习“渑池之会”。
第二课时
教学目标
学习第二、第三个故事,了解每个故事的前因后果。复述故事,弄清三个故事之间的联系。进一步体会人物的性格特点,从人物的好品质中受到启示和教育。
教具准备
课件
教学设计
一、复习检查。(出示课件13)
1.“将”“相”分别指谁?“和”是什么意思?本文主要写了一个什么故事?是由哪几个小故事组成的?
2.根据第一个故事,说说蔺相如这个人物的性格特点。
(板书:机智勇敢)
二、教师引导,进入新课。
小组学习,讨论、汇报。
1.学习第二个小故事。 按照学习第一个小故事的方法学习第二个小故事。(出示课件14)
(板书:渑池之会)
起因:秦王想侮辱赵王,要赵王鼓瑟,并且叫人记录下来。
经过:蔺相如针锋相对地逼秦王击缶,维护了赵国尊严。
结果:秦王没占到便宜,只好放赵王回国,相如再立大功,被封为上卿。)
思考:秦王为什么不敢拿赵王怎么样?
生答,师总结:
秦王不敢拿赵王怎么样,是因为他知道廉颇已经在边境上做好了准备。
(出示课件15)2.画出描写蔺相如言行的句子,分析人物的性格特点。(讨论、交流、点拨:秦王让赵王击缶实际上是侮辱赵王,蔺相如为了维护国家荣誉,让秦王为赵王击缶,表现了蔺相如为了国家的荣誉,不畏强暴、机智勇敢的高尚品质。)
(板书:不畏强暴,机智勇敢)
3.指导有感情地朗读,深化理解人物性格特点。
第三个小故事。
4.学习第三个小故事。(出示课件16)
(1)默读第三个小故事,找出故事的起因、经过、结果。
(板书:负荆请罪)
起因:廉颇不服,想找机会羞辱蔺相如,将相之间产生矛盾。
经过:蔺相如处处回避、忍辱退让。
结果:廉颇负荆请罪,将相和好。
思考:廉颇说自己攻无不克战无不胜,是真的吗?
生答,师总结:从渑池会中,秦王因为廉颇在边境做好了准备而不敢动赵王这件事中可以看出廉颇说的是真的。
(2)画出廉颇和蔺相如的言行。(出示课件16)
①分析:蔺相如的语言、行动,表现了蔺相如怎样的品质?
(表现了蔺相如以国家利益为重,顾大局、识大体的高尚品质。)
(板书:以国家利益为重,顾大局、识大体)
②分析:廉颇的语言、行动,表现了廉颇怎样的品质?
(语言:反映了廉颇居功自傲、性格直率的特点。行动:反映了廉颇以国家利益为重、勇于认错、知错就改的性格特点。)
(板书:居功自傲,性格直率)
(3)思考:将相和好的根本原因是什么?(详细说出因果联系;爱国是和好的根本原因。)
(4)思考:负荆请罪中蔺相如解释自己不和廉颇针锋相对的一番话有几层含义?说明了什么?
引导生读相关文字,并表达自己的观点。
师总结:A.和秦王做比较,点明自己不害怕廉颇。
B.秦王不敢进攻赵国,因为有廉颇。
C.将相不和会削弱赵国的力量。
从中我们可以看出蔺相如是个识大体、顾大局,心胸宽广的人。
三、回顾全文,归纳中心。(出示课件19)
1.课文的三个小故事叙述了谁和谁的矛盾?根据矛盾性质的不同,这些矛盾可以归纳为哪两种矛盾?
2.贯串两种矛盾的中心人物是谁?
3.三个小故事间有什么联系? 哪是因,哪是果?
归纳中心:本文通过记叙将相由和到不和又到和好的故事,表现了蔺相如不畏强暴、机智勇敢的精神,以及以国家利益为重,顾大局、识大体的高尚品质;表现了廉颇以国家利益为重,勇于改过的精神,赞扬了将相爱国的好品质。
四、总结、拓展。
本文通过典型事件来刻画人物形象;抓住人物言行来刻画人物的性格特点,使读者受到深刻的爱国主义教育。课下请同学们自读历史故事“刎颈之交”,进一步学习将相团结一致、全力合作的爱国主义精神。
五、布置作业。
1.用自己的话讲一讲这三个小故事。
2.联系自己的学习、生活,谈谈学了本文后的感想。
板书设计:
教学反思
1.《将相和》这篇文章对于五年级的学生来说,理解故事不是难点,结合课文实际,我确定了廉颇和蔺相如由“不和”到“和”的发展过程和内在原因为学习的重点。难点定为理解三个小故事各自的起因和结果以及这三个小故事之间的因果关系。教学的时候,我先引导学生比较充分地快速默读全文,从整体上弄清“将相和”这个故事的来龙去脉。然后再精读各个小故事,深入研究每个小故事涉及的问题,引导学生联系全文评价故事的主要人物,弄清三个小故事之间的内在联系。通过学习,学生提高了分析问题和解决问题的能力。优点:符合新课程标准提出的“积极倡导自主,合作探究的学习方式”。
2. 这一节分析课,我抓住教学的重、难点作为突破口,让学生充分发表自己的意见,并给予鼓励,极大地调动了学生的学习积极性。
不足之处:分析较多,读得太少,淡化了语文的感悟,出现了忽略语言学习的倾向。在今后的教学中,我一定把学生放在主体地位上,做好自己的主导地位。
人教版五年级英语上册课件 篇8
Did they buy ice creams?
学习任务:
This is a letter about Lingling’s funny experience with Sam and Amy in London.了解字母、字母组合e, ea, i, e, a 在单词中常见的读音
歌曲:The London eye .
运用任务:
1、read the letter
2、recite the key words.
3、answer the questions
教学程序:
1、热身复习
借助挂图复习SB Unit 1。
2、任务呈现与课文导入
review thewords of Unit 1,Module 1 ;let some students read the text.
教师应对学生的描述给予鼓励和肯定。
3、课文教学
(1)用动画或大挂图加录音带呈现SB Unit 2活动1
放第一遍录音,let the student preview the letter.放第二遍录音,学生检查,and follow the read thetext.教师对学生给予鼓励和表扬。
(2)SB Unit 2活动2
播放录音,在每一句话后停顿,学生重复,模仿录音中的语音、语调。
抽几组学生汇报。如果该组学生说的句子不够,其他组补充,直到把能说的句子都说出来为止。
4、任务完成
全班完成SB Unit 2活动3。
课文学习
(1)语音教学
学习SB活动1。
教师出示一些单词卡片,上面的词包括Chinese,teacher,river,rabbit,letter,hen,cat,apple。单词划线处的元音字母写成红色。教师出示单词卡片,学生读出单词。
学生听录音,思考划线处的发音。教师举起写有Chinese的卡片,请学生判断e字母在这个单词中的发音。再举一些例子。学生可以两人合作,或小组合作来想单词。以同样的方式来学习其他元音字母及字母组合在单词中的发音。
(2)歌曲教学
SB 活动2。学生看书歌曲部分下面的图,用英语描述每一幅图上都有什么,让学生读每一个句子,确认学生明白每一句。问学生这四句话分别用来描述哪一幅图。
放第一遍歌曲录音,学生听。放第二遍录音,在每一句后暂停,学生跟唱。用此种方式让学生跟录音唱几遍,直到学生学会为止。
6、课后作业
SB活动2,唱给家人听。
听磁带跟读SB Unit 1、2、3中的内容,模仿标准地道的英语。
完成AB Unit 2练习2和3。
copy the letter three times.
教学板书设计
Module 1 Unit2 Did they buy ice cream?
Words send –sent run – ran email love
Phonetics. DidLingling go to the park yesterday ?
Didshe meet John ?
Didthey buy ice creams ?
Didthey go home by bike ?
Did Linglingwalk to the bus ?
DidLingling drop her ice cream ?
人教版五年级英语上册课件 篇9
Step5: Extension.( Talk about our travel.)
T: We all had a happy weekend. We went to lots of places and did many things. But I think in our holiday, we were happy too. Now look at this photo. This is me. Who can ask me some questions?
S1: Where did you go?
T: I went to Tianjin. Other questions?
S2: What did you do?
T: I visited my friend. You must have happy holiday too. Now 4 Ss a group. Ask and answer.
学生小组讨论。
选取小记者,随机提问班里的同学。
最后教师总结:You went to lots of places. Now let’s enjoy our class’s travel(教师课前收集学生旅游照,自制学生旅游视频)。 The world is a wonderful book and those who do not travel can see only a page of it.
Step6: Homework.
Describe your travel to your friends.
板书设计:
Unit1 Where did you go?
Daming: What did you do at the weekend?
Amy: We visited lots of places.
Daming: Where did you go?
Amy: We went to the British Museum, Big Ben and the London Eye.
最新人教版五年级英语上册第三单元教案4
《How many do you want?》
教材分析:
1、 本模块学习用how many和how much问数量多少,并会表演在商场购物的简单会话。
2、 学生对可数名词和不可数名词认识可能有困难,应详细讲清。,
学情分析:
1、农村小学英语基础差,学生程度不齐,部分学生发音不准。
2、 学生对购物比较熟悉,会话取材简单,便于练习。
3、 对部分差生需要耐心辅导,帮助他们度过单词关、语音关。
教学目标:
1、学习句型How many bananas do you want?
How much cheese do you want?
Do you like cheese,Lingling?
No, I don,t ,I like cheese.
2、使用how many, how much询问多少。
3、 教育学生在家帮助父母购买物品、做点力所能及的家务活。
教学重点:
1、说出购物的过程,表演课本对话。
2、 使用how many , how much问多少。
3、 分清可数名词和不可数名词。
教学过程:
一、热身复习
学生跟录音机唱Module1中学习的英语歌曲。
二、课文导入
问一个学生的书包是在哪里买的,多少钱,引出单词shop how much yuan need等。
三、课文教学
A、学习单词,学生反复跟读后,教师拿出单词卡片,让学生看着汉语说英语,然后看着英语说汉语,检查单词记忆情况及读音是否正确。
B、 SB活动1
先听录音,然后解释句子意思,并解释how many ,how much的用法及区别,提出可数名词和不可数名词,并详细解释让学生分清楚。
C、小组练习
听几遍录音后,分小组分角色练习对话,教师在课堂上流动辅导,并让优秀学生带动差生练习。
D、SB活动2
先听录音,然后将班级学生分成两组读这两个重点句型。
E、SB活动3
让学生看图,教师先做示范,然后让学生两人一组做练习,并找几组在课堂上做对话。
四、任务完成
找若干小组学生在课堂上表演购物对话,组与组之间比赛。
五、课后作业
A、练习对话。
B、抄写本模块单词。
板书设计:
1、 本模块单词。
2、 重点句型。
3、 重点解释。
评价设计:
教师记分,学生鼓掌鼓励,小组比赛奖分等方法来激励学生积极参加课堂活动,提高教学效果。
最新人教版五年级英语上册第三单元教案5
第二单元
教学目标:
1、能听懂,会说What day is it today? It’s …。 What do you have on …? We have…。 I like …。 并能在情景中熟练运用。
2、了解西方国家一些没有固定日期的节日,如父亲节,母亲节等等。
教学重点:
掌握句型:What day is it today? Its....What do you have on Wednesdays? We have English,science,computer and P.E.I like Wednesdays.学生通过学习,能够自在实际情景中自如运用这些句子。
教学难点:
Lets try部分,内容多,易混淆。应多放录音,正确引导。必要时给出听力原文指导学生进行分句听和分段听。另一难点是能够简单描述一周内的学习和生活情况。
教学方法:
情景教学法,任务教学法 教具 CAI,cards
教学过程与内容设计:
Step 1 Warm-up(热身)
(1)教师放Start部分的歌谣Let’s chant录音,学生复习巩固有关星期的新单词和课程名称。
(2)日常口语练习,内容可参考如下:
A:What day is it today?
B:Its Tuesday.
A:What do you have?
B: We have P.E.class.I like Tuesdays.
Step 2 Presentation(新课呈现)
(1)教师播放Lets try的录音,让学生仔细听,尽量按选出正确的图,并说出先后顺序。听了一遍后,老师可给出重点句型。让学生再听录音,完成听音选图练习后,教师指导学生给出正确答案。如果学生听了两遍后,还不能理解内容,可出示听力原文的同时播声音,让学生听懂后,在不看文字的状态下再听一遍。反复播放录音能强化对新句型的听觉感知。
(2)在此基础上,教师出示本课时Let’s talk对话部分的图片,利用教学VCD或录音带,让学生来看一看、听一听Amy要上什么课程。要求学生在听的过程中做记录,有意识培养他们听的技能。小组或班级评选谁是听力王,对学生听的表现及时评价。
(3)反复听录音,跟读对话。两人一组读对话。
Step 3 Practice (趣味操练)
(1)教师利用转盘教具做游戏,操练第一组句型:What day is it today? Its....然后引导学生依据实际的课程表替换新句型中的关键词,操练第二组句型:What do you have on…? We have....
(2)让学生根据自己的课程表,准备描述一下自己本周学习的情况。可先在小组内或同桌间进行交流。然后在全班宣读。在准备过程中教师要有意识地引导学生说出本部分重点的两组新句型,如:What do you have on Wednesdays? We/I have....交流完毕后,教师不要忘记让大家评选出欢迎的宣读者。
(3)Group work
引导学生根据刚刚准备的情况宣读稿,分小组讨论各自喜欢什么课程和哪一天的课程。总结出各小组最喜欢的课程和最喜欢星期几的课程,在班级内做汇报。鼓励学生表述尽可能多的理由。
Step 4 Consolidation and extension(巩固与扩展)
(1)让学生做A Lets talk部分的活动手册配套练习。
(2)让学生听Lets talk部分的录音,读给朋友或家长听。
(3)让学生参照自己设计的课程表说一说喜欢的课程和喜欢星期几。要特别说的喜欢的理由。
(4)让学生把新学的文化背景知识介绍给家长或朋友听;制作祝福卡给父母或朋友。
Step 5 Conclusion
Homework:完成相应配套练习。
板书设计:
Unit 2 My week
What day is it today?
Its....
What do you have on Wednesdays?
We have English,science,computer and P.E.I like Wednesdays.
教学反思:
在这一节课学习的始终,课前我用几分钟结合情境复习单词、单词和句型的融合运用及问答,使学生熟悉单词、短语的表达,能够听懂老师的提问,在老师引导下能够完整回答。本节课继续学习与学生学习和生活密切相关的话题,即在校的课程和课余生活安排。学生很熟悉汉语的表达但转化到英语可能会混淆、反应慢,特别是星期几的记忆和替换句型灵活运用环节。在做两两和小组口语练习时,有的学生不敢开口,有的怕其他同学笑话,还有的担心出错。我多做示范,多引导,多鼓励他们,能说到哪就说到哪,不懂就举手问老师,共同完成。
人教版五年级英语上册课件 篇10
一.教学内容 Part B let’s try let’s talk
二.教学目标
1.继续学习“Who’s…?He/she is…What’s he/she like?” He/She is … Is he/she…?Yes,he/she is. No, he/she isn’t.”等询问某人是谁,怎么样的相关交际用语。
2.能够听懂,会说,会表演Let’s talk的内容并在真实场景中运用所学语言进行真实交流和运用。
3.在对话交流中使学生养成用英语交流的习惯,培养良好的语音语调和语感。
三.教学重难点
重点:学生能够表演Let’s talk的交际内容。
难点:能用Who’s …?He/She is … Is he/she…?Yes,he/she is. No, he/she isn’t.”进行真实交际。
四.课前准备
词卡,课件
五.教学步骤
Step1 Warming-up
1.sing a song”who’s your teacher?”
3.Let’s listen andchant.
Step2.Presentation
1.学习let’s try
(1)listen andtick (2)Listen and answer
2.学习let’s talk
(1)教师针对对话设计相关问题,引导学生思考。
(3)听录音,模仿朗读,理解对话内容。
(4)教师领读对话,学生模仿,齐读练习,生生对话,小组表演。
3.学生小组内讨论自己的老师。
S1:Who is your Chinese(math/English/art/PE/music)teacher?
S2:Mr/Ms... ...
S1:What’s he/she like? S2:He/She is ... ...
Step3Consolidation
Student show theirdialogue.
Step4 Homework
1.Read let’s talk。
2.Make a newdialogue and act it out.
六.板书设计
Unit one What’s he like?
Part B let’stry let’s talk
know What’s she like?-- She’s kind.
her Is she strict?--Yes,sometimes.
七.教学反思
人教版五年级英语上册课件 篇11
六、Put the following sentences in order. 把下列句子按顺序排列,使之成为一段通顺的对话。(6分)
( ) A.He is in the woods.
( ) B.Where is Zhang Peng?
( ) C. Yes, he is. They are play toghter.
( ) D. Is he taking picture?
( ) E. No, he isn't. He is playing chess.
( ) F. Is John playing chess, too?
七、Read and answer the questions. 阅读短文,然后回答问题。(6分)
My name is Jance . I'm eleven years old. My birthday is October 2nd. It's in golden fall. The weather is cool and sunny. It's my favourite season. My father's birthday is in October, too. Can you imagine (想到)it's on the same(同一) day! We can enjoy ourselves on that day together! Usually we go hiking or fly kites. Sometimes we have a picnic. We have a lot of fun on that day!
1. When is Tim's birthday? What's the date?
___________________________________________
2. What do Tim and his father do on their birthdays?
__________________________________________________
3. Which season does Tim like best?
_______________________________________________
八、你最喜爱的季节是哪个季节,用所学的语言说说你喜欢的那个季节的原因。至少五句话。(5分)
_________________My favourite season ____________
_______________________________________________
_______________________________________________
_______________________________________________
_______________________________________________
_______________________________________________
_______________________________________________
_______________________________________________
[听力材料]
一、Listen and choose. 听录音,选择正确的答案。(5分)
1. -Mike, when do you get up?
2. -- Which season do you like best?
--- I like spring best.
3.--- What's the date?
--- It's August 9th.
4. I like winter because I can make a snow man.
5. He is writing an e-mail in the study.
二、Listen and choose. 听音选图。(5分)
1. --- Which season do you like best?
--- Summer.
2. --- What's the date?
--- March the 4th.
3. --- What's she doing?
--- She is drawing a picture.
4. Look, he is catching butterflies.
5. Look at the korale, he is swimming in the river.
三、Listen and choose the right answers. 听句子,选择正确的答语。(10分)
1. When do you get up?
2. What's your favourite season?
3. What's the date today?
4. What do you do on the weekend?
5. Can you see the tigers? What are they doing?
四、Listen and write down the missing words. 听录音,写出所缺单词。(10分)
1. --- Do you like winter, Mike?
--- Well, winter is good, but summer is my favourite season.
2. --- Hello.
--- Hello. This is Mike. Can I speak to John, please?
--- Hold on, please. He is reading.
3. --- Can you see any monkeys?
--- Yes. Look, They are climbing.
4. --- When is your birthday?
--- It's June 1st. Children's Day.
5. --- When do you go to bed?
--- At 9:30 in the evening.
人教版五年级英语上册课件 篇12
听力部分(40分)
一、Listen and choose. 听录音,选择正确的答案。(5分)
( )1When do you ____?
A. get up B. eat breakfast C. eat dinner
( )2. . --- Which season do you like best?
--- .
A.spring B. winter C. summer
( )3. --- What's the date?
--- It's____.
A. February 29th B. August 19th C. July 9th
( )4. I like winter. Because I can .
A. make a snow man B. play sports C. have a picnic
( )5. He is an e-mail in the study.
A. reading B. writing C. playing
二、Listen and choose. 听音选图。(5分)
三、Listen and choose the right answers. 听句子,选择正确的答语。(10分)
( )1. A.Yes, I get up. B. I go to bed at 9:30. C.I get up at 6:00.
( )2. A.I like swimming. B. I like spring best. C.I am reading.
( )3. A.It's Sunday. B. It's June the 4th. C.It's my birthday.
( )4. A.I'm writing. B.I can skate. C.I often go shopping.
( )5. A.It's swinging. B.He is climbing. C.They're flighting.
四、Listen and write down the missing words. 听录音,写出所缺单词。(10分)
1. --- Do you like winter, Mike?
--- Well, winter is good, but _____is my favourite senson.
2. --- Hello.
--- Hello. This is Mike. Can I speak to John, please?
--- Hold on, please. He is __________.
3. --- Can you see any monkeys?
--- Yes. Look, They are __________.
4. --- When is your birthday?
--- It's _____1st .Children's Day.
5. --- When do you ______?
--- At 9:30 in the evening.
笔试部分(60分)
一、Look at the pictures, then write down the missing words or phrases. 看图,写出相应的单词或短语。(10分)
二、Choose the right answers. 选择填空。(5分)
1.Can I speak ___John?
A.for B to C.on
2._____season do you like best?
A.Which B.What C.How
3.--- ___ they taking a picture?
--- Yes, they are.
A.am B.is C.are
4.What do you do ____the weekend?
A.on B. in C.at
5.Kate ____ playing chess.
A.Am B.Is C.Are
三、Read and match. 将问题与相应的答案连起来。(5分)
1. What are you doing? A. Yes, they are.
2. Is her birthday in June? B. It's may the 5th.
3. What's the date? C. I'm answering the phone.
4. What do you do on the weekend? D. Yes, it is.
5. Are they doing an experiment? E. I often going hiking.
四、Rearrange the words. 根据提供的标点符号,把单词组合成完整的句子。(10分)
1. play sports, I, at, 3:00, usually(.)
2.do, why, summer, you, like(?)
3. they, catching butterflies, are(?)
4. when, get, do, up, you(?)
5. mountains, I, sometimes, climb(.)
五、Fill in the blanks with the following words. 用所给的词语或短语填空。(8分)
John: What you see?
Mike: I see two .
John: What are they ?
Mike: They water.
John: Can you see the ?
Mike: Yes, it .
人教版五年级英语上册课件 篇13
一、学生情况分析
学生已学过两年多的英语,已有一定的基础。但是教材难度偏大,教学内容与课时不成比例,两极分化较严重。因此,本学期应注重转化后进生,因材施教,基础教学,分层教学,保持学生的学习兴趣。 二、教学目的与要求:
1、激发学生学习英语的兴趣,培养他们学习英语的积极态度,使他们初步建立学习英语的自信心。
2、培养学生具有一定的语感和良好的语音、语调、书写基础,以及良好的学习习惯。 3、使他们初步具备用英语进行简单日常交流的能力。 4、培养学生的观察、记忆、思维、想象和创造能力。
5、适当介绍中西方文化,培养学生的爱国主义精神,增强世界意识,为学生的进一步学习奠定良好的基础。 三、教学内容与目标:
1、能听、说、读、写短语和单词以及成组句子和单句。 2、能听、说、认读三会单词以及节日和活动名称。
3、能够总结字母组合的发音规律,并能读出新词,并写句子。 4、能培养学生的书写能力,总结一部分语法知识。 5、能完成自我评价活动。 6、能理解幽默小故事。
7、能了解简单的中西方文化知识。 四、教学措施:
1、认真备课,钻研教材,抓紧课堂教学,做到当堂内容当堂掌握。 2、运用各种不同的肢体语言来辅助教学。
3、在课堂上多开展一些有趣的活动、游戏让学生在活动中学习英语,在生活中学习英语。 4、多为学生营造一引起学习氛围,如:创设英语角等等。 5、要求学生在课余时间尽量的运用已经学习的英语进行对话。 6、多看英语画报,多读英语故事,多看英语书籍。 7、多与学生交流,进行口语交际训练。 五、学困生教学措施
1、了解学困生心理,建立师生感情。 2、尊重、理解、宽容、善待学困生。 3、借助集体力量感染学困生。
4、给学困生制定适合他们发展的学习目标,充分肯定他们完成教学 目标的能力,以达到培养其自信心。
5、家庭的配合是学困生转化的外部条件,通过家长会议、家访等多 种形式及时与家长相互沟通,交流信息。 六、学优生教学措施
英语是一门交际工具,是一门实践性很强的课程,大量反复地训练对学优生来说会很快产生学习上的疲倦,
不利于他们的学习激情。所以我制定了相应的措施。
1、活跃课堂气氛,为学优生量身定制难度稍大的符合课文内容的材料。
2、课后为学优生增加相应的训练,从词—句—篇。并在适当的时候让他们展现自己。达到逐步培养自学的能力。
人教版五年级英语上册课件 篇14
这样有利于学生记忆和开展话题的讨论。与五年级上册相同,本册Let’s learn中的大部分词汇要求学生做到听、说、读、写四会掌握(即加粗的单词)。用来巩固复习词汇的活动主要是结对和小组活动,以及Let’s find out等启发学生主动思考的活动。
五年级下册学生用书的Let’s try也是一项brainstorm式的活动,这一点与五年级上册相同。另外,在这一部分基本上都安排了一个任务型活动,需要学生通过问答、思考或讨论来完成。
Let’s talk部分依旧是一个浓缩了的情景会话,目标句型突出。为给学生提供灵活运用语言的机会,这一部分提供了可供替换的内容。
Read and write部分的教学目标是:读懂对话或短文;完成检测学生理解程度的填充句子练习;听、说、读、写四会掌握两组句子;完成一项综合运用所学语言的任务型语言活动。
Let’s spell部分,三年级上册、四年级上册学生用书中安排呈现了26个字母及例词,使学生初步了解到字母在单词中的发音,四年级下册学生用书进一步呈现了5个元音字母在单词中长短不同的发音,五年级上册学生用书编排了22个常见字母组合的发音,在此基础上,本册又安排了10个常见字母组合的发音,.
依旧是用绕口令的形式将含有这些字母组合的单词整合成趣味句子。
五年级下册学生用书的阶段复习密切围绕各单元话题展开,将所有需要复习的语言点融进有实际交际意义的活动之中,并增加了考察综合性阅读理解能力的语篇,以增进对语言知识的积累。 三、教学内容目标
1.能听、说、读、写69个短语和单词以及14组句子和6个谚语句子。(包括日常活动、季节、生日、电话用语、动物和野营等几个话题)。要求能在真实语境中正确运用并能读懂简短语篇。
2.能听、说、认读85个单词。
3.能听懂、会唱6首歌曲。
4.能理解6个幽默小故事。
5.能了解6项简单的语法知识。 四、教学重难点
1.学习一天中不同时间段学习和生活起居情况的表达,尤其是学会使用频度副词谈论日常生活;
2.问答最喜欢哪个季节并陈述原因;
3.学习12个月份的名称、每个月的主要活动和与序数词有关的日期表达法;
4.学习现在进行时,能够简单描述自己或他人正在做什么,询问他人正在做什么,询问动物正在做什么并作答;
5.学习形容词性和名词性物主代词的用法。
6.学习祈使句的用法。 五、教学措施
1.认真钻研教材和课标,精心备课,认真上好每一堂课。确定每堂课的基础内容,预备内容和拓展内容,满足不同层次学生的不同需求。
2.尽可能使用多种方式教学,激发学生的课堂兴趣。
3.及时与学生沟通,及时改进教学中存在的问题和不足
4.注重个别辅导,在面向全体学生的基础上,培优补差。
5.重视语音的训练,进一步复习巩固音标。
6.扎实训练四会句型,切实掌握语言材料。绿色圃中小学教育
.
7.在课堂上多开展一些有趣活动、游戏。让学生在活动中学习英语,在生活中学习英语。
六、教学进度表
周次 教学内容 课时安排
第1-3周 Unit1 My day 6
第4-5周 Unit2 My favourite season 6
第6-7周 Unit3 My school calendar 6
第8-9周 U
1第10-11周 Unit4 When is Easter? 6
第12-13周 Unit5 Whose dog is it? 6
第14-15周 Unit6 Work quietly! 6
第16-17周 U
4第18-20周
.
—U3 & Recycle1 6—U6& Recycle2 6复习、期末考试 6课时 课时 课时 课时 课时 课时 课时 课时 课时
人教版五年级英语上册课件 篇15
《普罗米修斯》教学设计
一、新课导入
1、链接旧知
同学们,还记得前几个学期我们学了哪些中国神话故事吗?
2、同学们在遥远的欧洲,有个国家叫做希腊,那里跟咱们国家一样,流传着一个个动人的神话故事。今天我们就一起来读一个古希腊神话故事。这个故事的名字叫做《普罗米修斯》。(板书课题)
二、初读感知
1、你们想了解这个故事吗?那就赶快打开课本,翻到148页,自由地朗读课文。
2、检查课文生字新词。
①喷射 驱赶 吩咐 惩罚 饶恕 鹫鹰
②肝脏 火种 归还 动弹 尽管 凶恶
你发现什么?(多音字)
③肝脏 双膝
表示身体部位的一般都带有“月”字旁。(范写“膝”字)
④ 驱寒取暖 气急败坏 风吹雨淋 弯弓搭箭
你能带上动作读一读吗?
⑤课堂作业本第一题
3、了解故事中人物
课文中写了哪几个神?谁来说一说。(指名学生说并且出示五位神的名字)
三、概括课文主要内容(随机出示)
1、非常好,还记得在这个故事中天神普罗米修斯做了什么?指名学生回答
引导得出:天神普罗米修斯把火带到了人间,造福人类。(PPT出示天神做的事)
2、那么,众神领袖宙斯又做了什么?
引导学生得出:众神领袖宙斯在天神普罗米修斯盗取天火后惩罚了他。(PPT出示宙斯做的事)
3、火神呢?火神呢?火神做了什么?
引导得出:火神劝普罗米修斯承认错误,并且归还火种。普罗米修斯并不听,火神就按照宙斯的命令把普罗米修斯锁在高加索山上。
(出示PPT火神做的事)
4、故事的最后,大力神赫拉克勒斯又做了什么?你请
引导得出:大力神赫拉克勒斯救了普罗米修斯。(出示PPT大力神赫拉克勒斯做的事)
5、总结课文大意
①同学们,现在你能来给大家简单地讲讲这个故事吗?指名学生说
②出示故事大概:
天神普罗米修斯从太阳神阿波罗那里拿走了火种,并带到了人间
众神领袖宙斯决定给普罗米修斯以最严厉的惩罚,火神劝告普罗米修斯归还火种,遭到拒绝。他只好把普罗米修斯锁在高加索山上。宙斯见普罗米修斯不肯合作,就派了秃鹰去啄食他的肝脏。大力神赫拉克勒斯解救了普罗米修斯。
③你发现了什么?总结概括课文的方法。(出示)
按照事情的发展顺序,将故事中各个人物的主要活动连在一起就抓住了课文的主要内容。
三、想象入境,感知火带来的变化
1、默读一、二自然段,找出两个完全不同、完全相反的画面。(指名学生回答并出示)
①很久很久以前,地面上没有火,人们只好吃生的东西,在无边的黑暗中度过一个又一个长夜。
②自从有了火,人类就开始用它烧熟食物,驱寒取暖,并用火来驱赶危害人类安全的猛兽……
*自由读读,你发现了什么?(①集中写没火②集中写没火)
2、感知人类无火的悲惨生活
①从这句话中你可以知道人类的生活会是什么样的?
交流①只能吃生的东西,吃生的东西意味着会带来疾病。②在无边的黑暗中度过一个又一个长夜。③……
师:在这无边的黑暗中,在这一个又一个危险的长夜中,你听,人们的外面,林子的外面,传来豺狼的吼叫,传来虎豹的长啸。你的心会感到什么?你会感到……(说到后面,师走进请发言的学生)
(害怕,心都怦怦跳、很不安等)
师:是啊,把这种害怕,把这种恐惧,把这种(稍停了会)不安带进去,我们再来读一读第一个画面。很久很久以前,一,二,起。 (生齐读第一个画面。)
3、感知火的重要性
师:孩子们,面对茹毛饮血的生活,面对漫漫长夜的恐惧。这个时候,人们最最需要的是什么? (火) 你听,人类在呼唤。。。。。。生:火。
4、体会有火的幸福生活
①出示人们用火烤食物的画面
师:那是没有火的时候,当人们终于用上普罗米修斯从天上盗来的火种,生活又是怎样的画面呢?你看这副画面,你看到人们正在用火干什么?
②出示句子:自从有了火,人类就开始用它烧熟食物,驱寒取暖,并用火来驱赶危害人类安全的猛兽……
* 这里省略号的意思是
* 自从有了火人类的生活还有那些变化?指名2个学生说
* 小练笔:自从有了火,
③是啊,同学们你看,有了火的日子,那真是。。。(学生回答)
④师:这样的开心靠什么?生:火!
师:这样的安全靠什么?生:火!!
师:这样的幸福靠什么?生:火!!!
师:火,是的,那么这样的火是谁带来的?(生齐答:普罗米修斯)火带给人类幸福的生活,带给普罗米修斯的又是什么呢?我们下节课再来学习。
四、作业布置
除了《普罗米修斯》,你还知道哪些古希腊神话故事?赶紧到课外去读读吧
[普罗米修斯 教案教学设计(人教版五年级上册)]